Chemistry Redspot Olevel
Chemistry Redspot Olevel
Chemistry Redspot Olevel
Cambridge IGCSE®
Chemistry 0620
For examination in June and November 2020 and 2021.
Also available for examination in March 2020 and 2021 for India only.
Version 1
Why choose Cambridge?
Cambridge Assessment International Education prepares school students for life, helping them develop an informed
curiosity and a lasting passion for learning. We are part of the University of Cambridge.
Our international qualifications are recognised by the world’s best universities and employers, giving students a
wide range of options in their education and career. As a not-for-profit organisation, we devote our resources to
delivering high-quality educational programmes that can unlock learners’ potential.
Our programmes and qualifications set the global standard for international education. They are created by subject
experts, rooted in academic rigour and reflect the latest educational research. They provide a strong platform for
learners to progress from one stage to the next, and are well supported by teaching and learning resources.
Our mission is to provide educational benefit through provision of international programmes and qualifications for
school education and to be the world leader in this field. Together with schools, we develop Cambridge learners
who are confident, responsible, reflective, innovative and engaged – equipped for success in the modern world.
Every year, nearly a million Cambridge students from 10 000 schools in 160 countries prepare for their future with
an international education from Cambridge International.
Quality management
Our systems for managing the provision of international qualifications and education programmes
for students aged 5 to 19 are certified as meeting the internationally recognised standard for
quality management, ISO 9001:2008. Learn more at www.cambridgeinternational.org/ISO9001
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of
the University of Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
UCLES retains the copyright on all its publications. Registered centres are permitted to copy material from this booklet for their own
internal use. However, we cannot give permission to centres to photocopy any material that is acknowledged to a third party even for
internal use within a centre.
Contents
5 Appendix................................................................................................................................... 34
The Periodic Table 34
Safety in the laboratory 35
Mathematical requirements 35
Presentation of data 36
ICT opportunities 37
Conventions (e.g. signs, symbols, terminology and nomenclature) 37
Key benefits
Cambridge IGCSE® syllabuses are created especially for international students. For over 25 years, we have worked
with schools and teachers worldwide to develop syllabuses that are suitable for different countries, different types
of schools and for learners with a wide range of abilities.
Our programmes balance a thorough knowledge and understanding of a subject and help to develop the skills
learners need for their next steps in education or employment.
Cambridge
learner
‘The strength of Cambridge IGCSE qualifications is internationally recognised and has provided
an international pathway for our students to continue their studies around the world.’
Gary Tan, Head of Schools and CEO, Raffles International Group of Schools, Indonesia
Cambridge IGCSEs are accepted and valued by leading universities and employers around the world as evidence of
academic achievement. Many universities require a combination of Cambridge International AS & A Levels and
Cambridge IGCSEs or equivalent to meet their entry requirements.
UK NARIC, the national agency in the UK for the recognition and comparison of international qualifications and
skills, has carried out an independent benchmarking study of Cambridge IGCSE and found it to be comparable to
the standard of GCSE in the UK. This means students can be confident that their Cambridge IGCSE qualifications
are accepted as equivalent to UK GCSEs by leading universities worldwide.
‘Cambridge IGCSE is one of the most sought-after and recognised qualifications in the world. It
is very popular in Egypt because it provides the perfect preparation for success at advanced level
programmes.’
Mrs Omnia Kassabgy, Managing Director of British School in Egypt BSE
Supporting teachers
We provide a wide range of practical resources, detailed guidance, and innovative training and professional
development so that you can give your learners the best possible preparation for Cambridge IGCSE.
2 Syllabus overview
Aims
The aims describe the purposes of a course based on this syllabus.
You can deliver some of the aims using suitable local, international or historical examples and applications, or
through collaborative experimental work.
Content overview
Candidates study the following topics:
1 The particulate nature of matter
2 Experimental techniques
3 Atoms, elements and compounds
4 Stoichiometry
5 Electricity and chemistry
6 Chemical energetics
7 Chemical reactions
8 Acids, bases and salts
9 The Periodic Table
10 Metals
11 Air and water
12 Sulfur
13 Carbonates
14 Organic chemistry
Assessment overview
All candidates take three papers.
Candidates who have studied the Core subject content, or who are expected to achieve a grade D or below should
be entered for Paper 1, Paper 3 and either Paper 5 or Paper 6. These candidates will be eligible for grades C to G.
Candidates who have studied the Extended subject content (Core and Supplement), and who are expected to
achieve a grade C or above should be entered for Paper 2, Paper 4 and either Paper 5 or Paper 6. These candidates
will be eligible for grades A* to G.
Assessment objectives
The assessment objectives (AOs) are:
AO1 Knowledge with understanding
Subject content defines the factual material that candidates may be required to recall and explain. Candidates will
also be asked questions which require them to apply this material to unfamiliar contexts and to apply knowledge
from one area of the syllabus to another.
Questions testing this objective will often begin with one of the following words: define, state, describe, explain
(using your knowledge and understanding) or outline (see the Glossary of terms used in science papers).
Candidates should be able, in words or using other written forms of presentation (i.e. symbolic, graphical and
numerical), to:
•• locate, select, organise and present information from a variety of sources
•• translate information from one form to another
•• manipulate numerical and other data
•• use information to identify patterns, report trends and draw inferences
•• present reasoned explanations for phenomena, patterns and relationships
•• make predictions and hypotheses
•• solve problems, including some of a quantitative nature.
Questions testing these skills may be based on information that is unfamiliar to candidates, requiring them to apply
the principles and concepts from the syllabus to a new situation, in a logical, deductive way.
Questions testing these skills will often begin with one of the following words: predict, suggest, calculate or
determine (see the Glossary of terms used in science papers).
3 Subject content
All candidates should be taught the Core subject content. Candidates who are only taught the Core subject content
can achieve a maximum of grade C. Candidates aiming for grades A* to C should be taught the Extended subject
content. The Extended subject content includes both the Core and the Supplement.
Scientific subjects are, by their nature, experimental. Learners should pursue a fully integrated course which allows
them to develop their practical skills by carrying out practical work and investigations within all of the topics listed.
2 Experimental techniques
2.1 Measurement
Core
•• Name appropriate apparatus for the
measurement of time, temperature, mass
and volume, including burettes, pipettes and
measuring cylinders
2.2 Purity
2.2.1 Criteria of purity
Core Supplement
•• Demonstrate knowledge and understanding of •• Interpret simple chromatograms, including the
paper chromatography use of Rf values
•• Interpret simple chromatograms •• Outline how chromatography techniques can
•• Identify substances and assess their purity from be applied to colourless substances by exposing
melting point and boiling point information chromatograms to substances called locating
agents. (Knowledge of specific locating agents is
•• Understand the importance of purity in
not required.)
substances in everyday life, e.g. foodstuffs and
drugs
3.2.4 Macromolecules
Core Supplement
•• Describe the giant covalent structures of graphite •• Describe the macromolecular structure of
and diamond silicon(IV) oxide (silicon dioxide)
•• Relate their structures to their uses, e.g. graphite •• Describe the similarity in properties between
as a lubricant and a conductor, and diamond in diamond and silicon(IV) oxide, related to their
cutting tools structures
4 Stoichiometry
4.1 Stoichiometry
Core Supplement
•• Use the symbols of the elements and write the •• Determine the formula of an ionic compound
formulae of simple compounds from the charges on the ions present
•• Deduce the formula of a simple compound from •• Construct equations with state symbols,
the relative numbers of atoms present including ionic equations
•• Deduce the formula of a simple compound from •• Deduce the balanced equation for a chemical
a model or a diagrammatic representation reaction, given relevant information
•• Construct word equations and simple balanced
chemical equations
•• Define relative atomic mass, Ar, as the average
mass of naturally occurring atoms of an element
on a scale where the 12C atom has a mass of
exactly 12 units
•• Define relative molecular mass, Mr, as the sum
of the relative atomic masses. (Relative formula
mass or Mr will be used for ionic compounds.)
(Calculations involving reacting masses in simple
proportions may be set. Calculations will not
involve the mole concept.)
6 Chemical energetics
6.1 Energetics of a reaction
Core Supplement
•• Describe the meaning of exothermic and •• Describe bond breaking as an endothermic
endothermic reactions process and bond forming as an exothermic
•• Interpret energy level diagrams showing process
exothermic and endothermic reactions •• Draw and label energy level diagrams for
exothermic and endothermic reactions using data
provided
•• Calculate the energy of a reaction using bond
energies
7 Chemical reactions
7.1 Physical and chemical changes
Core
•• Identify physical and chemical changes, and
understand the differences between them
7.4 Redox
Core Supplement
•• Define oxidation and reduction in terms of oxygen •• Define redox in terms of electron transfer
loss/gain. (Oxidation state limited to its use •• Identify redox reactions by changes in oxidation
to name ions, e.g. iron(II), iron(III), copper(II), state and by the colour changes involved when
manganate(VII).) using acidified potassium manganate(VII), and
potassium iodide. (Recall of equations involving
KMnO4 is not required.)
•• Define oxidising agent as a substance which
oxidises another substance during a redox
reaction. Define reducing agent as a substance
which reduces another substance during a redox
reaction.
•• Identify oxidising agents and reducing agents
from simple equations
10 Metals
10.1 Properties of metals
Core
•• List the general physical properties of metals
•• Describe the general chemical properties of
metals, e.g. reaction with dilute acids and
reaction with oxygen
•• Explain in terms of their properties why alloys are
used instead of pure metals
•• Identify representations of alloys from diagrams
of structure
11.2 Air
Core Supplement
•• State the composition of clean, dry air as being •• Describe the separation of oxygen and nitrogen
approximately 78% nitrogen, 21% oxygen and from liquid air by fractional distillation
the remainder as being a mixture of noble gases
and carbon dioxide
•• Name the common pollutants in the air as
being carbon monoxide, sulfur dioxide, oxides of
nitrogen and lead compounds
•• State the source of each of these pollutants: •• Describe and explain the presence of oxides
–– carbon monoxide from the incomplete of nitrogen in car engines and their catalytic
combustion of carbon-containing substances removal
–– sulfur dioxide from the combustion of fossil
fuels which contain sulfur compounds
(leading to ‘acid rain’)
–– oxides of nitrogen from car engines
–– lead compounds from leaded petrol
•• State the adverse effect of these common
pollutants on buildings and on health and discuss
why these pollutants are of global concern
•• State the conditions required for the rusting of
iron
•• Describe and explain methods of rust prevention, •• Describe and explain sacrificial protection in
specifically paint and other coatings to exclude terms of the reactivity series of metals and
oxygen galvanising as a method of rust prevention
12 Sulfur
12.1 Sulfur
Core Supplement
•• Name some sources of sulfur •• Describe the manufacture of sulfuric acid by the
•• Name the use of sulfur in the manufacture of Contact process, including essential conditions
sulfuric acid and reactions
•• State the uses of sulfur dioxide as a bleach in the •• Describe the properties and uses of dilute and
manufacture of wood pulp for paper and as a concentrated sulfuric acid
food preservative (by killing bacteria)
13 Carbonates
13.1 Carbonates
Core
•• Describe the manufacture of lime
(calcium oxide) from calcium carbonate
(limestone) in terms of thermal decomposition
•• Name some uses of lime and slaked lime
such as in treating acidic soil and neutralising
acidic industrial waste products, e.g. flue gas
desulfurisation
•• Name the uses of calcium carbonate in the
manufacture of iron and cement
14 Organic chemistry
14.1 Names of compounds
Core Supplement
•• Name and draw the structures of methane, •• Name and draw the structures of the unbranched
ethane, ethene, ethanol, ethanoic acid and the alkanes, alkenes (not cis-trans), alcohols and
products of the reactions stated in sections acids containing up to four carbon atoms per
14.4–14.6 molecule
•• State the type of compound present, given a •• Name and draw the structural formulae of the
chemical name ending in ‑ane, ‑ene, ‑ol, or ‑oic esters which can be made from unbranched
acid or a molecular structure alcohols and carboxylic acids, each containing up
to four carbon atoms
14.2 Fuels
Core
•• Name the fuels: coal, natural gas and petroleum
•• Name methane as the main constituent of
natural gas
•• Describe petroleum as a mixture of hydrocarbons
and its separation into useful fractions by
fractional distillation
•• Describe the properties of molecules within a
fraction
•• Name the uses of the fractions as:
–– refinery gas for bottled gas for heating and
cooking
–– gasoline fraction for fuel (petrol) in cars
–– naphtha fraction for making chemicals
–– kerosene/paraffin fraction for jet fuel
–– diesel oil/gas oil for fuel in diesel engines
–– fuel oil fraction for fuel for ships and home
heating systems
–– lubricating fraction for lubricants, waxes and
polishes
–– bitumen for making roads
14.4 Alkanes
Core Supplement
•• Describe the properties of alkanes (exemplified •• Describe substitution reactions of alkanes with
by methane) as being generally unreactive, chlorine
except in terms of burning
•• Describe the bonding in alkanes
14.5 Alkenes
Core Supplement
•• Describe the manufacture of alkenes and of •• Describe the properties of alkenes in terms of
hydrogen by cracking addition reactions with bromine, hydrogen and
•• Distinguish between saturated and unsaturated steam
hydrocarbons:
–– from molecular structures
–– by reaction with aqueous bromine
•• Describe the formation of poly(ethene) as an
example of addition polymerisation of monomer
units
14.6 Alcohols
Core Supplement
•• Describe the manufacture of ethanol by •• Outline the advantages and disadvantages of
fermentation and by the catalytic addition of these two methods of manufacturing ethanol
steam to ethene
•• Describe the properties of ethanol in terms of
burning
•• Name the uses of ethanol as a solvent and as a
fuel
14.8 Polymers
14.8.1 Polymers
Core Supplement
•• Define polymers as large •• Understand that different polymers have different units and/or
molecules built up from small different linkages
units (monomers)
O O O O O
C C N N C C N N C
H H H H
O O O O
C C O O C C O O
N C N C N C
H O
Core Assessment
Core candidates take the following papers that have questions based on the Core subject content only:
45 minutes, 40 marks
Forty compulsory multiple-choice items of the four-choice type. This paper tests assessment objectives AO1
and AO2.
Short-answer and structured questions testing assessment objectives AO1 and AO2.
Extended Assessment
Extended candidates take the following papers that have questions based on the Core and Supplement subject
content:
45 minutes, 40 marks
Forty compulsory multiple-choice items of the four-choice type. This paper tests assessment objectives AO1
and AO2.
Short-answer and structured questions testing assessment objectives AO1 and AO2.
Practical Assessment
All candidates take one practical component from a choice of two:
or
1 hour, 40 marks
Candidates must not use textbooks or any of their course notes in the practical component.
Questions in the practical papers are structured to assess performance across the grade ranges A* to G. The
information candidates need to answer the questions is in the question paper itself or the experimental context and
skills listed below. The questions do not assess specific syllabus content.
Experimental skills tested in Paper 5 Practical Test and Paper 6 Alternative to Practical
Candidates may be asked questions on the following experimental contexts:
•• simple quantitative experiments involving the measurement of volumes and/or masses
•• rates (speeds) of reaction
•• measurement of temperature based on a thermometer with 1 °C graduations
•• problems of an investigatory nature, possibly including suitable organic compounds
•• filtration
•• electrolysis
•• identification of ions and gases (Paper 5 will include notes on qualitative analysis for the use of candidates in
the examination).
•• complete tables of data, and process data, using a calculator where necessary
•• draw an appropriate conclusion, justifying it by reference to the data and using an appropriate explanation
•• interpret and evaluate observations and experimental data
•• plot graphs and/or interpret graphical information
•• identify sources of error and suggest possible improvements in procedures
•• plan an experiment or investigation, including making reasoned predictions of expected results and suggesting
suitable apparatus and techniques.
The best way to prepare candidates for these papers is to integrate practical work fully into the course so that it
becomes a normal part of your teaching. Practical work helps candidates to:
•• develop a deeper understanding of the syllabus topics
•• learn to appreciate the way in which scientific theories are developed and tested
•• develop experimental skills and positive scientific attitudes such as objectivity, integrity, cooperation,
enquiry and inventiveness.
Apparatus list
This list contains the items you will need for teaching the experimental skills needed for both practical papers, as
well as the Paper 5 exam. It is not exhaustive and does not include standard equipment such as Bunsen burners or
tripods. The Confidential Instructions we send you before the Paper 5 exam will give the detailed requirements for
the exam.
•• a burette, 50 cm3
•• a pipette, 25 cm3
•• a pipette filler
•• two conical flasks, within the range 150 cm3 to 250 cm3
•• measuring cylinder, 50 cm3, 25 cm3, 10 cm3
•• a filter funnel
•• beaker, squat form with lip, 250 cm3 and 100 cm3
•• a thermometer, –10 °C to + 110 °C at 1 °C graduations
•• a polystyrene or other plastic beaker of approximate capacity 150 cm3
•• clocks (or wall-clock) to measure to an accuracy of 1 s (where clocks are specified, candidates may use their
own wrist-watch if they prefer)
•• wash bottle
•• test-tubes (Pyrex or hard glass), approximately 125 mm × 16 mm
•• boiling tubes, approximately 150 mm × 25 mm
•• stirring rod
1 Define (the term(s) … ) is intended literally, only a formal statement or equivalent paraphrase being required.
2
What do you understand by/What is meant by (the term(s) … ) normally implies that a definition should be given,
together with some relevant comment on the significance or context of the term(s) concerned, especially where
two or more terms are included in the question. The amount of supplementary comment intended should be
interpreted in the light of the indicated mark value.
3 State implies a concise answer with little or no supporting argument (e.g. a numerical answer that can readily
be obtained ‘by inspection’).
4 List requires a number of points, generally each of one word, with no elaboration. Where a given number of
points is specified this should not be exceeded.
5 (a) Explain may imply reasoning or some reference to theory, depending on the context. It is another way of
asking candidates to give reasons. The candidate needs to leave the examiner in no doubt why something
happens.
(b) G
ive a reason/Give reasons is another way of asking candidates to explain why something happens.
6 Describe requires the candidate to state in words (using diagrams where appropriate) the main points.
Describe and explain may be coupled, as may state and explain.
7 Discuss requires the candidate to give a critical account of the points involved.
8 Outline implies brevity (i.e. restricting the answer to giving essentials).
9 Predict implies that the candidate is expected to make a prediction not by recall but by making a logical
connection between other pieces of information.
10 Deduce implies that the candidate is not expected to produce the required answer by recall but by making a
logical connection between other pieces of information.
11 Suggest is used in two main contexts, i.e. either to imply that there is no unique answer (e.g. in chemistry, two
or more substances may satisfy the given conditions describing an ‘unknown’), or to imply that candidates are
expected to apply their general knowledge of the subject to a ‘novel’ situation, one that may be formally ‘not in
the syllabus’ – many data response and problem-solving questions are of this type.
12 Find is a general term that may variously be interpreted as calculate, measure, determine, etc.
13 Calculate is used when a numerical answer is required. In general, working should be shown, especially where
two or more steps are involved.
14 Measure implies that the quantity concerned can be directly obtained from a suitable measuring instrument
(e.g. length using a rule, or mass using a balance).
15 Determine often implies that the quantity concerned cannot be measured directly but is obtained from a graph
or by calculation.
16 Estimate implies a reasoned order of magnitude statement or calculation of the quantity concerned, making
such simplifying assumptions as may be necessary about points of principle and about the values of quantities
not otherwise included in the question.
17 Sketch, when applied to graph work, implies that the shape and/or position of the curve need only be
qualitatively correct, but candidates should be aware that, depending on the context, some quantitative
aspects may be looked for (e.g. passing through the origin, having an intercept).
In diagrams, sketch implies that simple, free-hand drawing is acceptable; nevertheless, care should be taken
over proportions and the clear exposition of important details.
www.cambridgeinternational.org/igcse
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Cambridge IGCSE Chemistry 0620 syllabus for 2020 and 2021.
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.)
Associations
CLEAPSS is an advisory service providing support in practical science and technology.
www.cleapss.org.uk
Publications
CLEAPSS Laboratory Handbook, updated 2009 (available to CLEAPSS members only)
CLEAPSS Hazcards, 2007 update of 1995 edition (available to CLEAPSS members only)
UK regulations
Control of Substances Hazardous to Health Regulations (COSHH) 2002 and subsequent amendment in 2004
www.legislation.gov.uk/uksi/2002/2677/contents/made
www.legislation.gov.uk/uksi/2004/3386/contents/made
Mathematical requirements
Calculators may be used in all parts of the examination.
Presentation of data
The solidus (/) is to be used for separating the quantity and the unit in tables, graphs and charts, e.g. time / s for
time in seconds.
(a) Tables
•• Each column of a table should be headed with the physical quantity and the appropriate unit, e.g. time / s.
•• The column headings of the table can then be directly transferred to the axes of a constructed graph.
(b) Graphs
•• Unless instructed otherwise, the independent variable should be plotted on the x-axis (horizontal axis) and
the dependent variable plotted on the y-axis (vertical axis).
•• Each axis should be labelled with the physical quantity and the appropriate unit, e.g. time / s.
•• Unless instructed otherwise, the scales for the axes should allow more than half of the graph grid to be
used in both directions, and be based on sensible ratios, e.g. 2 cm on the graph grid representing 1, 2 or 5
units of the variable.
•• The graph is the whole diagrammatic presentation, including the best-fit line when appropriate. It may
have one or more sets of data plotted on it.
•• Points on the graph should be clearly marked as crosses (×) or encircled dots ().
•• Large ‘dots’ are penalised. Each data point should be plotted to an accuracy of better than one half of each
of the smallest squares on the grid.
•• A best-fit line (trend line) should be a single, thin, smooth straight-line or curve. The line does not need to
coincide exactly with any of the points; where there is scatter evident in the data, Examiners would expect
a roughly even distribution of points either side of the line over its entire length. Points that are clearly
anomalous should be ignored when drawing the best-fit line.
•• The gradient of a straight line should be taken using a triangle whose hypotenuse extends over at least half
of the length of the best-fit line, and this triangle should be marked on the graph.
(c) Numerical results
•• Data should be recorded so as to reflect the precision of the measuring instrument.
•• The number of significant figures given for calculated quantities should be appropriate to the least number
of significant figures in the raw data used.
(d) Pie charts
•• These should be drawn with the sectors in rank order, largest first, beginning at ‘noon’ and proceeding
clockwise. Pie charts should preferably contain no more than six sectors.
(e) Bar charts
•• These should be drawn when one of the variables is not numerical. They should be made up of narrow
blocks of equal width that do not touch.
(f) Histograms
•• These are drawn when plotting frequency graphs with continuous data. The blocks should be drawn in
order of increasing or decreasing magnitude and they should touch.
ICT opportunities
In order to play a full part in modern society, candidates need to be confident and effective users of ICT. This
syllabus provides candidates with a wide range of opportunities to use ICT in their study of chemistry.
•• Signs, Symbols and Systematics: The ASE Companion to 16–19 Science (2000).
Litre/dm3
To avoid any confusion concerning the symbol for litre, dm3 will be used in place of l or litre.
Decimal markers
In accordance with current ASE convention, decimal markers in examination papers will be a single dot on the line.
Candidates are expected to follow this convention in their answers.
Numbers
Numbers from 1000 to 9999 will be printed without commas or spaces. Numbers greater than or equal to 10 000
will be printed without commas. A space will be left between each group of three whole numbers, e.g. 4 256 789.
This section is an overview of other information you need to know about this syllabus. It will help to share the
administrative information with your exams officer so they know when you will need their support. Find more
information about our administrative processes at www.cambridgeinternational.org/examsofficers
Cambridge IGCSE, Cambridge IGCSE (9–1) and Cambridge O Level syllabuses are at the same level.
Making entries
Exams officers are responsible for submitting entries to Cambridge International. We encourage them to work
closely with you to make sure they enter the right number of candidates for the right combination of syllabus
components. Entry option codes and instructions for submitting entries are in the Cambridge Guide to Making
Entries. Your exams officer has a copy of this guide.
Exam administration
To keep our exams secure, we produce question papers for different areas of the world, known as ‘administrative
zones’. We allocate all Cambridge schools to one administrative zone determined by their location. Each zone has
a specific timetable. Some of our syllabuses offer candidates different assessment options. An entry option code
is used to identify the components the candidate will take relevant to the administrative zone and the available
assessment options.
Retakes
Candidates can retake the whole qualification as many times as they want to. This is a linear qualification so
candidates cannot re-sit individual components.
The standard assessment arrangements may present unnecessary barriers for candidates with disabilities or learning
difficulties. We can put arrangements in place for these candidates to enable them to access the assessments and
receive recognition of their attainment. We do not agree access arrangements if they give candidates an unfair
advantage over others or if they compromise the standards being assessed.
Candidates who cannot access the assessment of any component may be able to receive an award based on the
parts of the assessment they have completed.
Language
This syllabus and the related assessment materials are available in English only.
A* is the highest and G is the lowest. ‘Ungraded’ means that the candidate’s performance did not meet the
standard required for grade G. ‘Ungraded’ is reported on the statement of results but not on the certificate. In
specific circumstances your candidates may see one of the following letters on their statement of results:
•• Q (result pending)
•• X (no result)
•• Y (to be issued)
These letters do not appear on the certificate.
Grade descriptions
Grade descriptions are provided to give an indication of the standards of achievement candidates awarded
particular grades are likely to show. Weakness in one aspect of the examination may be balanced by a better
performance in some other aspect.
Grade descriptions for Cambridge IGCSE Chemistry will be published after the first assessment of the IGCSE in
2020. Find more information at www.cambridgeinternational.org/igcse
From 2020 this syllabus will no longer be regulated by the qualifications and examinations regulator in England,
Wales and Northern Ireland.
Changes to the syllabus and specimen papers reflect the change in regulated status. There are no other changes to
the syllabus or specimen assessment material.
The syllabus and specimen papers have been updated with the new name for Cambridge Assessment International
Education.
You are strongly advised to read the whole syllabus before planning your teaching programme.
Any textbooks endorsed to support the syllabus for examination from 2016 are still suitable for use
with this syllabus.
CHEMISTRY 0620/01
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN PAPER
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
Soft pencil (type B or HB is recommended)
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 18.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 The diagrams show the arrangement of particles in three different physical states of substance X.
4 The nucleon number and proton number of the lithium atom are shown by the symbol 73 Li.
What is the correct symbol for the lithium ion in lithium chloride?
6 6 7 7
A 2
Li– B 3
Li+ C 3
Li+ D 3
Li–
A 5 B 31 C 32 D 63
Mg 12 24 12 W 12
Mg2+ X 24 12 12 10
F 9 19 9 Y 9
F– 9 19 9 10 Z
W X Y Z
A 10 10 9 9
B 10 12 10 9
C 12 10 9 10
D 12 12 10 10
key
+ = proton
+ +
– – n = neutron
n n
– = electron
A B C D
+ + + + + + + + + + +
– – – – – – – –
n n n n n n n n n
R 2,4
T 2,8
X 2,8,1
Z 2,8,7
Which row shows how many electrons there could be in the outer shell of an atom of X?
1 2 6 7
A
B
C
D
10 Which diagram does not show the outer shell electrons in the molecule correctly?
A B C D
H H H Cl H C H Cl Cl
W NaAl Si3O8
X CaAl2Si2O8
12 The diagram shows apparatus used in an attempt to electroplate a metal ring with copper.
battery
+ –
bulb
13 Three electrolysis cells are set up. Each cell has inert electrodes.
15 The apparatus shown can be used to measure the rate of some chemical reactions.
gas syringe
reaction mixture
16 A student investigates the rate of reaction between magnesium and excess sulfuric acid.
The volume of hydrogen given off in the reaction is measured over time.
R
volume of S
hydrogen
given off
time
A A catalyst is added in S.
B The acid is more concentrated in R than in S.
C The magnesium is less finely powdered in R than in S.
D The temperature in R is lower than in S.
17 When pink cobalt(II) chloride crystals are heated they form steam and a blue solid.
When water is added to the blue solid, it turns pink and becomes hot.
Which terms describe the pink cobalt(II) chloride crystals and the reactions?
A aqueous irreversible
B anhydrous reversible
C hydrated irreversible
D hydrated reversible
18 The red colour in some pottery glazes may be formed as a result of the reactions shown.
heat
CuCO3 CuO + CO2
1 2
A CO2 SnO2
B CuCO3 CuO
C CuO SnO
D SnO CuO
A decomposition
B fermentation
C neutralisation
D oxidation
21 A solution contains barium ions and silver ions and one type of anion.
A chloride only
B nitrate only
C sulfate only
D chloride or nitrate or sulfate
22 A mixture containing two anions was tested and the results are shown below.
test result
23 Astatine is an element in Group VII of the Periodic Table. It has only ever been produced in very
small amounts.
24 The diagram shows the positions of elements L, M, Q, R and T in the Periodic Table.
R T
M Q
25 The table compares the properties of Group I elements with those of transition elements.
26 X is a monatomic gas.
gas X
A X burns in air.
B X is coloured.
C X is unreactive.
D X will displace iodine from potassium iodide.
Which set of properties help to explain the use of aluminium for cooking and storing food?
A B
– + – +
+ – + –
– + – +
C D
29 The table shows the results of adding three metals, P, Q and R, to dilute hydrochloric acid and to
water.
Q no reaction no reaction
A P R Q
B P Q R
C R Q P
D R P Q
30 The table gives the composition of the atmosphere of four newly discovered planets.
A W only
B W, X and Z
C W and Y only
D W, Y and Z
heat
limewater
A brown solid is formed in the reaction tube and the limewater turns cloudy.
What is compound X?
A calcium oxide
B copper(II) oxide
C magnesium oxide
D sodium oxide
heat with an
ammonium compound
ammonia
substance Y
a salt
heat with
dilute acid
A an alcohol
B a base
C a catalyst
D a metal
After three days, the water level inside the test-tube has risen.
water
Two of these gases are emitted into the atmosphere as a result of processes within animals.
1 2 3 4
35 To grow rose plants, a fertiliser containing nitrogen, phosphorus and potassium is often used.
For the best rose flowers, the fertiliser should contain a high proportion of potassium.
proportion by mass
fertiliser
N P K
A 9 0 25
B 13 13 20
C 29 5 0
D 29 15 5
36 Air containing an acidic impurity was neutralised by passing it through a column containing
substance X.
substance X
What is substance X?
A calcium oxide
B sand
C sodium chloride
D concentrated sulfuric acid
refinery gases
gasoline
X
pre-heat diesel oil
400 °C Y
Z
X Y Z
H H H H H H H H H H
C C H C C C C H H C C C C C C H
H H H H H H H H H H
A B C D
H H H O H H H H
H C C H H C C O H H C C H H C C O H
H H H H H H H
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/01
Paper 1 Multiple Choice For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN MARK SCHEME
45 minutes
MAXIMUM MARK: 40
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 D 21 B
2 C 22 B
3 C 23 A
4 C 24 B
5 D 25 A
6 D 26 C
7 A 27 D
8 C 28 D
9 C 29 A
10 D 30 D
11 B 31 B
12 D 32 B
13 A 33 A
14 B 34 D
15 C 35 B
16 B 36 A
17 D 37 D
18 D 38 B
19 C 39 C
20 C 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/02
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN PAPER
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
Soft pencil (type B or HB is recommended)
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 18.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 Amino acids are colourless and can be separated and identified by chromatography.
glass cover
beaker
chromatography
paper solvent
What additional apparatus is required to identify the amino acids present in a mixture?
A a locating agent
B a ruler
C a ruler and a locating agent
D neither a ruler or a locating agent
2 The diagram shows the diffusion of hydrogen chloride and ammonia in a glass tube.
The gases are given off by the solutions at each end of the tube.
When hydrogen chloride and ammonia mix they produce a white solid, ammonium chloride.
A B C D
key
+ = proton
+ +
– – n = neutron
n n
– = electron
A B C D
+ + + + + + + + + + +
– – – – – – – –
n n n n n n n n n
Mg 12 24 12 W 12
Mg2+ X 24 12 12 10
F 9 19 9 Y 9
F– 9 19 9 10 Z
W X Y Z
A 10 10 9 9
B 10 12 10 9
C 12 10 9 10
D 12 12 10 10
5 Iron is a metal. The structure of iron is described as a lattice of positive ions in a sea of electrons.
2 iron has a high melting point due to the strong covalent bonds
3 iron is an alloy
4 iron is malleable because the layers of atoms can slide over one another
A 1 only
B 1 and 3
C 1 and 4
D 2, 3 and 4
R 2,4
T 2,8
X 2,8,1
Z 2,8,7
H H
C C
H H
A 15 B 37 C 74 D 148
W NaAl Si3O8
X CaAl2Si2O8
10 What is the concentration of a solution containing 1.0 g of sodium hydroxide in 250 cm3 of
solution?
11 Four students prepared hydrated copper(II) sulfate by adding an excess of dilute sulfuric acid to
copper(II) oxide.
Mr = 80 Mr = 250
After the copper(II) sulfate had crystallised the students dried and weighed the crystals.
Which student produced the highest percentage yield of hydrated copper(II) sulfate?
A 4.0 11.5
B 8.0 23.5
C 12.0 35.0
D 16.0 46.5
What is the total volume of gas remaining at the end of the reaction?
A 400 cm3
B 450 cm3
C 490 cm3
D 520 cm3
V
metal 1 metal 2
14 Three electrolysis cells are set up. Each cell has inert electrodes.
2 Electrons move around the circuit from the cathode to the anode.
Which statements about the electrolysis of concentrated copper(II) chloride are correct?
A 1 and 3
B 1 and 4
C 2 and 3
D 2 and 4
2H2O → 2H2 + O2
N2O4(g) ⇌ 2NO2(g)
Which conditions will give the largest yield of nitrogen dioxide, NO2?
temperature pressure
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
18 The apparatus shown can be used to measure the rate of some chemical reactions.
gas syringe
reaction mixture
19 A student investigates the rate of reaction between magnesium and excess sulfuric acid.
The volume of hydrogen given off in the reaction is measured over time.
R
volume of S
hydrogen
given off
time
A A catalyst is added in S.
B The acid is more concentrated in R than in S.
C The magnesium is less finely powdered in R than in S.
D The temperature in R is lower than in S.
A Cu2+ + 2e– Cu
B Fe2O3 + 3CO 2Fe + 3CO2
C HCl + NaOH NaCl + H2O
D Mg + ZnSO4 Zn + MgSO4
21 The red colour in some pottery glazes may be formed as a result of the reactions shown.
heat
CuCO3 CuO + CO2
1 2
A CO2 SnO2
B CuCO3 CuO
C CuO SnO
D SnO CuO
A ammonia
B ammonium hydroxide
C none of them
D water
A W Z X Y
B X Y W Z
C Z X Y W
D Z W X Y
24 A solution contains barium ions and silver ions and one type of anion.
A chloride only
B nitrate only
C sulfate only
D chloride or nitrate or sulfate
25 A mixture containing two anions was tested and the results are shown below.
test result
W X
Z Y
27 Astatine is an element in Group VII of the Periodic Table. It has only ever been produced in very
small amounts.
28 The table shows the results of adding three metals, P, Q and R, to dilute hydrochloric acid and to
water.
Q no reaction no reaction
A P R Q
B P Q R
C R Q P
D R P Q
heat
limewater
A brown solid is formed in the reaction tube and the limewater turns cloudy.
What is compound X?
A calcium oxide
B copper(II) oxide
C magnesium oxide
D sodium oxide
30 Zinc is extracted from zinc blende. Zinc blende is an ore of zinc and consists mainly of zinc
sulfide.
One of the steps in the process involves zinc sulfide reacting with oxygen from the air.
C 2ZnS + O2 → 2ZnO + S
carbon dioxide in
atmosphere
gradual production of
fossil fuels
coal, oil
and
natural gas
A combustion
B photosynthesis
C respiration
D transpiration
A 2CO + O2 → 2CO2
C 2NO2 → N2 + 2O2
heat with an
ammonium compound
ammonia
substance Y
a salt
heat with
dilute acid
A an alcohol
B a base
C a catalyst
D a metal
34 Which row shows the conditions for the manufacture of sulfuric acid?
35 Air containing an acidic impurity was neutralised by passing it through a column containing
substance X.
substance X
What is substance X?
A calcium oxide
B sand
C sodium chloride
D concentrated sulfuric acid
refinery gases
gasoline
X
pre-heat diesel oil
400 °C Y
Z
X Y Z
Which row describes the type of reaction that ethane and ethene undergo?
ethane ethene
A addition addition
B addition substitution
C substitution substitution
D substitution addition
Which acid and alcohol react together to form the following ester?
O
CH3CH2 C
OCH3
H O H O
C N C N C N C
H O
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/02
Paper 2 Multiple Choice For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN MARK SCHEME
45 minutes
MAXIMUM MARK: 40
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 D
2 D 22 D
3 A 23 D
4 D 24 B
5 C 25 B
6 C 26 C
7 B 27 A
8 C 28 A
9 B 29 B
10 B 30 A
11 B 31 C
12 C 32 B
13 B 33 B
14 A 34 A
15 A 35 A
16 A 36 D
17 B 37 B
18 C 38 D
19 B 39 B
20 A 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/03
Paper 3 Theory (Core) For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN PAPER
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
diamond chlorine
= carbon atom = chlorine atom
diamond
chlorine
[4]
(b) The structure of a compound containing carbon and chlorine is shown below.
Cl Cl
Cl Cl
C
Cl C C Cl
Cl C C Cl
C
Cl Cl
Cl Cl
[1]
[1]
density in liquid
element boiling point / °C colour
state / g per cm3
bromine –7 red-brown
[1]
(iii) Describe the trend in boiling point of the halogens down the group.
[1]
(d) (i) Complete the word equation for the reaction of bromine with aqueous potassium iodide.
…………………... [2]
(ii) Suggest why bromine does not react with aqueous potassium chloride.
[1]
solubility in water?
electrical conductivity?
[2]
[Total: 13]
[1]
(b) A teacher placed a small amount of liquid bromine in the bottom of a sealed gas jar of air.
After two minutes red-brown fumes were seen just above the liquid surface. After one hour
the red-brown colour had spread completely throughout the gas jar.
air
liquid
bromine
[3]
[Total: 4]
A B C
K+ NO3– K+
N N
H H NO3– K+ NO3– I I
H I
K+ NO3– K+
D E
N
N N O O
(c) a gas which turns damp red litmus paper blue, [1]
[Total: 6]
4 The diagram shows a rotary lime kiln used to make lime from limestone.
Limestone is fed in at the top of the kiln and lime comes out at the bottom.
hot air
lime
[1]
(b) State the name of the type of chemical reaction that takes place in the kiln.
[1]
(c) Suggest why the air coming out of the kiln has a greater percentage of carbon dioxide than
the air entering the kiln.
[1]
[1]
gas syringe
metal carbonate
heat
State one thing that must be kept constant if the rates of the three reactions are to be
compared in a fair way.
[1]
(f) The graph shows the volume of carbon dioxide released when the three metal carbonates
were heated.
50
calcium
40 carbonate
30 strontium
volume of carbonate
carbon dioxide
/ cm3
20
barium
carbonate
10
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
time / minutes
[1]
(ii) What volume of carbon dioxide was produced by strontium carbonate in twelve minutes?
[1]
(iii) How do the rates of the reactions of these three metal carbonates relate to the position
of calcium, strontium and barium in the Periodic Table?
[2]
(g) Describe how hydrochloric acid and limewater can be used to show that carbonate ions are
present in calcium carbonate.
[3]
[Total: 12]
(a) State three properties of transition elements which are not shown by the Group I elements.
1.
2.
3. [3]
(b) The symbols for two isotopes of iron are shown below.
54 57
26
Fe 26
Fe
[1]
57
(ii) Determine the number of neutrons present in one atom of the isotope 26
Fe.
[1]
[1]
method
[2]
[2]
(e) In the blast furnace, iron(III) oxide reacts with carbon monoxide.
substance
explanation
[2]
(f) (i) Carbon monoxide is a pollutant gas produced in motor car engines.
State why carbon monoxide is formed.
[1]
[1]
[Total: 14]
concentrated
hydrochloric acid
[1]
(c) State the name of the gas given off at the negative electrode.
[1]
(d) Complete the following sentence about electrolysis using words from the list.
(i) Draw the shells and the electronic structure in an atom of chlorine.
[1]
[2]
test
result [2]
…………………… [2]
[Total: 14]
nitrogen
oxygen
other gases
[1]
(ii) Apart from nitrogen and oxygen, state the names of two gases present in unpolluted air.
and [2]
(b) The percentage of oxygen in air can be found using the apparatus shown below.
gas syringe
heat
Air is passed backwards and forwards over the heated copper using the syringes. The
copper reacts with oxygen in the air.
[1]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 6]
[1]
(ii) Complete the symbol equation for the manufacture of ethene from dodecane, C12H26.
(b) Two fractions obtained from the distillation of petroleum are refinery gas and gasoline.
State one use of each of these fractions.
refinery gas
gasoline [2]
unsaturated
hydrocarbon [2]
fermentation
(ii) Draw the structure of ethanol, showing all atoms and bonds.
[2]
[Total: 11]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/03
Paper 3 Theory (Core) For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN MARK SCHEME
1 hour 15 minutes
MAXIMUM MARK: 80
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
1 (a) diamond:
covalent;
giant structure / macromolecule;
chlorine: any two of:
molecule;
covalent;
diatomic; [4]
iodine [1]
not: iodide
electrical conductivity:
ionic compounds conduct electricity when molten / in (aqueous) solution
and molecular compounds do not [1]
note: both needed for mark
(c) carbon dioxide has been removed from the limestone / it comes from the limestone / carbon
dioxide is a product [1]
(d) neutralising acidic soils / treating acidic lakes / flue gas desulfurisation
allow: any suitable use [1]
(e) temperature of Bunsen / distance of Bunsen from the tube / mass of carbonate used / owtte
[1]
(iii) calcium faster than strontium which is faster than barium / idea of
trend down the group; [1]
correct trend, i.e. less rapid reaction the further down the group / ora; [1]
(ii) 31 [1]
(iii) 23 [1]
(c) suitable method, e.g. coating with paint / zinc / unreactive metal / plastic / oil / grease /
galvanising / sacrificial protection; [1]
suitable reason, e.g. stops air / water reaching surface; [1]
note: reason must be consequential to the method chosen
(f) (i) incomplete combustion / insufficient or limited or not enough oxygen [1]
(ii) toxic / suffocates you / stops red blood cells carrying oxygen / binds with hemoglobin in
place of oxygen [1]
6 (a) break down (of substance / electrolyte) by electricity / splitting up of substance by electricity /
decomposition by electricity [1]
allow: current / voltage for electricity
(b) (i) decreases / gets less / gets lower / gets used up [1]
(c) any suitable use e.g. electrical conductor / electrical wiring / saucepans [1]
8 (a) (i) (group of) molecules with similar boiling points / (group of) molecules with similar relative
molecular masses / molecules with limited range of boiling points / molecules with limited
range of molecular masses / molecules coming off at the same place in the fractionation
column / owtte [1]
(ii) C10H22
allow: reasonable mixtures, e.g. C7H16 + C3H6 [1]
(b) refinery gas: (fuel) for heating / (fuel) for cars / (fuel) for cooking; [1]
gasoline: (fuel) for cars / mowers etc.; [1]
(d) (i) 1st box down ticked (catalytic addition of steam) [1]
CHEMISTRY 0620/04
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN PAPER
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
[1]
(b) State all the substances that are liquid at room temperature?
[1]
(c) Which substance could have a macromolecular structure similar to that of silicon(IV) oxide?
[1]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 5]
A 15 15 16
B 15 18 16
C 15 15 17
(a) What is the evidence in the table for each of the following?
[1]
[1]
[2]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 6]
3 Kinetic theory explains the properties of matter in terms of the arrangement and movement of
particles.
(a) Nitrogen is a gas at room temperature. Nitrogen molecules, N2, are spread far apart and
move in a random manner at high speed.
[2]
(ii) Compare the movement and arrangement of the molecules in solid nitrogen to those in
nitrogen gas.
[3]
(b) A sealed container contains nitrogen gas. The pressure of the gas is due to the molecules of
the gas hitting the walls of the container.
Use the kinetic theory to explain why the pressure inside the container increases when the
temperature is increased.
[2]
The following apparatus can be used to measure the rate of diffusion of a gas.
constant
pressure
applied metal foil,
gas escapes
gas syringe gas through small
hole in foil
nitrogen 25 1.00
chlorine 25 0.63
nitrogen 50 1.05
(c) (i) Explain why nitrogen gas diffuses faster than chlorine gas.
[2]
(ii) Explain why the nitrogen gas diffuses faster at the higher temperature.
[1]
[Total: 10]
(a) (i) State two differences in the physical properties of chromium and sodium.
[2]
(ii) State two differences in the chemical properties of chromium and sodium.
[2]
(b) Chromium is used to electroplate steel objects. The diagram shows how this could be done.
+ –
(i) Give two reasons why steel objects are plated with chromium.
[2]
(ii) The formula of the chromium(III) ion is Cr3+ and of the sulfate ion is SO42–. Give the
formula of chromium(III) sulfate.
[1]
(iii) Write the ionic half-equation for the reaction at the negative electrode (cathode).
[2]
(iv) A colourless gas, which relights a glowing splint, is formed at the positive electrode
(anode).
[1]
(v) During electroplating, it is necessary to add more chromium(III) sulfate but during
copper plating using a copper anode, it is not necessary to add more copper(II) sulfate.
[2]
[Total: 12]
waste gases
raw materials::
coke, C
iron ore, Fe2O3
firebrick lining limestone, CaCO3
air
slag
molten iron
Include one equation for a redox reaction and one for an acid/base reaction.
[5]
[Total: 5]
BLANK PAGE
(a) Complete this method of preparing dry crystals of the soluble salt
cobalt(II) chloride-6-water from the insoluble base cobalt(II) carbonate.
step 1
Add an excess of cobalt(II) carbonate to hot dilute hydrochloric acid.
step 2
step 3
step 4
[4]
(b) (i) 5.95 g of cobalt(II) carbonate were added to 40 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, concentration
2.0 mol / dm3.
Calculate the maximum yield of cobalt(II) chloride-6-water and show that the cobalt(II)
carbonate was in excess.
maximum yield:
number of moles of HCl used = ……………………….……… (use your value from above)
(ii) Explain how these calculations show that cobalt(II) carbonate is in excess.
[1]
[Total: 10]
I2 + Cl2 → 2ICl
[2]
(b) When the equilibrium mixture is heated, it becomes a darker brown colour.
Suggest if the reverse reaction is endothermic or exothermic. Give a reason for your choice.
[1]
(i) How would this affect the position of equilibrium? Give a reason for your choice.
reason
[1]
[1]
(d) Calculate the overall energy change for the reaction between iodine and chlorine using the
bond energy values shown.
I2 + Cl2 → 2ICl
I–I 151
Cl – Cl 242
I – Cl 208
[3]
(e) Draw a labelled energy level diagram for the reaction between iodine and chlorine using the
information in (d).
[2]
[Total: 10]
[3]
(b) The following two alcohols are members of an homologous series and they are isomers.
[2]
(ii) Deduce the structural formula of another alcohol which is also an isomer of these
alcohols.
[1]
mineral wool
soaked in butanol copper(II) oxide
heat
liquid X
formed by
oxidation of
butanol.
(i) Give the name of another reagent which can oxidise butanol.
[1]
[1]
[1]
(d) The alcohol ethanol can be made by fermentation. Yeast is added to aqueous glucose.
Carbon dioxide is given off and the mixture becomes warm, as the reaction is exothermic.
The graph shows how the rate of reaction varies over several days.
rate of
reaction
time
[2]
[1]
[2]
[Total: 14]
BLANK PAGE
[2]
[2]
(c) The polymer known as PVA is used in paints and adhesives. Its structural formula is shown
below.
―CH2―CH―CH2―CH―
│ │
OCOCH3 OCOCH3
[1]
[3]
[Total: 8]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/04
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN MARK SCHEME
1 hour 15 minutes
MAXIMUM MARK: 80
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
1 (a) A [1]
(c) E [1]
(d) B [1]
(e) C [1]
(ii) all have the same number of protons / same proton number / same atomic number [1]
(iii) same number of protons / same proton number / same atomic number; [1]
different number of neutrons / different nucleon number / different mass number; [1]
(ii) non-metal because it accepts electrons / needs 3e to complete outer energy level /
because it is in Group V or 5e in outer shell [1]
note: need both non-metal and reason for one mark
3 (a) (i) 6e between two nitrogen atoms; note: can be any combination of dots or crosses [1]
1 lone pair on each nitrogen atom; [1]
(ii) (at higher temperature) molecules move faster / have more energy [1]
(v) to replace chromium ions (used to plate steel) / chromium ions used up; [1]
copper ions replaced from copper anode; [1]
number of moles of HCl used = 0.08 note: must use their value
allow: ecf
number of moles of CoCO3 in 5.95 g of cobalt(II) carbonate = 5.95/119 = 0.05; [1]
(b) endothermic and because this direction is favoured by high temperatures; [1]
note: reason is required
(c) (i) move to left hand side / reactants favoured and because bigger volume / more moles on
left hand side [1]
note: reason is required
(ii) less (yellow) solid / more (dark brown) liquid / green gas visible / turns darker brown /
smell chlorine [1]
allow: ecf from (c)(i)
9 (a) addition: polymer is the only product / only one product; [1]
condensation: polymer and water formed / small molecule formed; [1]
(d) -OC(CH2)4CONH(CH2)6NH-
amide linkage correct; [1]
correct repeat units; [1]
continuation bonds shown; [1]
CHEMISTRY 0620/05
Paper 5 Practical Test For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN PAPER
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between excess magnesium and two different dilute
acids, X and Y.
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
(a) Experiment 1
bung
inverted 100 cm3
measuring cylinder
conical flask
water
trough
Remove the bung from the conical flask and move the measuring cylinder away from the
delivery tube without letting any water run out. Twist one of the strips of magnesium to break
it into four pieces and place all four pieces into the conical flask.
Using a different measuring cylinder, measure 50 cm3 of dilute acid X. Pour it into the conical
flask and replace the bung firmly. Place the measuring cylinder back over the delivery tube
and start the timer. In the table, record the volume of gas collected in the measuring cylinder
every 30 seconds for three minutes.
(b) Experiment 2
(c) Plot the results you have obtained for both experiments on the grid below. For each set of
results, draw a smooth line graph. Indicate clearly which line represents Experiment 1 and
which line represents Experiment 2.
[4]
(d) State which experiment had the faster rate of reaction and suggest why the rate was faster in
this experiment.
[1]
(e) From your graph, deduce the time required to collect 25 cm3 of gas in Experiment 1.
Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your answer.
[1]
volume of gas / cm 3
rate =
time taken / s
For the experiment with the higher rate, calculate the rate of reaction for the first 30 seconds
of the reaction. Deduce the units.
rate [2]
(g) A student suggested that the magnesium should be rubbed with sandpaper before starting
the experiment. Explain why the magnesium should be rubbed with sandpaper.
[2]
(h) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder to add the acids to
the flask.
advantage
disadvantage [2]
[1]
[Total: 17]
BLANK PAGE
2 You are provided with a mixture of two solids, C and D. Solid C is water-soluble and D is
insoluble in water. Carry out the following tests on C and D, recording all of your observations at
each stage.
Add 15 cm3 of distilled water to the mixture in the boiling tube. Stopper and shake the boiling tube
for two minutes. Filter the contents of the tube, keeping the filtrate and residue for the following
tests.
(a) (i) To about 1 cm3 of the solution, add a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
observation [1]
observation [1]
(b) To about 1 cm3 of the solution add an equal volume of aqueous ammonia.
observation [1]
(c) To about 1 cm3 of the solution add excess aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Now add a small piece of aluminium foil and warm the mixture carefully. Test any gases
given off.
observation
[2]
[2]
Wash the residue in the filter paper with a little distilled water.
Using a spatula, transfer some of the solid residue from the filter paper into two test-tubes.
(e) Heat the solid in the first test-tube gently and then strongly. Leave the test-tube to cool.
observation
[2]
(f) (i) Add about 2 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid to the second test-tube. Test any gases given
off. Keep this liquid for (f)(ii).
observation
[2]
(ii) After two minutes, add an equal volume of distilled water and shake the test-tube.
Decant off the liquid and divide the liquid into two approximately equal portions.
To the first portion add aqueous sodium hydroxide a little at a time until in excess.
observation
[2]
(iii) To the second portion add aqueous ammonia a little at a time until in excess.
observation
[2]
[2]
[Total: 17]
(a) E210 is benzoic acid. How could you show that a solution of benzoic acid is a weak acid?
test
result [2]
[4]
[Total: 6]
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp, red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/05
Paper 5 Practical Test For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN MARK SCHEME
1 hour 15 minutes
MAXIMUM MARK: 40
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
(c) appropriate scale on x-axis and y-axis and labels and units; [1]
note: scale should cover at least half of grid
points plotted to ± half a small square accuracy;; [2]
note: >12 correct = 2, 10–12 correct = 1, <10 correct = 0
two labelled smooth line graphs and must plot volume at t = 0; [1]
(d) Experiment 1 / acid X and statement that acid X is stronger or more concentrated / ora [1]
(e) value from graph to ± half a small square accuracy and indication shown on graph [1]
(i) graduated pipette / burette / gas syringe / mass of magnesium rather than strips / repeats
and take average / take more frequent readings / suitable method for reducing initial loss of
gas and any suitable comment on improved accuracy; [1]
note: explanation must relate to reason
CHEMISTRY 0620/06
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN PAPER
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 The diagram shows the apparatus used to prepare a dry sample of a gas. The gas is more dense
than air.
stand and
clamp
concentrated
sulfuric acid
[1]
(c) Suggest a reason why the gas is passed through concentrated sulfuric acid.
[1]
[Total: 5]
2 A student investigated the rate of reaction between excess magnesium and two different dilute
acids, X and Y.
Experiment 1
trough water
Using a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of dilute acid X was poured into the conical flask.
0.5 g of magnesium ribbon was added to the conical flask and the bung added.
The timer was started and the volume of gas collected in the measuring cylinder was measured
every 30 seconds for three minutes.
(a) Use the measuring cylinder diagrams to record the volumes of gas collected.
0
0 5
10
10
30 15
20
20
60 25
30
25
90 30
35
30
120 35
40
40
150 45
50
45
180 50
55
[2]
Experiment 2
(b) Use the measuring cylinder diagrams to record the volumes of gas collected.
0
0 5
10
0
30 5
10
5
60 10
15
10
90 15
20
10
120 15
20
15
150 20
25
15
180 20
25
[2]
(c) Plot the results for both experiments on the grid below. For each set of results, draw a
smooth line graph. Indicate clearly which line represents Experiment 1 and which line
represents Experiment 2.
[4]
(d) State which experiment had the faster rate of reaction and suggest why the rate was faster in
this experiment.
[1]
(e) From your graph, deduce the time required to collect 25 cm3 of gas in Experiment 1.
Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your answer.
[1]
volume of gas / cm 3
rate =
time taken / s
For the experiment with the higher rate, calculate the rate of reaction for the first 30 seconds
of the reaction. Deduce the units.
rate [2]
(g) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder to add the acids to
the flask.
advantage
disadvantage [2]
[1]
[Total: 15]
3 Concentrated aqueous sodium chloride was broken down by electricity using the apparatus
shown.
gas A gas B
concentrated aqueous
sodium chloride
electrodes
+ –
[1]
test
result [2]
(c) Gas B pops when tested with a lighted splint. What is gas B?
[1]
[Total: 4]
BLANK PAGE
4 Solid E was analysed. E was an aluminium salt. Some of the observations are shown below.
test 1
colourless drops of liquid formed at the top of
the tube
A little of solid E was heated in a test-tube.
The solution was divided into four test-tubes and the following tests were carried out.
(i) test 2
observations [1]
observations [1]
(iii) test 3
Drops of aqueous ammonia solution were added to the second test-tube. Excess
ammonia solution was then added.
observations
[2]
Two further tests are carried out and the following observations made.
test 4
test 5
effervescence
To the fourth test-tube of solution, aqueous
sodium hydroxide and aluminium foil were pungent gas given off
added.
gas turned damp litmus paper blue
The mixture was warmed carefully.
[1]
[1]
[2]
[2]
[Total: 10]
(a) E210 is benzoic acid. How could you show that a solution of benzoic acid is a weak acid?
test
result [2]
[4]
[Total: 6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/06
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical For Examination from 2016
SPECIMEN MARK SCHEME
1 hour
MAXIMUM MARK: 40
The syllabus is accredited for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
2 (a) volume boxes completed correctly 0, 13, 22, 30, 36, 43, 49
note: all 7 correct = 2, 6 correct = 1, <6 correct = 0 [2]
(c) appropriate scale on x-axis and y-axis and labels and units; [1]
note: scale should cover at least half of grid
points plotted to ± half a small square accuracy;; [2]
note: >12 correct = 2, 10–12 correct = 1, <10 correct = 0
two labelled smooth line graphs and must plot volume at t = 0; [1]
(d) Experiment 1 / acid X and statement that acid X is stronger or more concentrated / ora [1]
(h) graduated pipette / burette / gas syringe / mass of magnesium rather than strips / repeats
and take average / take more frequent readings / suitable method for reducing initial loss of
gas and any suitable comment on improved accuracy; [1]
note: explanation must relate to reason
(b) damp blue litmus paper / Universal indicator paper / pH paper; [1]
bleaches / turns white; [1]
(c) ammonia
not: ammonium [1]
CHEMISTRY 0620/01
*0123456789*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate answer sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 18.
Electronic calculators may be used.
1 The diagrams show the arrangement of particles in three different physical states of substance X.
7
4 The nucleon number and proton number of the lithium atom are shown by the symbol 3
Li.
What is the correct symbol for the lithium ion in lithium chloride?
6 6 7 7
A 2
Li– B 3
Li+ C 3
Li+ D 3
Li–
A 5 B 31 C 32 D 63
Mg 12 24 12 W 12
Mg2+ X 24 12 12 10
F 9 19 9 Y 9
F– 9 19 9 10 Z
W X Y Z
A 10 10 9 9
B 10 12 10 9
C 12 10 9 10
D 12 12 10 10
key
+ = proton
+ +
– – n = neutron
n n
– = electron
A B C D
+ + + + + + + + + + +
– – – – – – – –
n n n n n n n n n
R 2,4
T 2,8
X 2,8,1
Z 2,8,7
Which row shows how many electrons there could be in the outer shell of an atom of X?
1 2 6 7
A 9 9 8 8
B 9 8 9 8
C 8 8 9 9
D 8 9 8 9
10 Which diagram does not show the outer shell electrons in the molecule correctly?
A B C D
H H H Cl H C H Cl Cl
W NaAl Si3O8
X CaAl2Si2O8
12 The diagram shows apparatus used in an attempt to electroplate a metal ring with copper.
battery
+ –
bulb
13 Three electrolysis cells are set up. Each cell has inert electrodes.
15 The apparatus shown can be used to measure the rate of some chemical reactions.
gas syringe
reaction mixture
16 A student investigates the rate of reaction between magnesium and excess sulfuric acid.
The volume of hydrogen given off in the reaction is measured over time.
R
volume of S
hydrogen
given off
time
A A catalyst is added in S.
B The acid is more concentrated in R than in S.
C The magnesium is less finely powdered in R than in S.
D The temperature in R is lower than in S.
17 When pink cobalt(II) chloride crystals are heated they form steam and a blue solid.
When water is added to the blue solid, it turns pink and becomes hot.
Which terms describe the pink cobalt(II) chloride crystals and the reactions?
A aqueous irreversible
B anhydrous reversible
C hydrated irreversible
D hydrated reversible
18 The red colour in some pottery glazes may be formed as a result of the reactions shown.
heat
CuCO3 CuO + CO2
1 2
A CO2 SnO2
B CuCO3 CuO
C CuO SnO
D SnO CuO
A decomposition
B fermentation
C neutralisation
D oxidation
21 A solution contains barium ions and silver ions and one type of anion.
A chloride only
B nitrate only
C sulfate only
D chloride or nitrate or sulfate
22 A mixture containing two anions was tested and the results are shown below.
test result
23 Astatine is an element in Group VII of the Periodic Table. It has only ever been produced in very
small amounts.
24 The diagram shows the positions of elements L, M, Q, R and T in the Periodic Table.
R T
M Q
25 The table compares the properties of Group I elements with those of transition elements.
26 X is a monatomic gas.
gas X
A X burns in air.
B X is coloured.
C X is unreactive.
D X will displace iodine from potassium iodide.
Which set of properties help to explain the use of aluminium for cooking and storing food?
A B
– + – +
+ – + –
– + – +
C D
29 The table shows the results of adding three metals, P, Q and R, to dilute hydrochloric acid and to
water.
Q no reaction no reaction
A P R Q
B P Q R
C R Q P
D R P Q
30 The table gives the composition of the atmosphere of four newly discovered planets.
A W only
B W, X and Z
C W and Y only
D W, Y and Z
heat
limewater
A brown solid is formed in the reaction tube and the limewater turns cloudy.
What is compound X?
A calcium oxide
B copper(II) oxide
C magnesium oxide
D sodium oxide
heat with an
ammonium compound
ammonia
substance Y
a salt
heat with
dilute acid
A an alcohol
B a base
C a catalyst
D a metal
After three days, the water level inside the test-tube has risen.
water
Two of these gases are emitted into the atmosphere as a result of processes within animals.
1 2 3 4
35 To grow rose plants, a fertiliser containing nitrogen, phosphorus and potassium is often used.
For the best rose flowers, the fertiliser should contain a high proportion of potassium.
proportion by mass
fertiliser
N P K
A 9 0 25
B 13 13 20
C 29 5 0
D 29 15 5
36 Air containing an acidic impurity was neutralised by passing it through a column containing
substance X.
substance X
What is substance X?
A calcium oxide
B sand
C sodium chloride
D concentrated sulfuric acid
refinery gases
gasoline
X
pre-heat diesel oil
400 °C Y
Z
X Y Z
H H H H H H H H H H
C C H C C C C H H C C C C C C H
H H H H H H H H H H
A B C D
H H H O H H H H
H C C H H C C O H H C C H H C C O H
H H H H H H H
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/01
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) For examination from 2020
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Specimen
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 D 21 B
2 C 22 B
3 C 23 A
4 C 24 B
5 D 25 A
6 D 26 C
7 A 27 D
8 C 28 D
9 C 29 A
10 D 30 D
11 B 31 B
12 D 32 B
13 A 33 A
14 B 34 D
15 C 35 B
16 B 36 A
17 D 37 D
18 D 38 B
19 C 39 C
20 C 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/02
*0123456789*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate answer sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 18.
Electronic calculators may be used.
1 Amino acids are colourless and can be separated and identified by chromatography.
glass cover
beaker
chromatography
paper solvent
What additional apparatus is required to identify the amino acids present in a mixture?
A a locating agent
B a ruler
C a ruler and a locating agent
D neither a ruler or a locating agent
2 The diagram shows the diffusion of hydrogen chloride and ammonia in a glass tube.
The gases are given off by the solutions at each end of the tube.
When hydrogen chloride and ammonia mix they produce a white solid, ammonium chloride.
A B C D
key
+ = proton
+ +
– – n = neutron
n n
– = electron
A B C D
+ + + + + + + + + + +
– – – – – – – –
n n n n n n n n n
Mg 12 24 12 W 12
Mg2+ X 24 12 12 10
F 9 19 9 Y 9
F– 9 19 9 10 Z
W X Y Z
A 10 10 9 9
B 10 12 10 9
C 12 10 9 10
D 12 12 10 10
5 Iron is a metal. The structure of iron is described as a lattice of positive ions in a sea of electrons.
2 iron has a high melting point due to the strong covalent bonds
3 iron is an alloy
4 iron is malleable because the layers of atoms can slide over one another
A 1 only
B 1 and 3
C 1 and 4
D 2, 3 and 4
R 2,4
T 2,8
X 2,8,1
Z 2,8,7
H H
C C
H H
A 15 B 37 C 74 D 148
W NaAl Si3O8
X CaAl2Si2O8
10 What is the concentration of a solution containing 1.0 g of sodium hydroxide in 250 cm3 of
solution?
11 Four students prepared hydrated copper(II) sulfate by adding an excess of dilute sulfuric acid to
copper(II) oxide.
Mr = 80 Mr = 250
After the copper(II) sulfate had crystallised the students dried and weighed the crystals.
Which student produced the highest percentage yield of hydrated copper(II) sulfate?
A 4.0 11.5
B 8.0 23.5
C 12.0 35.0
D 16.0 46.5
What is the total volume of gas remaining at the end of the reaction?
A 400 cm3
B 450 cm3
C 490 cm3
D 520 cm3
V
metal 1 metal 2
14 Three electrolysis cells are set up. Each cell has inert electrodes.
2 Electrons move around the circuit from the cathode to the anode.
Which statements about the electrolysis of concentrated copper(II) chloride are correct?
A 1 and 3
B 1 and 4
C 2 and 3
D 2 and 4
2H2O → 2H2 + O2
N2O4(g) ⇌ 2NO2(g)
Which conditions will give the largest yield of nitrogen dioxide, NO2?
temperature pressure
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
18 The apparatus shown can be used to measure the rate of some chemical reactions.
gas syringe
reaction mixture
19 A student investigates the rate of reaction between magnesium and excess sulfuric acid.
The volume of hydrogen given off in the reaction is measured over time.
R
volume of S
hydrogen
given off
time
A A catalyst is added in S.
B The acid is more concentrated in R than in S.
C The magnesium is less finely powdered in R than in S.
D The temperature in R is lower than in S.
A Cu2+ + 2e– p Cu
B Fe2O3 + 3CO p 2Fe + 3CO2
C HCl + NaOH p NaCl + H2O
D Mg + ZnSO4 p Zn + MgSO4
21 The red colour in some pottery glazes may be formed as a result of the reactions shown.
heat
CuCO3 CuO + CO2
1 2
A CO2 SnO2
B CuCO3 CuO
C CuO SnO
D SnO CuO
A ammonia
B ammonium hydroxide
C none of them
D water
A W Z X Y
B X Y W Z
C Z X Y W
D Z W X Y
24 A solution contains barium ions and silver ions and one type of anion.
A chloride only
B nitrate only
C sulfate only
D chloride or nitrate or sulfate
25 A mixture containing two anions was tested and the results are shown below.
test result
W X
Z Y
27 Astatine is an element in Group VII of the Periodic Table. It has only ever been produced in very
small amounts.
28 The table shows the results of adding three metals, P, Q and R, to dilute hydrochloric acid and to
water.
Q no reaction no reaction
A P R Q
B P Q R
C R Q P
D R P Q
heat
limewater
A brown solid is formed in the reaction tube and the limewater turns cloudy.
What is compound X?
A calcium oxide
B copper(II) oxide
C magnesium oxide
D sodium oxide
30 Zinc is extracted from zinc blende. Zinc blende is an ore of zinc and consists mainly of zinc
sulfide.
One of the steps in the process involves zinc sulfide reacting with oxygen from the air.
C 2ZnS + O2 → 2ZnO + S
carbon dioxide in
atmosphere
gradual production of
fossil fuels
coal, oil
and
natural gas
A combustion
B photosynthesis
C respiration
D transpiration
A 2CO + O2 → 2CO2
C 2NO2 → N2 + 2O2
heat with an
ammonium compound
ammonia
substance Y
a salt
heat with
dilute acid
A an alcohol
B a base
C a catalyst
D a metal
34 Which row shows the conditions for the manufacture of sulfuric acid?
35 Air containing an acidic impurity was neutralised by passing it through a column containing
substance X.
substance X
What is substance X?
A calcium oxide
B sand
C sodium chloride
D concentrated sulfuric acid
refinery gases
gasoline
X
pre-heat diesel oil
400 °C Y
Z
X Y Z
Which row describes the type of reaction that ethane and ethene undergo?
ethane ethene
A addition addition
B addition substitution
C substitution substitution
D substitution addition
Which acid and alcohol react together to form the following ester?
O
CH3CH2 C
OCH3
H O H O
C N C N C N C
H O
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/02
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) For examination from 2020
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Specimen
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 D
2 D 22 D
3 A 23 D
4 D 24 B
5 C 25 B
6 C 26 C
7 B 27 A
8 C 28 A
9 B 29 B
10 B 30 A
11 B 31 C
12 C 32 B
13 B 33 B
14 A 34 A
15 A 35 A
16 A 36 D
17 B 37 B
18 C 38 D
19 B 39 B
20 A 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/03
*0123456789*
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
diamond chlorine
= carbon atom = chlorine atom
diamond
chlorine
[4]
(b) The structure of a compound containing carbon and chlorine is shown below.
Cl Cl
Cl Cl
C
Cl C C Cl
Cl C C Cl
C
Cl Cl
Cl Cl
[1]
[1]
density in liquid
element boiling point / °C colour
state / g per cm3
bromine –7 red-brown
[1]
(iii) Describe the trend in boiling point of the halogens down the group.
[1]
(d) (i) Complete the word equation for the reaction of bromine with aqueous potassium iodide.
«««««««... [2]
(ii) Suggest why bromine does not react with aqueous potassium chloride.
[1]
solubility in water?
electrical conductivity?
[2]
[Total: 13]
[1]
(b) A teacher placed a small amount of liquid bromine in the bottom of a sealed gas jar of air.
After two minutes red-brown fumes were seen just above the liquid surface. After one hour
the red-brown colour had spread completely throughout the gas jar.
air
liquid
bromine
[3]
[Total: 4]
A B C
K+ NO3– K+
N N
H H NO3– K+ NO3– I I
H I
K+ NO3– K+
D E
N
N N O O
(c) a gas which turns damp red litmus paper blue, [1]
[Total: 6]
4 The diagram shows a rotary lime kiln used to make lime from limestone.
Limestone is fed in at the top of the kiln and lime comes out at the bottom.
hot air
lime
[1]
(b) State the name of the type of chemical reaction that takes place in the kiln.
[1]
(c) Suggest why the air coming out of the kiln has a greater percentage of carbon dioxide than
the air entering the kiln.
[1]
[1]
gas syringe
metal carbonate
heat
State one thing that must be kept constant if the rates of the three reactions are to be
compared in a fair way.
[1]
(f) The graph shows the volume of carbon dioxide released when the three metal carbonates
were heated.
50
calcium
40 carbonate
30 strontium
volume of carbonate
carbon dioxide
/ cm3
20
barium
carbonate
10
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
time / minutes
[1]
(ii) What volume of carbon dioxide was produced by strontium carbonate in twelve minutes?
[1]
(iii) How do the rates of the reactions of these three metal carbonates relate to the position
of calcium, strontium and barium in the Periodic Table?
[2]
(g) Describe how hydrochloric acid and limewater can be used to show that carbonate ions are
present in calcium carbonate.
[3]
[Total: 12]
(a) State three properties of transition elements which are not shown by the Group I elements.
1.
2.
3. [3]
(b) The symbols for two isotopes of iron are shown below.
54 57
26
Fe 26
Fe
[1]
57
(ii) Determine the number of neutrons present in one atom of the isotope 26
Fe.
[1]
[1]
method
[2]
[2]
(e) In the blast furnace, iron(III) oxide reacts with carbon monoxide.
substance
explanation
[2]
(f) (i) Carbon monoxide is a pollutant gas produced in motor car engines.
State why carbon monoxide is formed.
[1]
[1]
[Total: 14]
concentrated
hydrochloric acid
[1]
(c) State the name of the gas given off at the negative electrode.
[1]
(d) Complete the following sentence about electrolysis using words from the list.
(i) Draw the shells and the electronic structure in an atom of chlorine.
[1]
[2]
test
result [2]
«««««««« [2]
[Total: 14]
nitrogen
oxygen
other gases
[1]
(ii) Apart from nitrogen and oxygen, state the names of two gases present in unpolluted air.
and [2]
(b) The percentage of oxygen in air can be found using the apparatus shown below.
gas syringe
heat
Air is passed backwards and forwards over the heated copper using the syringes. The
copper reacts with oxygen in the air.
[1]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 6]
[1]
(ii) Complete the symbol equation for the manufacture of ethene from dodecane, C12H26.
(b) Two fractions obtained from the distillation of petroleum are refinery gas and gasoline.
State one use of each of these fractions.
refinery gas
gasoline [2]
unsaturated
hydrocarbon [2]
fermentation
(ii) Draw the structure of ethanol, showing all atoms and bonds.
[2]
[Total: 11]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/03
Paper 3 Theory (Core) For examination from 2020
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Specimen
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
1 (a) diamond:
covalent;
giant structure / macromolecule;
chlorine: any two of:
molecule;
covalent;
diatomic; [4]
iodine [1]
not: iodide
electrical conductivity:
ionic compounds conduct electricity when molten / in (aqueous) solution
and molecular compounds do not [1]
note: both needed for mark
(c) carbon dioxide has been removed from the limestone / it comes from the limestone / carbon
dioxide is a product [1]
(d) neutralising acidic soils / treating acidic lakes / flue gas desulfurisation
allow: any suitable use [1]
(e) temperature of Bunsen / distance of Bunsen from the tube / mass of carbonate used / owtte
[1]
(iii) calcium faster than strontium which is faster than barium / idea of
trend down the group; [1]
correct trend, i.e. less rapid reaction the further down the group / ora; [1]
(ii) 31 [1]
(iii) 23 [1]
(c) suitable method, e.g. coating with paint / zinc / unreactive metal / plastic / oil / grease /
galvanising / sacrificial protection; [1]
suitable reason, e.g. stops air / water reaching surface; [1]
note: reason must be consequential to the method chosen
(f) (i) incomplete combustion / insufficient or limited or not enough oxygen [1]
(ii) toxic / suffocates you / stops red blood cells carrying oxygen / binds with hemoglobin in
place of oxygen [1]
6 (a) break down (of substance / electrolyte) by electricity / splitting up of substance by electricity /
decomposition by electricity [1]
allow: current / voltage for electricity
(b) (i) decreases / gets less / gets lower / gets used up [1]
(c) any suitable use e.g. electrical conductor / electrical wiring / saucepans [1]
8 (a) (i) (group of) molecules with similar boiling points / (group of) molecules with similar relative
molecular masses / molecules with limited range of boiling points / molecules with limited
range of molecular masses / molecules coming off at the same place in the fractionation
column / owtte [1]
(ii) C10H22
allow: reasonable mixtures, e.g. C7H16 + C3H6 [1]
(b) refinery gas: (fuel) for heating / (fuel) for cars / (fuel) for cooking; [1]
gasoline: (fuel) for cars / mowers etc.; [1]
(d) (i) 1st box down ticked (catalytic addition of steam) [1]
CHEMISTRY 0620/04
*0123456789*
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
[1]
(b) State all the substances that are liquid at room temperature.
[1]
(c) Which substance could have a macromolecular structure similar to that of silicon(IV) oxide?
[1]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 5]
A 15 15 16
B 15 18 16
C 15 15 17
(a) What is the evidence in the table for each of the following?
[1]
[1]
[2]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 6]
3 Kinetic theory explains the properties of matter in terms of the arrangement and movement of
particles.
(a) Nitrogen is a gas at room temperature. Nitrogen molecules, N2, are spread far apart and
move in a random manner at high speed.
[2]
(ii) Compare the movement and arrangement of the molecules in solid nitrogen to those in
nitrogen gas.
[3]
(b) A sealed container contains nitrogen gas. The pressure of the gas is due to the molecules of
the gas hitting the walls of the container.
Use the kinetic theory to explain why the pressure inside the container increases when the
temperature is increased.
[2]
The following apparatus can be used to measure the rate of diffusion of a gas.
constant
pressure
applied metal foil,
gas escapes
gas syringe gas through small
hole in foil
nitrogen 25 1.00
chlorine 25 0.63
nitrogen 50 1.05
(c) (i) Explain why nitrogen gas diffuses faster than chlorine gas.
[2]
(ii) Explain why the nitrogen gas diffuses faster at the higher temperature.
[1]
[Total: 10]
(a) (i) State two differences in the physical properties of chromium and sodium.
[2]
(ii) State two differences in the chemical properties of chromium and sodium.
[2]
(b) Chromium is used to electroplate steel objects. The diagram shows how this could be done.
+ –
(i) Give two reasons why steel objects are plated with chromium.
[2]
(ii) The formula of the chromium(III) ion is Cr3+ and of the sulfate ion is SO42–. Give the
formula of chromium(III) sulfate.
[1]
(iii) Write the ionic half-equation for the reaction at the negative electrode (cathode).
[2]
(iv) A colourless gas, which relights a glowing splint, is formed at the positive electrode
(anode).
[1]
(v) During electroplating, it is necessary to add more chromium(III) sulfate but during
copper plating using a copper anode, it is not necessary to add more copper(II) sulfate.
[2]
[Total: 12]
waste gases
raw materials::
coke, C
iron ore, Fe2O3
firebrick lining limestone, CaCO3
air
slag
molten iron
Include one equation for a redox reaction and one for an acid/base reaction.
[5]
[Total: 5]
BLANK PAGE
(a) Complete this method of preparing dry crystals of the soluble salt
cobalt(II) chloride-6-water from the insoluble base cobalt(II) carbonate.
step 1
Add an excess of cobalt(II) carbonate to hot dilute hydrochloric acid.
step 2
step 3
step 4
[4]
(b) (i) 5.95 g of cobalt(II) carbonate were added to 40 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, concentration
2.0 mol / dm3.
Calculate the maximum yield of cobalt(II) chloride-6-water and show that the cobalt(II)
carbonate was in excess.
maximum yield:
number of moles of HCl used = «««««««««.««« (use your value from above)
(ii) Explain how these calculations show that cobalt(II) carbonate is in excess.
[1]
[Total: 10]
I2 + Cl2 → 2ICl
[2]
(b) When the equilibrium mixture is heated, it becomes a darker brown colour.
Suggest if the reverse reaction is endothermic or exothermic. Give a reason for your choice.
[1]
(i) How would this affect the position of equilibrium? Give a reason for your choice.
reason
[1]
[1]
(d) Calculate the overall energy change for the reaction between iodine and chlorine using the
bond energy values shown.
I2 + Cl2 → 2ICl
I–I 151
Cl – Cl 242
I – Cl 208
[3]
(e) Draw a labelled energy level diagram for the reaction between iodine and chlorine using the
information in (d).
[2]
[Total: 10]
[3]
(b) The following two alcohols are members of an homologous series and they are isomers.
[2]
(ii) Deduce the structural formula of another alcohol which is also an isomer of these
alcohols.
[1]
mineral wool
soaked in butanol copper(II) oxide
heat
liquid X
formed by
oxidation of
butanol.
(i) Give the name of another reagent which can oxidise butanol.
[1]
[1]
[1]
(d) The alcohol ethanol can be made by fermentation. Yeast is added to aqueous glucose.
Carbon dioxide is given off and the mixture becomes warm, as the reaction is exothermic.
The graph shows how the rate of reaction varies over several days.
rate of
reaction
time
[2]
[1]
[2]
[Total: 14]
BLANK PAGE
[2]
[2]
(c) The polymer known as PVA is used in paints and adhesives. Its structural formula is shown
below.
―CH2―CH―CH2―CH―
│ │
OCOCH3 OCOCH3
[1]
[3]
[Total: 8]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/04
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) For examination from 2020
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Specimen
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
1 (a) A [1]
(c) E [1]
(d) B [1]
(e) C [1]
(ii) all have the same number of protons / same proton number / same atomic number [1]
(iii) same number of protons / same proton number / same atomic number; [1]
different number of neutrons / different nucleon number / different mass number; [1]
(ii) non-metal because it accepts electrons / needs 3e to complete outer energy level /
because it is in Group V or 5e in outer shell [1]
note: need both non-metal and reason for one mark
3 (a) (i) 6e between two nitrogen atoms; note: can be any combination of dots or crosses [1]
1 lone pair on each nitrogen atom; [1]
(ii) (at higher temperature) molecules move faster / have more energy [1]
(v) to replace chromium ions (used to plate steel) / chromium ions used up; [1]
copper ions replaced from copper anode; [1]
number of moles of HCl used = 0.08 note: must use their value
allow: ecf
number of moles of CoCO3 in 5.95 g of cobalt(II) carbonate = 5.95/119 = 0.05; [1]
(b) endothermic and because this direction is favoured by high temperatures; [1]
note: reason is required
(c) (i) move to left hand side / reactants favoured and because bigger volume / more moles on
left hand side [1]
note: reason is required
(ii) less (yellow) solid / more (dark brown) liquid / green gas visible / turns darker brown /
smell chlorine [1]
allow: ecf from (c)(i)
9 (a) addition: polymer is the only product / only one product; [1]
condensation: polymer and water formed / small molecule formed; [1]
(d) -OC(CH2)4CONH(CH2)6NH-
amide linkage correct; [1]
correct repeat units; [1]
continuation bonds shown; [1]
CHEMISTRY 0620/05
*0123456789*
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between excess magnesium and two different dilute
acids, X and Y.
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
(a) Experiment 1
bung
inverted 100 cm3
measuring cylinder
conical flask
water
trough
Remove the bung from the conical flask and move the measuring cylinder away from the
delivery tube without letting any water run out. Twist one of the strips of magnesium to break
it into four pieces and place all four pieces into the conical flask.
Using a different measuring cylinder, measure 50 cm3 of dilute acid X. Pour it into the conical
flask and replace the bung firmly. Place the measuring cylinder back over the delivery tube
and start the timer. In the table, record the volume of gas collected in the measuring cylinder
every 30 seconds for three minutes.
(b) Experiment 2
(c) Plot the results you have obtained for both experiments on the grid below. For each set of
results, draw a smooth line graph. Indicate clearly which line represents Experiment 1 and
which line represents Experiment 2.
[4]
(d) State which experiment had the faster rate of reaction and suggest why the rate was faster in
this experiment.
[1]
(e) From your graph, deduce the time required to collect 25 cm3 of gas in Experiment 1.
Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your answer.
[1]
volume of gas / cm 3
rate =
time taken / s
For the experiment with the higher rate, calculate the rate of reaction for the first 30 seconds
of the reaction. Deduce the units.
rate [2]
(g) A student suggested that the magnesium should be rubbed with sandpaper before starting
the experiment. Explain why the magnesium should be rubbed with sandpaper.
[2]
(h) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder to add the acids to
the flask.
advantage
disadvantage [2]
[1]
[Total: 17]
BLANK PAGE
2 You are provided with a mixture of two solids, C and D. Solid C is water-soluble and D is
insoluble in water. Carry out the following tests on C and D, recording all of your observations at
each stage.
Add 15 cm3 of distilled water to the mixture in the boiling tube. Stopper and shake the boiling tube
for two minutes. Filter the contents of the tube, keeping the filtrate and residue for the following
tests.
(a) (i) To about 1 cm3 of the solution, add a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
observation [1]
observation [1]
(b) To about 1 cm3 of the solution add an equal volume of aqueous ammonia.
observation [1]
(c) To about 1 cm3 of the solution add excess aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Now add a small piece of aluminium foil and warm the mixture carefully. Test any gases
given off.
observation
[2]
[2]
Wash the residue in the filter paper with a little distilled water.
Using a spatula, transfer some of the solid residue from the filter paper into two test-tubes.
(e) Heat the solid in the first test-tube gently and then strongly. Leave the test-tube to cool.
observation
[2]
(f) (i) Add about 2 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid to the second test-tube. Test any gases given
off. Keep this liquid for (f)(ii).
observation
[2]
(ii) After two minutes, add an equal volume of distilled water and shake the test-tube.
Decant off the liquid and divide the liquid into two approximately equal portions.
To the first portion add aqueous sodium hydroxide a little at a time until in excess.
observation
[2]
(iii) To the second portion add aqueous ammonia a little at a time until in excess.
observation
[2]
[2]
[Total: 17]
(a) E210 is benzoic acid. How could you show that a solution of benzoic acid is a weak acid?
test
result [2]
[4]
[Total: 6]
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp, red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/05
Paper 5 Practical Test For examination from 2020
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Specimen
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
(c) appropriate scale on x-axis and y-axis and labels and units; [1]
note: scale should cover at least half of grid
points plotted to ± half a small square accuracy;; [2]
note: >12 correct = 2, 10–12 correct = 1, <10 correct = 0
two labelled smooth line graphs and must plot volume at t = 0; [1]
(d) Experiment 1 / acid X and statement that acid X is stronger or more concentrated / ora [1]
(e) value from graph to ± half a small square accuracy and indication shown on graph [1]
(i) graduated pipette / burette / gas syringe / mass of magnesium rather than strips / repeats
and take average / take more frequent readings / suitable method for reducing initial loss of
gas and any suitable comment on improved accuracy; [1]
note: explanation must relate to reason
CHEMISTRY 0620/06
*0123456789*
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
1 The diagram shows the apparatus used to prepare a dry sample of a gas. The gas is more dense
than air.
stand and
clamp
concentrated
sulfuric acid
[1]
(c) Suggest a reason why the gas is passed through concentrated sulfuric acid.
[1]
[Total: 5]
2 A student investigated the rate of reaction between excess magnesium and two different dilute
acids, X and Y.
Experiment 1
trough water
Using a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of dilute acid X was poured into the conical flask.
0.5 g of magnesium ribbon was added to the conical flask and the bung added.
The timer was started and the volume of gas collected in the measuring cylinder was measured
every 30 seconds for three minutes.
(a) Use the measuring cylinder diagrams to record the volumes of gas collected.
0
0 5
10
10
30 15
20
20
60 25
30
25
90 30
35
30
120 35
40
40
150 45
50
45
180 50
55
[2]
Experiment 2
(b) Use the measuring cylinder diagrams to record the volumes of gas collected.
0
0 5
10
0
30 5
10
5
60 10
15
10
90 15
20
10
120 15
20
15
150 20
25
15
180 20
25
[2]
(c) Plot the results for both experiments on the grid below. For each set of results, draw a
smooth line graph. Indicate clearly which line represents Experiment 1 and which line
represents Experiment 2.
[4]
(d) State which experiment had the faster rate of reaction and suggest why the rate was faster in
this experiment.
[1]
(e) From your graph, deduce the time required to collect 25 cm3 of gas in Experiment 1.
Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your answer.
[1]
volume of gas / cm 3
rate =
time taken / s
For the experiment with the higher rate, calculate the rate of reaction for the first 30 seconds
of the reaction. Deduce the units.
rate [2]
(g) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder to add the acids to
the flask.
advantage
disadvantage [2]
[1]
[Total: 15]
3 Concentrated aqueous sodium chloride was broken down by electricity using the apparatus
shown.
gas A gas B
concentrated aqueous
sodium chloride
electrodes
+ –
[1]
test
result [2]
(c) Gas B pops when tested with a lighted splint. What is gas B?
[1]
[Total: 4]
BLANK PAGE
4 Solid E was analysed. E was an aluminium salt. Some of the observations are shown below.
test 1
colourless drops of liquid formed at the top of
the tube
A little of solid E was heated in a test-tube.
The solution was divided into four test-tubes and the following tests were carried out.
(i) test 2
observations [1]
observations [1]
(iii) test 3
Drops of aqueous ammonia solution were added to the second test-tube. Excess
ammonia solution was then added.
observations
[2]
Two further tests are carried out and the following observations made.
test 4
test 5
effervescence
To the fourth test-tube of solution, aqueous
sodium hydroxide and aluminium foil were pungent gas given off
added.
gas turned damp litmus paper blue
The mixture was warmed carefully.
[1]
[1]
[2]
[2]
[Total: 10]
(a) E210 is benzoic acid. How could you show that a solution of benzoic acid is a weak acid?
test
result [2]
[4]
[Total: 6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/06
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical For examination from 2020
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Specimen
underline actual word given must be used by candidate (grammatical variants excepted)
() the word / phrase in brackets is not required but sets the context
2 (a) volume boxes completed correctly 0, 13, 22, 30, 36, 43, 49
note: all 7 correct = 2, 6 correct = 1, <6 correct = 0 [2]
(c) appropriate scale on x-axis and y-axis and labels and units; [1]
note: scale should cover at least half of grid
points plotted to ± half a small square accuracy;; [2]
note: >12 correct = 2, 10–12 correct = 1, <10 correct = 0
two labelled smooth line graphs and must plot volume at t = 0; [1]
(d) Experiment 1 / acid X and statement that acid X is stronger or more concentrated / ora [1]
(h) graduated pipette / burette / gas syringe / mass of magnesium rather than strips / repeats
and take average / take more frequent readings / suitable method for reducing initial loss of
gas and any suitable comment on improved accuracy; [1]
note: explanation must relate to reason
(b) damp blue litmus paper / Universal indicator paper / pH paper; [1]
bleaches / turns white; [1]
(c) ammonia
not: ammonium [1]
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice May/June 2011
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*9373386046*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
You may use a calculator.
IB11 06_0620_11/2RP
© UCLES 2011 [Turn over
2
1 The diagrams show the arrangement of particles in three different physical states of substance X.
Which method of separation would show that the solution contains ions of different colours?
A chromatography
B crystallisation
C distillation
D filtration
3 The table gives the solubility of four substances in ethanol and in water.
A mixture containing all four substances is added to ethanol, stirred and filtered.
solubility in
ethanol water
A insoluble insoluble
B insoluble soluble
C soluble insoluble
D soluble soluble
W 2,4
X 2,8
Y 2,8,1
Z 2,8,7
A B
C D
electronic structure
A 2,8,1
B 2,4
C 2,8,2
D 2,8
A B C D
7 The nucleon number and proton number of the lithium atom are shown by the symbol 73 Li .
What is the correct symbol for the lithium ion in lithium chloride?
6
A 2 Li− B 6
3 Li+ C 7
3 Li+ D 7
3 Li−
A 5 B 31 C 32 D 63
9 Electricity from a power station passes through overhead cables to a substation and then to a
school where it is used to electrolyse concentrated hydrochloric acid using inert electrodes.
Which substances are used for the overhead cables and for the electrodes?
A aluminium copper
B aluminium platinum
C copper platinum
D platinum aluminium
positive negative
+ –
electrode carbon electrode
rods
concentrated
aqueous sodium
chloride
What is the test for the gas formed at the positive electrode?
Which substances produce both carbon dioxide and water when used as a fuel?
A
B
C
D
14 The equation for the effect of heat on hydrated sodium carbonate is as shown.
A P, Q and R only
B P, Q and S only
C Q, R and S only
D P, Q, R and S
15 The apparatus shown can be used to measure the rate of some chemical reactions.
gas syringe
16 A student investigates the rate of reaction between magnesium and excess sulfuric acid.
The volume of hydrogen given off in the reaction is measured over time.
R
volume of S
hydrogen
given off
time
A A catalyst is added in S.
B The acid is more concentrated in R than in S.
C The magnesium is less finely powdered in R than in S.
D The temperature in R is lower than in S.
17 Carbon dioxide is an acidic oxide that reacts with aqueous calcium hydroxide.
A decomposition
B fermentation
C neutralisation
D oxidation
A chloride only
B nitrate only
C sulfate only
D chloride or nitrate or sulfate
20 A mixture containing two anions was tested and the results are shown below.
test result
21 X is a monatomic gas.
gas X
A X burns in air.
B X is coloured.
C X is unreactive.
D X will displace iodine from potassium iodide.
I II III IV V VI VII 0
V W X
Y Z
23 The equation shows the reaction between a halogen and aqueous bromide ions.
1 2 3
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
27 The table shows the results of adding three metals, P, Q and R, to dilute hydrochloric acid and to
water.
A P R Q
B P Q R
C R Q P
D R P Q
Which row lists a property that is not correct for the use given?
29 Which row describes the conditions used to make steel from the iron produced by a blast
furnace?
calcium oxide
oxygen heat
(lime)
A
B
C
D
30 Water from a reservoir flows to the water works where purification processes 1 takes place
followed by process 2.
purification purification
process 1 process 2
A chlorination filtration
B filtration chlorination
C fractional distillation filtration
D filtration fractional distillation
What is X?
A argon
B carbon dioxide
C nitrogen
D oxygen
32 The table gives the composition of the atmosphere of four newly discovered planets.
A W only
B W, X and Z
C W and Y only
D W, Y and Z
33 Statement 1: Alloying iron with other materials to form stainless steel prevents iron from rusting
by excluding oxygen.
Statement 2: Painting, oiling and electroplating are all methods of preventing iron from rusting.
Which is correct?
34 Which two substances, when reacted together, would form a salt that contains two of the
essential elements provided by fertilisers?
Two of these gases are emitted into the atmosphere as a result of processes within animals.
1 2 3 4
36 Compounds containing five carbon atoms in a molecule may have names beginning with ‘pent…’.
key
= carbon
= oxygen
= hydrogen
A pentane
B pentanoic acid
C pentanol
D pentene
waste
gases
petrol
paraffin
diesel
crude lubricating
oil vapour oils
bitumen
A cracking
B fermentation
C fractional distillation
D polymerisation
O H O O H H
H C H H C C H H C C C H
H H H
A carbon dioxide
B ethane
C hydrogen
D methane
A light
B sugar
C yeast
D water
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Tin Antimony Tellurium Xenon
0620/11/M/J/11
Indium Iodine
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2011 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2011 0620 11
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 D 21 C
2 A 22 B
3 B 23 B
4 C 24 D
5 C 25 D
6 A 26 A
7 C 27 A
8 D 28 C
9 B 29 A
10 C 30 B
11 A 31 C
12 B 32 D
13 B 33 D
14 B 34 A
15 C 35 D
16 B 36 C
17 C 37 C
18 B 38 B
19 B 39 D
20 B 40 A
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 May/June 2011
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may need to use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
Total
IB11 06_0620_21/4RP
© UCLES 2011 [Turn over
2
For
1 The structures of some substances containing nitrogen are shown below. Examiner’s
Use
A B C
K+ NO3– K+ Cl
N
H H NO3– K+ NO3–
N
H
+
K NO3 K – + Cl Cl
D E
N
N N
O O
(f) a salt?
[Total: 6]
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
51
23 V 28
[3]
isotopes are used in .......................... for treating patients with .......................... . [3]
vanadium is a non-metal
[2]
[Total: 9]
test ....................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Water vapour in the atmosphere reacts with sulfur dioxide, SO2, to produce acid rain.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
1. ................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................... [2]
[1]
(e) Water from lakes and rivers can be treated to make the water safer to drink.
step 1 ................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
step 2 ................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[1]
[Total: 14]
H H H H H H Br Br
H C C C H C C C H H C C H
H H H H H H H
D E
H H H H
C C H C C O H
H H n
H H
(i) a polymer,
(b) (i) Balance the equation for the complete combustion of compound A, C3H8.
[2]
(ii) State the name of two substances formed when compound A undergoes incomplete
combustion.
(c) Complete the structure of ethanoic acid to show all atoms and bonds.
H C
[1]
[Total: 9]
concentrated
hydrochloric acid
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) State the name of the gas given off at the negative electrode.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Complete the following sentence about electrolysis using words from the list.
[1]
[2]
test .............................................................................................................................
.............................
[2]
[Total: 14]
[1]
(ii) Iron is a metal between zinc and copper in the reactivity series.
Predict the reactivity of iron with
(b) The equation for the reaction of zinc with steam is:
Zn + H2O → ZnO + H2
[1]
(c) State three physical properties which are characteristic of most metals.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................................
3. ................................................................................................................................. [3]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) How does the hardness of these metals change down the group?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 10]
(b) In the converter, the oxygen oxidises sulfur, carbon and phosphorus to their oxides.
(i) Explain why sulfur dioxide and carbon dioxide are easily removed from the
converter.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Explain how calcium oxide is used to remove phosphorus(V) oxide from the
converter.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
A B C D
[1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 9]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) Bromine is very volatile, so it can be removed from solution by bubbling air through
the solution.
What do you understand by the term volatile ?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) Hydrogen reacts with bromine in the presence of a hot platinum catalyst to form hydrogen
bromide.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
State the names of three products formed when hydrobromic acid reacts with sodium
carbonate.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 9]
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/M/J/11
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2011 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2011 0620 21
2 (a) atoms of same element with different number of neutrons / same type of atom with different
mass number / atoms with same proton number but different number of neutrons / atoms
with same proton number but different nucleon number/ atoms with same atomic number but
different nucleon number [1]
OR
(d) (i) burning coal / burning fossil fuels / burning petrol petrol / burning specified fuel (as long
as it contains sulfur) / from volcanoes / from heating sulphide ores [1]
ignore burning pure substances e.g. hydrogen, methane / car exhausts
ignore from ores without qualification /
(e) In each of these points, the explanation mark depends on the correct step
(ii) B [1]
(iii) E [1]
(iv) C [1]
(c)
O
║
-C–O–H [1]
2 on left [1]
(ii) less hard (down the Group) / softer (down the Group) [1]
allow decreases (in hardness)
ignore from hard to soft / the softer is at the bottom and the harder at the top / gets softer
as melting point decreases
(b) (i) they are gases / gases escape easily / sulphur oxides are gases / named sulfur oxides
are gases / carbon dioxide is a gas / named oxide of carbon is gas / the products are
gases [1]
(ii) any suitable use e.g. chemical plant / cutlery / surgical instruments / (ball) bearings / [1]
allow facings of buildings (not buildings without qualification)
parts of aircraft engines (not aircraft without qualification)
bridges
car decoration / trim / radiator grills / exhaust pipes (not cars without qualification)
washing machine drums
razor blades
chemical tankers / road tankers (not tankers unqualified)
cooking utensils ignore for cooking
watches
(c) (i) substance which speeds up reaction / makes reaction go faster / lowers the activation
energy [1]
allow changes rate of reaction
ignore slows down reaction
(ii) it gains hydrogen / oxygen accepts hydrogen / hydrogen peroxide accepts hydrogen /
oxidation number of oxygen decreases [1]
allow it loses oxygen / hydrogen peroxide loses oxygen / hydrogen peroxide gains
electrons / oxygen gains electrons
ignore comments related to hydrogen bromide alone
[Total: 80]
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 (Extended) May/June 2011
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
Total
IB11 06_0620_31/4RP
© UCLES 2011 [Turn over
2
For
1 The following techniques are used to separate mixtures. Examiner’s
Use
A simple distillation B fractional distillation C evaporation
From this list, choose the most suitable technique to separate the following.
(a) methane from a mixture of the gases, methane and ethane .................. [1]
(c) glycine from a mixture of the amino acids, glycine and lysine ................... [1]
(d) iron filings from a mixture of iron filings and water .................. [1]
(e) zinc sulfate crystals from aqueous zinc sulfate .................. [1]
(f) hexane from a mixture of the liquids, hexane and octane .................. [1]
[Total: 6]
2 Selenium and sulfur are in Group VI. They have similar properties.
(a) One of the main uses of selenium is in photoelectric cells. These cells can change light
into electrical energy.
(i) Name a process which can change light into chemical energy.
....................................................................................................................................
(ii) Name a device which can change chemical energy into electrical energy.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(i) Selenium forms an ionic compound with potassium. Draw a diagram which shows
the formula of this ionic compound, the charges on the ions and the arrangement of
the valency electrons around the negative ion.
Use o to represent an electron from an atom of potassium.
Use x to represent an electron from an atom of selenium.
[3]
[3]
(iii) Predict two differences in the physical properties of these two compounds.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
What type of reagent is the selenide ion in this reaction? Give a reason for your choice.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 13]
3 Iron from the blast furnace is impure. It contains about 4 % carbon and 0.5 % silicon. Most
of this impure iron is used to make mild steel, an alloy of iron containing less then 0.25 %
carbon.
(a) A jet of oxygen is blown through the molten iron in the presence of a base, usually
calcium oxide. Explain how the percentage of carbon is reduced and how the silicon is
removed.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
(c) Both iron and steel have typical metallic structures - a lattice of positive ions and a sea
of electrons.
(i) Suggest an explanation for why they have high melting points.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Explain why, when a force is applied to a piece of steel, it does not break but just
changes its shape.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 11]
4 A major ore of zinc is zinc blende, ZnS. A by-product of the extraction of zinc from this ore is
sulfur dioxide which is used to make sulfuric acid.
(a) (i) Zinc blende is heated in air. Zinc oxide and sulfur dioxide are formed. Write the
balanced equation for this reaction.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Zinc oxide is reduced to zinc by heating with carbon. Name two other reagents
which could reduce zinc oxide.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(iii) The zinc obtained is impure. It is a mixture of metals. Explain how fractional distillation
could separate this mixture.
zinc bp = 908 °C, cadmium bp = 765 °C, lead bp = 1751 °C
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
temperature: 450 °C
pressure: 2 atmospheres
catalyst: vanadium(V) oxide
Explain, mentioning both position of equilibrium and rate, why these conditions give the
most economic yield.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
[Total: 10]
(a) It has the reactions of a typical strong acid. Complete the following equations.
(b) Two of the reactions in (a) are acid / base and one is redox. Which one is redox? Explain
your choice.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Describe how you could distinguish between hydriodic, HI(aq), and hydrobromic, HBr(aq)
acids, by bubbling chlorine through these two acids.
temperature
(i) Explain why the temperature increases rapidly at first then stops increasing.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Suggest why the temperature drops after the addition of 18.0 cm3 of acid.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) In another experiment, it was shown that 15.0 cm3 of the acid neutralised 20.0 cm3 of
aqueous sodium hydroxide, 1.00 mol / dm3. Calculate the concentration of the acid.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 12]
(i) Describe the chemistry of making butanol from petroleum by the following route.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
(b) Butanol can be oxidised to a carboxylic acid by heating with acidified potassium
manganate(VII). Give the name and structural formula of the carboxylic acid.
structural formula
[1]
(c) Butanol reacts with ethanoic acid to form a liquid, X, which has the sweet smell of
bananas. Its empirical formula is C3H6O and its Mr is 116.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) Draw the structural formula of X. Show all the individual bonds.
[2]
[Total: 12]
The experiments were repeated at the same temperature using the same number of moles
of powdered magnesium and aluminium.
metal B
metal A
volume of
hydrogen
metal C
time
(a) Identify metals A, B and C by choosing from zinc, magnesium and aluminium. Give a
reason for each choice.
metal A .............................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
metal B .............................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
metal C .............................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [5]
(b) Using ‘moles’, explain why two of the metals form the same volume of hydrogen but the
third metal forms a larger volume.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 8]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) Poly(dichloroethene) is used to package food. Draw its structure. The structural formula
of dichloroethene is shown below.
H Cl
C C
H Cl
[2]
(c) The polymer known as PVA is used in paints and adhesives. Its structural formula is
shown below.
CH2 CH CH2 CH
OOCCH3 OOCCH3
[1]
[3]
[Total: 8]
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/M/J/11
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2011 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2011 0620 31
(b) (i) any sensible suggestion – harder/stronger/can be tailored for a specific use/more
resistant to corrosion [1]
not steel does not rust
(c) (i) strong attractive forces / strong bonds / bonds hard to break / requires a lot of
energy to break bonds [1]
not between ions, not between positive and negative ions,
not between electrons
between positive ions and (negative) electrons / opposite charges attract [1]
(ii) two reagents from named metal(s) more reactive than zinc/carbon monoxide [2]
not hydrogen
(ii) zinc carbonate + hydriodic acid → zinc iodide + carbon dioxide + water [1]
(c) with hydriodic acid – iodine formed / goes dark brown / grey/black solid [1]
with hydrobromic acid – bromine formed / goes orange / yellow / brown / reddish brown / red
/ brown vapour [1]
note can accept brown for iodine provided bromine is different orange/brown etc.
(ii) C6H12O2
ignore CH3COOC4H9 [1]
(iii) correct structural formula of butyl ethanoate showing all bonds [2]
because both have valency of 2 / 1 mole of metal gives 1 mole of hydrogen / 1 mole of metal
reacts with 2 moles of acid [1]
bigger volume for aluminium because its valency is 3 / 1 mole of metal gives 1.5 moles of
hydrogen / 1 mole of metal reacts with 3 moles of acid [1]
If you encounter different reasoning which is correct, please award the appropriate marks.
(d) -OC(CH2)4CONH(CH2)6NH-
COND amide correct linkage [1]
correct repeat units [1]
continuation [1]
not NH2 or COOH endings
[Total: 80]
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2011
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*6110546425*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on page 2 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB11 06_0620_51CI/5RP
© UCLES 2011 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
(d) 100 cm3 of aqueous potassium manganate(VII), KMnO4, of concentration 3.2 g / dm3, labelled
solution A
(e) 100 cm3 of aqueous potassium manganate(VII), KMnO4 of concentration 6.4 g / dm3, labelled
solution B
(f) 100 cm3 of aqueous hydrogen peroxide, H2O2. This solution should be freshly made, i.e.
the day before, and be of concentration 35 cm3 of 20 volume hydrogen peroxide in 1 dm3 of
0.5 mol / dm3 sulfuric acid, labelled solution C. (20 volume hydrogen peroxide is equivalent to
6 % hydrogen peroxide or 1.667 M)
(l) splints
(m) a spatula
(n) test-tube
25 cm3 of solution C should require approximately 32 cm3 of solution A for the end-point.
For Question 2
[F][H] (a) a stoppered test-tube containing about 10 cm3 of ethanol, labelled liquid M
(b) a stoppered test-tube containing about 10 cm3 of aqueous potassium iodide, labelled
liquid N, of concentration 0.1 mol / dm3
[N][H] (c) two stoppered, dry test-tubes, each containing one crystal of iodine, labelled iodine
(e) splints
[N][H] (j) aqueous silver nitrate of suitable concentration to give a positive halide test
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
JUNE 2011
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2011
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
IB11 06_0620_51/4RP
© UCLES 2011 [Turn over
2
For
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between two different solutions of potassium Examiner’s
manganate(VII), A and B, and an acidic solution of substance C. Use
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
You are going to carry out three experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Fill the burette with the solution A of potassium manganate(VII) to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
Using a measuring cylinder, pour 25 cm3 of solution C into the conical flask.
Add 1 cm3 of the solution A to the flask, with shaking. Continue to add solution A to the
flask until the mixture just turns permanently pink. Record the burette readings in the
table and complete the table.
Pour away the contents of the conical flask and rinse the flask with distilled water.
(b) Experiment 2
Empty the burette and rinse it first with distilled water, and then with a little of solution B.
Fill the burette with the solution B of potassium manganate(VII) solution to the 0.0 cm3
mark.
Repeat Experiment 1.
Record the burette readings in the table and complete the table.
(c) Experiment 3
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(e) (i) What colour change was observed when potassium manganate(VII) solution was
added to the flask in Experiment 1.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(f) (i) In which experiment was the greatest volume of potassium manganate(VII) solution
used?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(g) If Experiment 2 was repeated using 12.5 cm3 of solution C, what volume of potassium
manganate(VII) solution would be used? Explain your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(h) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder for solution C.
advantage .........................................................................................................................
[Total: 21]
tests observations
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 19]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/51 Paper 5 (Practical), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2011 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2011 0620 51
(g) half the value of the result for experiment 2 (1) cm3 (1)
half the volume of C used (1) [3]
[Total: 40]
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2011
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part For Examiner’s Use
question.
1
Total
IB11 06_0620_61/5RP
© UCLES 2011 [Turn over
2
For
1 A student heated hydrated zinc sulfate crystals, ZnSO4.7H2O, using the apparatus below to Examiner’s
obtain a sample of water. Use
ice cubes
in water
(a) Complete the box to identify the piece of apparatus labelled. [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
test ....................................................................................................................................
[Total: 6]
eye
conical flask
printed sheet
printed text
A student used this method to investigate the effect of changing the concentration of the
sodium thiosulfate solution on the speed of the reaction.
The student used different concentrations of sodium thiosulfate solution.
All other variables were kept the same.
(a) Give two variables which were kept the same in the investigation.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. ................................................................................................................................. [2]
0.16
0.12
speed of reaction
/ arbitrary units
0.08
0.04
0.00
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3
concentration of sodium thiosulfate in mol / dm3
(c) Suggest two reasons why not all of the points lie on the line of best fit.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. ................................................................................................................................. [2]
(d) From your graph, deduce the speed of reaction when the concentration of sodium
thiosulfate is 0.075 mol / dm3. Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your
answer.
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Explain why the speed of reaction increases when the concentration of sodium thiosulfate
is increased.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(f) Sketch on the grid the line you would expect if the experiments were repeated at a higher
temperature. [1]
[Total: 10]
solvent
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
The results obtained for the colours in two different sweets, C and D, are shown below.
sweet sweet
C D
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) What conclusions can you draw about the colours present in sweets C and D?
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 6]
Experiment 1
A burette was filled with the solution A of potassium manganate(VII) up to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
Using a measuring cylinder, 25 cm3 of colourless hydrogen peroxide solution was poured into
the conical flask.
The potassium manganate(VII) solution A was added slowly to the flask, and shaken to mix
thoroughly. Addition of potassium manganate(VII) solution was continued until there was a
permanent pink colour in the contents of the flask.
(a) Use the burette diagram to record the volume in the table of results and complete the
column. [2]
31
32
33
final reading
Experiment 2
(b) Use the burette diagrams to record the volumes in the table of results and complete the
table. [2]
18 34
19 35
20 36
experiment 1 experiment 2
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) (i) What colour change was observed when potassium manganate(VII) solution was
added to the flask?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(e) (i) In which experiment was the greatest volume of potassium manganate(VII) solution
used?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(f) If Experiment 2 was repeated using 12.5 cm3 of the hydrogen peroxide solution, what
volume of potassium manganate(VII) solution would be needed to react completely?
Explain your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(g) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder for the
hydrogen peroxide solution.
advantage .........................................................................................................................
[Total: 16]
tests observations
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 7]
BLANK PAGE
5 cm3 of solution P was put into each of six test-tubes. Increasing volumes of solution Q were
added to each test-tube. The mixtures were filtered to obtain the precipitates, which were
washed, dried and then weighed in a suitable container.
(a) Draw a labelled diagram to show how the mixture was filtered.
[2]
5 1 4.50 4.95
5 2 4.50 5.45
5 3 4.50 5.90
5 4 4.50 6.40
5 5 4.50 6.85
5 6 4.50 6.85
[2]
2.0
1.5
mass of
precipitate / g
1.0
0.5
0.0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
volume of Q / cm3
[3]
(d) What is the minimum volume of Q required to completely react with 5 cm3 of P?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
Contains:
sodium hydroxide, sodium
hypochlorite
contact with acids liberates
chlorine
rinse container with water
before throwing out
test ....................................................................................................................................
(b) Suggest why it could be dangerous to pour fizzy drinks into a sink containing this liquid
cleaner.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Why should the container be rinsed with water before throwing out?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
test ....................................................................................................................................
[Total: 7]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2011 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2011 0620 61
(b) (i) (arrow) labelled heat in correct position under shaded crystals (1)
(ii) arrow labelled water in test-tube at or below the level of the ice (1) [2]
(b) straight line drawn with a ruler, missing anomalous point but touching all other points (1)
not multiple lines [1]
(c) any two sensible errors that could be from same category max 2
• qualified measurement error e.g. volume
• qualified timing error
• recording error
• plotting error
• temperature variation
• contamination from previous experiment
not systematic error max [2]
(e) more particles/particles closer together (1) more collisions (1) [2]
(f) sketch straight line to the LEFT of the original (1) [1]
4 Experiment 1
(a) and (b) initial and final volumes completed correctly (1) 0.0, 32.0
Experiment 2
(f) half value from table result for experiment 2 / 8 (1) cm3 (1)
half volume of peroxide used (1) [3]
6 (a) diagram of a filter paper in a funnel (1) label funnel/filter paper (1) [2]
(b) 0.45, 0.95, 1.40, 1.90, 2.35 and 2.35 (2), –1 for each incorrect up to 2 [2]
(c) all points plotted correctly (2), –1 for each incorrect point up to 2
two intersecting straight lines (1) ignore origin [3]
[Total: 60]
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice May/June 2012
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*3111298563*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
You may use a calculator.
IB12 06_0620_11/3RP
© UCLES 2012 [Turn over
2
key
A
different
atoms
2 Which method is most suitable to obtain zinc carbonate from a suspension of zinc carbonate in
water?
A crystallisation
B distillation
C evaporation
D filtration
3 A student investigates how the concentration of an acid affects the speed of reaction with a 0.5 g
mass of magnesium at 30 °C.
The student has a beaker, concentrated acid, water and the apparatus below.
P a balance
Q a clock
R a measuring cylinder
S a thermometer
A P, Q and R only
B P, Q and S only
C Q, R and S only
D P, Q, R and S
A Element Z has one more electron in its outer shell than element Y.
B Element Z has one more electron shell than element Y.
C Element Z is in the same group of the Periodic Table as element Y.
D Element Z is in the same period of the Periodic Table as element Y.
conducts electricity
volatile
when solid when molten
A
B
C
D
key
P Q = electron
8 The diagrams show the structures of two forms, P and Q, of a solid element.
P Q
A drilling drilling
B lubricating drilling
C drilling lubricating
D lubricating lubricating
9 The equation for the reaction between magnesium and dilute sulfuric acid is shown.
Mg + H2SO4 → MgSO4 + H2
Mr of MgSO4 is 120
Which mass of magnesium sulfate will be formed if 12 g of magnesium are reacted with sulfuric
acid?
A 5g B 10 g C 60 g D 120 g
10 Winston Churchill, a British Prime Minister, had his false teeth electroplated with gold.
The teeth were coated with a thin layer of carbon and were then placed in the apparatus shown.
switch
X Y
aqueous solution
of a gold salt
A negative diamond
B negative graphite
C positive diamond
D positive graphite
11 The diagram shows that two gases are formed when concentrated hydrochloric acid is
electrolysed using inert electrodes.
+ve –ve
concentrated
hydrochloric acid
Which row correctly describes the colours of the gases at the electrodes?
A colourless colourless
B colourless yellow-green
C yellow-green colourless
D yellow-green yellow-green
12 The diagram shows the reaction between zinc oxide and dilute hydrochloric acid.
dilute aqueous
hydrochloric acid zinc chloride
20 °C 22 °C
pH 1 pH 7
before after
endothermic neutralisation
A
B
C
D
gas syringe
reactants
Which equation represents a reaction where the speed can be measured using this apparatus?
A VO2 → V2O3
B V2O5 → VO2
C V2O3 → VO
D V2O3 → V2O5
A ammonia
B chlorine
C hydrogen
D sulfur dioxide
16 The results of three tests on a solution of compound X are shown in the table.
test result
What is compound X?
A aluminium bromide
B aluminium chloride
C zinc bromide
D zinc chloride
Which letter represents the area of the graph where both acid and salt are present?
A
14 B
pH
C
7
D
0
solid S gas G
A copper hydrogen
B copper carbonate carbon dioxide
C zinc hydrogen
D zinc carbonate carbon dioxide
Which row correctly shows the physical state of element X at room temperature and its reactivity
compared with that of iodine?
physical state
reactivity compared
of element X at
with that of iodine
room temperature
21 Which properties of the element titanium, Ti, can be predicted from its position in the Periodic
Table?
A
B
C
D
22 Five elements have proton numbers 10, 12, 14, 16 and 18.
What are the proton numbers of the three elements that form oxides?
A 10, 12 and 14
B 10, 14 and 18
C 12, 14 and 16
D 14, 16 and 18
24 Which statement about the extraction of iron from its ore is correct?
What is the correct order of reactivity of these metals, most reactive first?
A X→Y→Z
B X→Z→Y
C Z→X→Y
D Z→Y→X
1 for drinking
2 in chemical reactions
3 in swimming pools
4 in washing
A carbon dioxide
B carbon monoxide
C methane
D sulfur dioxide
A filling balloons
B filling light bulbs
C food preservation
D making steel
31 A new planet has been discovered and its atmosphere has been analysed.
atmosphere
planet
carbon dioxide 4
nitrogen 72
oxygen 24
Which gases are present in the atmosphere of the planet in a higher percentage than they are in
the Earth’s atmosphere?
X Y Z
33 Air containing an acidic impurity was neutralised by passing it through a column containing
substance X.
substance X
What is substance X?
A calcium oxide
B sand
C sodium chloride
D concentrated sulfuric acid
H H H O
H C C C C
H O H
A
B
C
D
35 Which fraction from the fractional distillation of petroleum does not match its correct use?
fraction use
36 The diagram shows apparatus used to separate petroleum into four fractions.
thermometer
petroleum
on rock wool
water
heat
fraction
A up to 70
B 70 to 120
C 120 to 170
D over 170
37 When a long chain hydrocarbon is cracked, the following products are produced.
1 C3H8
2 C2H4
3 C3H6
4 C2H6
H O H
C C
H H
alcohols alkenes
A
B
C
D
1 2
A combustion ethane
B combustion glucose
C fermentation ethane
D fermentation glucose
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Tin Antimony Tellurium Xenon
0620/11/M/J/12
Indium Iodine
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2012 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2012 0620 11
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 A
2 D 22 C
3 D 23 C
4 B 24 B
5 C 25 A
6 D 26 B
7 B 27 B
8 B 28 C
9 C 29 D
10 B 30 C
11 C 31 A
12 C 32 D
13 A 33 A
14 D 34 C
15 A 35 C
16 B 36 A
17 D 37 B
18 C 38 A
19 D 39 C
20 B 40 D
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 May/June 2012
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may need to use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together. For Examiner’s Use
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part
question. 1
Total
IB12 06_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2012 [Turn over
2
For
1 Stearic acid is a solid at room temperature. Examiner’s
The diagram below shows the apparatus used for finding the melting point of stearic acid. Use
The apparatus was heated at a steady rate and the temperature recorded every minute.
stirrer
water
stearic acid
heat
A, ......................................................................................................................................
B. ................................................................................................................................ [2]
(b) (i) Suggest why the water needs to be kept stirred during this experiment.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
test .............................................................................................................................
80
60
temperature / °C
40
20
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
time / minutes
(i) What was the temperature of the stearic acid after 3 minutes heating?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Use the information on the graph to determine the melting point of stearic acid.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Describe the arrangement and motion of the particles in liquid stearic acid.
arrangement .....................................................................................................................
(i) Which one of the following statements about this sample of stearic acid is correct?
Tick one box.
[1]
(ii) Describe one area of everyday life where the purity of substances is important.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 11]
S S H H
S S
S S H C C S H
H H S
S S
H H
D E
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 7]
pH 3 pH 7 pH 9 pH 13
[1]
(b) Describe how you would use litmus to test if a solution is acidic.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(i) Write a word equation for the reaction of calcium carbonate with hydrochloric acid.
[3]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) Name one other compound that can be used to treat acidic soil.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Hydrochloric acid reacts with iron to form iron(II) chloride and hydrogen.
Complete the equation for this reaction.
H O
H O H
molecular formula C 2 H6 O
[2]
(ii) Ethanol can be manufactured by the catalytic addition of steam to ethene. Complete
the equation for this reaction.
[Total: 14]
(a) Match the fractions on the left with their uses on the right.
The first one has been done for you.
[4]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Draw the structure of methane, showing all atoms and bonds.
[1]
(ii) Complete the following equation for the burning of methane in excess oxygen.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 11]
measuring cylinder
small test-tube
held by a
piece of cotton
water
zinc powder
hydrochloric acid
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) The student measured the volume of gas in the measuring cylinder at minute intervals.
The results are shown in the table.
time / minutes 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
volume of gas / cm3 0 15 23 30 33 35 35 35
(i) Plot the results on the grid below and draw the best curve through the points.
40
30
volume of
gas / cm3
20
10
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
time / minutes
[3]
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) Complete the following sentences about this reaction using words or phrases from the
list below.
When the ............................. of hydrochloric acid is increased, the volume of gas given
off in the first two minutes ............................. . Decreasing the temperature of the reaction
mixture ............................. the ............................. of the reaction. [4]
(d) When the reaction is complete, the flask contains a mixture of zinc and aqueous zinc
chloride.
Describe how you can obtain pure dry crystals of zinc chloride from this reaction mixture.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 13]
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[1]
(b) Describe the reactions of lithium, sodium and potassium with water.
In your description, write about:
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [5]
– –
A
E
+
(iii) Which one of the following substances is most likely to be used for the anode?
Put a ring around the correct answer.
(d) Lithium, sodium and potassium are metals with a low density.
State two other physical properties of these metals.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. ................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 15]
A S + O2 → SO2
B SO2 + O3 → SO3 + O2
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Which two of the following statements about reaction B are correct?
Tick two boxes.
O3 is reduced to O2
O3 is oxidised to O2 [2]
(iii) Complete the equation to show how an aqueous solution of sulfuric acid, H2SO4, is
formed from SO3.
(b) Describe and explain the effect of sulfuric acid on buildings made from limestone (calcium
carbonate).
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/M/J/12
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2012 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2012 0620 21
(e) (i) the melting point is different / 3rd box down ticked; [1]
[Total: 11]
(b) 64 [1]
(d) D; [1]
ions can move / ions are free; [1]
[Total: 7]
3 (a) pH 3; [1]
(b) dip (litmus) paper in the solution / acid or add litmus solution to the acid / add acid to litmus
paper; [1]
note: if another substance added e.g. add a metal or a further process e.g. boil the solution,
the first mark is lost but the next two marks can still be obtained.
note: if the indicator is incorrect, the second two marks cannot be obtained.
(c) (i) calcium carbonate + hydrochloric acid → calcium chloride + carbon dioxide + water [3]
note: –1 per error
(ii) extraction of iron / making cement / making lime / neutralising acidic lakes /
(flue gas) desulfurisation / making glass / neutralising acidic waste / any other suitable
use; [1]
H H
│ │
H―C—C—O—H
│ │
H H
allow: OH in place of O- H
[Total: 14]
[Total: 11]
5 (a) lower the test tube (into the HCl) / mix the reactants / mix the zinc and hydrochloric acid; [1]
(b) (i) all points plotted correctly including the 0-0 point; [2]
note: –1 per error
(ii) because the reaction has finished / reaction has stopped / reaction is complete; [1]
the hydrochloric acid has been used up / hydrochloric acid is limiting / the limiting
reagent has been used up; [1]
reject: the zinc has been used up / the zinc and hydrochloric acid have been used up
heat filtrate to crystallisation point / evaporate some of the water / heat for a little while / leave
filtrate in a warm place / leave on the windowsill; [1]
[Total: 13]
note: reactivity increases down group / only two of the elements are named but they are in
correct order of reactivity e.g. potassium is more reactive than sodium = 1 mark
[Total: 15]
(c) kills (or harms) organisms in lakes / forest death / deforestation / kills trees / kills plants /
damages plants / irritation of throat or lungs / reference to asthma; [1]
allow: kills (or harms) animals or fish in lakes or rivers / kills corals.
allow: leaches soil minerals
allow: leaf burn
ignore: kills animals / fish in the sea / kills fish unqualified
ignore: acidifies soil / acidifies lakes
ignore: wears away / erodes carbonate rocks / erodes soil
ignore: destroys plants / animals
[Total: 9]
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 (Extended) May/June 2012
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together. 1
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part
question. 2
Total
IB12 06_0620_31/4RP
© UCLES 2012 [Turn over
2
For
1 The diagram below shows part of the Water Cycle. Examiner’s
Use
cloud
H2O(l) H2O(g)
Sun
rain
land
H2O(l) sea
(a) (i) State the name of each of the following changes of state.
H2O(l) → H2O(g)
name ..........................................................................................................................
H2O(g) → H2O(l)
name ..........................................................................................................................
[2]
(ii) Which one of the above changes of state is exothermic? Explain your choice.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) The rain drains into rivers and then into reservoirs. Describe how water is treated before
it enters the water supply.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [4]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 11]
................................... ...................................
...................................
................................... ...................................
...................................
[6]
(b) (i) Write an ionic equation with state symbols for the preparation of silver(I) chloride.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 10]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) All Group I metals react with cold water. Complete the following equation.
(b) Lithium reacts with nitrogen to form the ionic compound, lithium nitride.
(iii) In all solid ionic compounds, the ions are held together in a lattice.
Explain the term lattice.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iv) What is the ratio of lithium ions to nitride ions in the lattice of lithium nitride?
Give a reason for your answer.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 9]
2 + 8 + .......... + 2
[1]
(b) Predict three physical properties of vanadium which are typical of transition elements.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................................
3. ................................................................................................................................. [2]
2SO2 + O2 2SO3
The rate of this reaction can be increased either by using a catalyst or by increasing the
temperature. Explain why a catalyst is used and not a higher temperature.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) The oxidation states of vanadium in its compounds are V(+5), V(+4), V(+3) and V(+2).
The vanadium(III) ion can behave as a reductant or an oxidant.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 8]
5 Reactive metals tend to have unreactive compounds. The following is part of the reactivity
series.
(a) Sodium hydroxide and sodium carbonate do not decompose when heated.
The corresponding calcium compounds do decompose when heated.
Complete the following equations.
.................................... ....................................
calcium carbonate → +
.................................... ....................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Complete the equation for the action of heat on sodium nitrate.
(c) Which of the metals in the list on page 5 have oxides which are not reduced by carbon?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Choose from the list on page 5, metals whose ions would react with zinc.
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
H H H H
H C C C C H
H H H H
(a) The equation for the complete combustion of butane is given below. Insert the two
missing volumes.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[2]
(c) One of the chlorobutanes reacts with sodium hydroxide to form butan-1-ol. Butan-1-ol
can be oxidised to a carboxylic acid.
(i) State a reagent, other than oxygen, which will oxidise butan-1-ol to a carboxylic acid.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) Butan-1-ol reacts with ethanoic acid to form an ester. Name this ester and give its
structural formula showing all the individual bonds.
structural formula
[2]
[Total: 12]
● burning
● recycling.
burning ..............................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
recycling ...........................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
(b) (i) There are two types of polymerisation reaction. Give their names and explain the
differences between them.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [4]
(ii) Give the structural formula of a polymer which is formed from two different monomers.
[2]
[Total: 10]
electron flow
+ –
iron(III) oxide
(rust)
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Which electrode will be oxidised and become smaller? Explain your choice.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
(iii) What measurements would you need make to find the rate of rusting of the electrode
you have chosen in (ii)?
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(iv) Suggest an explanation why the addition of salt to the water increases the rate of
rusting.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
Calculate the following and then write the formula for this sample of rust.
[Total: 12]
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/M/J/12
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2012 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2012 0620 31
[Total: 11]
[Total: 10]
(iii) regular arrangement of ions / particles / positive and negative ions alternate; [1]
not: atoms
[Total: 9]
4 (a) 2 + 8 + 11 + 2 [1]
(b) hard;
strong / high tensile strength;
high mp / bp / high fixed points;
high density; [2]
(c) catalyst would not affect yield / change position of equilibrium / affects both sides equally; [1]
(higher) temperature would reduce yield / increase in temperature would favour back
reaction; [1]
[Total: 8]
[Total: 8]
(b) (i) chlorination / substitution / photochemical / exothermic / halogenation / free radical; [1]
[Total: 12]
7 (a) burning
produces toxic gases / harmful to health
increases greenhouse gases / global warming
reduces visual pollution / litter
reduces risks to wildlife
shortage of landfill sites / reduces space needed in landfill sites / saves space
non-biodegradable / long time to rot / decompose / accumulates waste
burning source of energy / used to generate electricity
recycling
conserves petroleum / natural resources
difficult to recycle / expensive / takes much energy
problems over sorting
reduces need for landfill
quality of plastic is reduced each time it is recycled
four DIFFERENT valid points which are advantages or disadvantages of burning and/or
recycling [4]
(polymer and) simple molecule / water / hydrogen chloride / one other product forms; [1]
[Total: 10]
[Total: 12]
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2012
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*9340926181*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on page 2 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB12 06_0620_51CI/RP
© UCLES 2012 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
[N][T] (c) 50 cm3 of aqueous lead nitrate, Pb(NO3)2, of concentration 0.5 mol / dm3 (165 g / dm3)
(d) 50 cm3 of aqueous potassium chloride, KCl , of concentration 0.5 mol / dm3 (37 g / dm3)
For Question 2
(a) a stoppered test-tube, containing about 2 g of sodium hydrogen carbonate, NaHCO3, labelled
solid W
(f) limewater
(k) spatulas
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
JUNE 2012
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2012
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
IB12 06_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2012 [Turn over
2
For
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between aqueous lead nitrate and aqueous Examiner’s
potassium chloride. Use
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiment.
Instructions
You are going to carry out one experiment.
(a) Experiment
Using the measuring cylinder, pour 3 cm3 of the aqueous lead nitrate provided into
each of the six test-tubes in the test-tube rack. Label the test-tubes 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6
respectively.
Fill the burette with the aqueous potassium chloride provided to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
From the burette add 1.0 cm3 of aqueous potassium chloride to test-tube 1.
Add 4.0 cm3, 5.0 cm3, 6.0 cm3 and 7.0 cm3 of aqueous potassium chloride to test-tubes 3,
4, 5 and 6 respectively.
Using a glass rod carefully stir the contents of each of the test-tubes. Leave the contents
of the test-tubes to stand for 10 minutes.
You should start question 2 while waiting for the solid in the test-tubes to settle.
After 10 minutes, use a ruler to measure the height of the solid in each test-tube. Record
your results in the table.
volume of aqueous
test-tube number height of solid / mm
potassium chloride / cm3
6
[4]
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
[4]
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) What type of chemical reaction occurs when aqueous potassium chloride reacts with
aqueous lead nitrate?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(f) Predict what would happen if the experiment were continued using three further
test-tubes with 8 cm3, 9 cm3 and 10 cm3 of aqueous potassium chloride. Explain your
answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) What difference would be observed if the experiment was repeated using aqueous silver
nitrate and aqueous potassium iodide?
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) Explain one improvement you could make to the experiment to obtain more accurate
results.
improvement .....................................................................................................................
explanation .......................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 19]
tests observations
tests on solid W
................................................................ [2]
Leave the mixture to cool for five
minutes. Add about 2 cm3 of dilute .....................................................................
hydrochloric acid. Test the gas given
off with a lighted splint. ................................................................ [2]
tests on aqueous W
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) What type of change occurs when solid W dissolves in water in test (c)?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 21]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620 / 51 Paper 5 (Practical), maximum raw mark 40
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May / June 2012 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2012 0620 51
(b) all points correctly plotted including origin (2), –1 for any incorrect
appropriate scale for y axis(at least half of grid) (1)
best fit straight line graph drawn with a ruler(1) [4]
(c) value from graph (1) unit (1) shown clearly (1) [3]
` all lead nitrate reacted / / reaction finished / excess potassium chloride (1) [2]
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2012
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part
question.
For Examiner’s Use
Total
IB12 06_0620_61/4RP
© UCLES 2012 [Turn over
2
For
1 A student reacted excess iron powder with sulfuric acid to prepare a solution of iron(II) Examiner’s
sulfate. Use
The diagram shows the procedure followed in three stages.
2
iron powder was added
until all the sulfuric acid
1 had reacted
50 cm3 of dilute sulfuric
acid was measured and
added to a beaker
heat
3
the mixture was solution of
allowed to cool iron(II) sulfate
(a) Complete the boxes to identify the pieces of apparatus labelled. [2]
(b) How would the student know when all of the sulfuric acid had reacted? Give two reasons.
1 ........................................................................................................................................
2 .................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) Describe the effect of boiling the solution of iron(II) sulfate for several minutes.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 7]
thermometer
boiling tube
25 cm3 water
spirit burner
(a) Some methanol was put into the burner. The initial temperature of the water was measured.
The burner was lit and allowed to burn for one minute. The flame was extinguished and
the final temperature of the water was measured. The experiment was repeated with
ethanol, propanol and butanol.
Use the thermometer diagrams to record the temperatures in the table on page 4.
Complete the table by recording the temperature rise for each alcohol.
30 30
methanol CH3OH 25 25
20 20
30 40
ethanol C2H5OH 25 35
20 30
30 50
propanol C3H7OH 25 45
20 40
30 60
butanol C4H9OH 25 55
20 50
[4]
40
30
temperature
rise / °C
20
10
0
0 1 2 3 4 5
number of carbon atoms
in the alcohol formula
[4]
(c) From your graph, work out the temperature rise expected if the experiment was repeated
using pentanol, C5H11OH.
Show clearly on the grid how you obtained your answer.
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) Suggest the effect of using a copper can to contain the water instead of a boiling tube.
Explain your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
Stage 2 Hot water was added to the crushed beans to dissolve the soluble substances.
Stage 3 The crushed beans were separated from the liquid solution.
Stage 4 The liquid was allowed to cool and shaken with trichloromethane to extract the
caffeine from the water.
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[2]
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) What method could be used to check the purity of the crystals in Stage 6?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
BLANK PAGE
Using a measuring cylinder, 3 cm3 of aqueous lead nitrate was poured into each of six
test-tubes in a test-tube rack. The test-tubes were labelled A, B, C, D, E and F respectively.
A burette was filled with aqueous potassium chloride. A 1.0 cm3 sample of the aqueous
potassium chloride was added to test-tube A.
A 2.0 cm3 sample of aqueous potassium chloride was added to test-tube B.
A 4.0 cm3, 5.0 cm3, 6.0 cm3 and 7.0 cm3 sample of aqueous potassium chloride was added
to test-tubes C, D, E and F respectively.
Using a glass rod, the contents of the test-tubes were stirred. The contents of the
test-tubes were left to stand for 10 minutes.
After 10 minutes, a ruler was used to measure the height of the solid in each test-tube.
The diagrams show the six test-tubes in a rack. Use a ruler to measure the height of the
solid in each test-tube in the diagram. Record the heights of the solid in the table.
test-tube A B C D E F
solid
A
B
C
D
E
F
[4]
20
15
height of
solid / mm
10
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
volume of aqueous potassium chloride / cm3
[4]
(c) From your graph, find the height of the solid formed when 3.5 cm3 of aqueous potassium
chloride was added to 3 cm3 of aqueous lead nitrate.
Show clearly on the graph how you obtained your answer.
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) What type of chemical reaction occurs when aqueous potassium chloride reacts with
aqueous lead nitrate?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) What difference would be observed if the experiment was repeated using aqueous silver
nitrate and aqueous potassium iodide?
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) Explain one improvement the student could make to the experiment to obtain more
accurate results.
improvement .....................................................................................................................
explanation .......................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 19]
tests observations
tests on solid W
(b) Solid W was heated. gas evolved formed a white solid at the top
of the test-tube
........................................................... [3]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 6]
Solutions of chemicals known as corrosion inhibitors are added to the water in steel radiators
to reduce rust.
You are provided with three different bottles of liquid corrosion inhibitors, R, S and T, and
some steel nails.
Plan an experiment to test if these inhibitors prevent the corrosion of steel and which of these
inhibitors is the most effective.
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................ [7]
[Total: 7]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes must be read in conjunction with the question papers and the report on the
examination.
• Cambridge will not enter into discussions or correspondence in connection with these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2012 question papers for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level syllabuses and some Ordinary Level
syllabuses.
Page 2 Mark Scheme: Teachers’ version Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2012 0620 61
1 (a) tripod (1) accept: stand spatula (1) not: spoon [2]
[Total: 7]
[Total: 13]
[Total: 8]
(c) value from graph 14 (1) unit (1) shown clearly (1) [3]
[Total: 19]
[Total: 6]
[Total: 7]
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice May/June 2013
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*9639789716*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
IB13 06_0620_11/RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
Which row describes the water particles in the air above the cup compared with the water
particles in the cup?
A
B
C
D
1 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid was accurately measured into a conical flask.
2 Aqueous sodium hydroxide was added until the solution was neutral. The volume of
sodium hydroxide added was measured.
3 The solution was evaporated and the crystals washed with approximately 15 cm3 of
water.
Which row shows the pieces of apparatus used to measure the 25.0 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, the
volume of aqueous sodium hydroxide and the 15 cm3 of water?
Lead iodide is made by adding aqueous lead nitrate to aqueous potassium iodide.
Which pieces of apparatus are needed to obtain solid lead iodide from 20 cm3 of aqueous lead
nitrate?
1 2 3 4 5
27
4 Element X is represented by 13 X.
5 The positions of four elements are shown on the outline of the Periodic Table.
B C
D
type of bonding
substance
ionic covalent metallic
A chlorine
B potassium bromide
C sodium
D sodium chloride
e e key
e = electron
e
e
e e
lamp
glass tube
Which substance causes the lamp to light when added to the glass tube?
9 A compound with the formula XF2 has a relative formula mass of 78.
What is element X?
A argon
B calcium
C neon
D zirconium
10 What is the balanced chemical equation for the reaction between calcium and water?
A Ca + H2O → CaOH + H2
B Ca + H2O → Ca(OH)2 + H2
C Ca + 2H2O → CaOH + H2
D Ca + 2H2O → Ca(OH)2 + H2
plastic coating
metal core
+ – + –
A B C D
aqueous molten
sodium sodium
chloride chloride
13 Some white anhydrous copper(II) sulfate powder is put into a beaker of water and stirred.
A coal
B hydrogen
C natural gas
235
D U
15 The equation shows the formation of anhydrous copper(II) sulfate from hydrated copper(II)
sulfate.
2 The (II) in the name copper(II) sulfate refers to the oxidation state of the metal.
3 The reaction is reversible.
B CO2 + C → 2CO
C CuO + H2 → Cu + H2O
18 Ant stings hurt because of the methanoic acid produced by the ant.
substance pH
A baking soda 8
B car battery acid 1
C lemon juice 3
D oven cleaner 14
Li Be B C N O F Ne
blue red
litmus paper litmus paper
aqueous
ammonium chloride
+
aqueous
sodium hydroxide
heat
21 Two indicators, bromophenol blue and Congo red, show the following colours in acidic solutions
and in alkaline solutions.
in a solution of pH 2
bromophenol blue is Congo red is
A blue red
B blue violet
C yellow red
D yellow violet
A metallic character
B number of electron shells
C number of outer shell electrons
D tendency to form positive ions
A white 113
B white 1495
C yellow 113
D yellow 1495
charge on electrical
element ion conductivity
A negative low
B positive high
C negative high
D positive low
A conducts electricity
B conducts heat
C mechanical strength
D resistance to corrosion
A carbon
B carbon monoxide
C calcium carbonate
D nitrogen
29 Pure metals conduct electricity and can be hammered into different shapes.
A Alloys are cheaper than the metals they are made from.
B Alloys are easier to hammer into different shapes.
C Alloys are harder and keep their shape better.
D Alloys conduct electricity better.
magnesium
zinc
iron
copper
Titanium reacts with acid and cannot be extracted from its ore by heating with carbon.
A below copper
B between iron and copper
C between magnesium and zinc
D between zinc and iron
Rusting can be prevented by covering the iron with a more reactive metal, such as ……2……
1 2
A oxygen copper
B oxygen magnesium
C oxygen and water copper
D oxygen and water magnesium
33 Nitrogen, phosphorus and potassium are essential elements for plant growth.
mixture formula
35 The list shows four methods that were suggested for the formation of carbon dioxide.
36 Organic compounds may have names ending in -ane, -ene, -ol or -oic acid.
How many of these endings indicate the compounds contain double bonds in their molecules?
A 1 B 2 C 3 D 4
37 The table shows the boiling points of four members of the homologous series of alcohols.
methanol CH3OH 65
ethanol C2H5OH 78
propanol C3H7OH X
butanol C4H9OH 117
A 55 °C B 82 °C C 98 °C D 115 °C
38 The table shows some fractions that are obtained from petroleum by fractional distillation,
together with some of their uses.
fraction use
1 2 3
1 2 3 4
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Tin Antimony Tellurium Xenon
0620/11/M/J/13
Indium Iodine
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2013 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2013 0620 11
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 B 21 D
2 C 22 C
3 C 23 D
4 D 24 C
5 D 25 D
6 D 26 B
7 C 27 D
8 A 28 D
9 B 29 C
10 D 30 C
11 B 31 B
12 B 32 D
13 C 33 A
14 D 34 B
15 C 35 C
16 B 36 B
17 A 37 C
18 A 38 D
19 C 39 A
20 C 40 A
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice May/June 2013
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*9639789716*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
IB13 06_0620_11/RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
Which row describes the water particles in the air above the cup compared with the water
particles in the cup?
A
B
C
D
1 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid was accurately measured into a conical flask.
2 Aqueous sodium hydroxide was added until the solution was neutral. The volume of
sodium hydroxide added was measured.
3 The solution was evaporated and the crystals washed with approximately 15 cm3 of
water.
Which row shows the pieces of apparatus used to measure the 25.0 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, the
volume of aqueous sodium hydroxide and the 15 cm3 of water?
Lead iodide is made by adding aqueous lead nitrate to aqueous potassium iodide.
Which pieces of apparatus are needed to obtain solid lead iodide from 20 cm3 of aqueous lead
nitrate?
1 2 3 4 5
27
4 Element X is represented by 13 X.
5 The positions of four elements are shown on the outline of the Periodic Table.
B C
D
type of bonding
substance
ionic covalent metallic
A chlorine
B potassium bromide
C sodium
D sodium chloride
e e key
e = electron
e
e
e e
lamp
glass tube
Which substance causes the lamp to light when added to the glass tube?
9 A compound with the formula XF2 has a relative formula mass of 78.
What is element X?
A argon
B calcium
C neon
D zirconium
10 What is the balanced chemical equation for the reaction between calcium and water?
A Ca + H2O → CaOH + H2
B Ca + H2O → Ca(OH)2 + H2
C Ca + 2H2O → CaOH + H2
D Ca + 2H2O → Ca(OH)2 + H2
plastic coating
metal core
+ – + –
A B C D
aqueous molten
sodium sodium
chloride chloride
13 Some white anhydrous copper(II) sulfate powder is put into a beaker of water and stirred.
A coal
B hydrogen
C natural gas
235
D U
15 The equation shows the formation of anhydrous copper(II) sulfate from hydrated copper(II)
sulfate.
2 The (II) in the name copper(II) sulfate refers to the oxidation state of the metal.
3 The reaction is reversible.
B CO2 + C → 2CO
C CuO + H2 → Cu + H2O
18 Ant stings hurt because of the methanoic acid produced by the ant.
substance pH
A baking soda 8
B car battery acid 1
C lemon juice 3
D oven cleaner 14
Li Be B C N O F Ne
blue red
litmus paper litmus paper
aqueous
ammonium chloride
+
aqueous
sodium hydroxide
heat
21 Two indicators, bromophenol blue and Congo red, show the following colours in acidic solutions
and in alkaline solutions.
in a solution of pH 2
bromophenol blue is Congo red is
A blue red
B blue violet
C yellow red
D yellow violet
A metallic character
B number of electron shells
C number of outer shell electrons
D tendency to form positive ions
A white 113
B white 1495
C yellow 113
D yellow 1495
charge on electrical
element ion conductivity
A negative low
B positive high
C negative high
D positive low
A conducts electricity
B conducts heat
C mechanical strength
D resistance to corrosion
A carbon
B carbon monoxide
C calcium carbonate
D nitrogen
29 Pure metals conduct electricity and can be hammered into different shapes.
A Alloys are cheaper than the metals they are made from.
B Alloys are easier to hammer into different shapes.
C Alloys are harder and keep their shape better.
D Alloys conduct electricity better.
magnesium
zinc
iron
copper
Titanium reacts with acid and cannot be extracted from its ore by heating with carbon.
A below copper
B between iron and copper
C between magnesium and zinc
D between zinc and iron
Rusting can be prevented by covering the iron with a more reactive metal, such as ……2……
1 2
A oxygen copper
B oxygen magnesium
C oxygen and water copper
D oxygen and water magnesium
33 Nitrogen, phosphorus and potassium are essential elements for plant growth.
mixture formula
35 The list shows four methods that were suggested for the formation of carbon dioxide.
36 Organic compounds may have names ending in -ane, -ene, -ol or -oic acid.
How many of these endings indicate the compounds contain double bonds in their molecules?
A 1 B 2 C 3 D 4
37 The table shows the boiling points of four members of the homologous series of alcohols.
methanol CH3OH 65
ethanol C2H5OH 78
propanol C3H7OH X
butanol C4H9OH 117
A 55 °C B 82 °C C 98 °C D 115 °C
38 The table shows some fractions that are obtained from petroleum by fractional distillation,
together with some of their uses.
fraction use
1 2 3
1 2 3 4
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Tin Antimony Tellurium Xenon
0620/11/M/J/13
Indium Iodine
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*0286058287*
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 May/June 2013
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may need to use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
IB13 06_0620_21/2RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 The electronic structures of five atoms of different elements, A, B, C, D and E, are shown Examiner’s
below. Use
A B C D E
Answer the following questions about these structures. Each structure may be used once,
more than once or not at all.
(b) Complete the following sentences about elements using words from the list below.
Elements such as iron and copper, which form coloured compounds, are called
[Total: 10]
(a) Use the information in the table to explain why caesium is a liquid when the temperature
is 34 °C.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
.................. °C [1]
(c) (i) Describe the general trend in density down the group.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) State three physical properties of potassium, other than density, melting point and boiling
point.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(e) Potassium reacts with water. The products are potassium hydroxide and hydrogen.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 11]
halogenoalkane C2H 6
alkane CH3COOH
alkene C2H5OH
alcohol C2H5Cl
[4]
(b) Draw the full structural formula of the compound, C2H6, showing all atoms and bonds.
[1]
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
test ....................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 10]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
H H
H N N H
C
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Calculate the relative molecular mass of urea. You must show all your working.
[2]
[2]
test ....................................................................................................................................
[Total: 11]
does a solution of
does the solid
substance melting point / °C the solid conduct
conduct electricity?
electricity?
(b) A student carried out an experiment to determine the rate of reaction of calcium carbonate
with excess hydrochloric acid.
He recorded the loss of mass of the reaction mixture over a period of time.
cotton wool
small pieces of
hydrochloric acid calcium carbonate
balance
362.05
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
1.0
0.8
0.6
loss in
mass / g
0.4
0.2
0
0 100 200 300 400 500 600
time / seconds
................... s [1]
(iii) From the graph, deduce the loss in mass in the first 100 seconds.
................... g [1]
(iv) The student repeated the experiment keeping everything the same except for the
size of the pieces of calcium carbonate. He used smaller pieces of calcium carbonate
but the mass used was the same.
On the grid above, draw a line to show how the loss of mass changes with time when
smaller pieces of calcium carbonate are used. [2]
(v) State the effect of increasing the concentration of hydrochloric acid on the rate
(speed) of this reaction when all other factors remain constant.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 9]
(i) Describe how she could separate the salt from the sugar.
You may draw a labelled diagram to help you answer this question.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
(ii) Describe how the student could obtain solid sodium chloride from a solution of
sodium chloride in water.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
Na+ Cl – Na+ Cl –
Cl – Na+ Cl – Na+
Na+ Cl – Na+ Cl –
Cl – Na+ Cl – Na+
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
+ –
B C
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 9]
damp blue
litmus paper slightly red all red
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
(b) Hydrogen chloride reacts with ammonia to form a salt which has the formula NH4Cl.
State the name of this salt.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) (i) Hydrochloric acid reacts with iron to form iron(II) chloride and hydrogen.
Write a word equation for this reaction.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
test .............................................................................................................................
oil
iron
nail
(i) Tube 1 contains unprotected iron. What is the purpose of this experiment?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) State the names of the two substances needed for iron to rust.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 13]
brass
lamp holder plastic
copper wires
Some properties of metals used in the light bulb are shown in the table below.
(a) (i) Suggest why copper rather than tungsten is used for electrical wiring?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) Suggest two reasons why tungsten rather than copper is used to make the bulb
filament.
reason 1 .....................................................................................................................
(iv) Explain why the copper wires are covered with plastic.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
A B C D
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 7]
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/M/J/13
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2013 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2013 0620 21
(ii) B [1]
(iii) E [1]
(iv) A [1]
(v) A [1]
(vi) D [1]
[Total: 10]
2 (a) melting point below (34 °C) and boiling point above (34 °C) [1]
ALLOW: its melting point is 29 °C and its boiling point is 669 °C
• bubbles
• moves (around)
• floats / on surface
• catches fire / flame
• lilac (flame) ALLOW: mauve or purple
• explodes / spits
• fizzing
• forms a ball
• beaker gets hotter
• gets smaller [2]
IGNORE: water goes cloudy / water goes purple or blue
[Total: 11]
alkane → C2H6
alkene → C2H4
alcohol → C2H5OH
carboxylic acid → CH3COOH [4]
H H
| |
H–C–C–H
| |
H H [1]
(d) bromine water / aqueous bromine / bromine / ALLOW: correct formula; [1]
IGNORE: Br
(saturated hydrocarbon) no reaction / stays the same colour / remains orange / remains
orange-brown [1]
ALLOW: remains brown
ALLOW: remains yellow (if aqueous bromine used) / remains red (if bromine used)
IGNORE: remains yellow (if bromine used)
REJECT: incorrect colour, e.g. stays same blue colour, does not score
[Total: 10]
(ii) 60 [2]
if 2 marks not scored: ALLOW 1 mark for correct atomic masses
N = 14, O = 16, H = 1, C = 12 anywhere in working
NOTE: no e.c.f.
[Total: 11]
(ii) C [1]
(iii) A [1]
[Total: 9]
[Total: 9]
(iii) air not present / oxygen not present / water not present [1]
(iv) air and water can get to the surface of the iron / oxygen and water can get to the
iron [1]
IGNORE: ideas that not all surface is protected
[Total: 13]
cheaper [1]
(b) B [1]
[Total: 7]
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 (Extended) May/June 2013
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
IB13 06_0620_31/2RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 Petroleum contains hydrocarbons which are separated by fractional distillation. Examiner’s
Use
(a) (i) Complete the following definition of a hydrocarbon.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) Some of the fractions obtained from petroleum are given below.
State a use for each fraction.
bitumen ....................................................................
[Total: 8]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Binary compounds contain two atoms per molecule, for example HCl.
Identify an element which could form a binary compound with element M.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Predict the formula of the sulfate of M. The formula of the sulfate ion is SO42–.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 6]
3 A small piece of marble, CaCO3, was added to 5.0 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, concentration
1.0 mol / dm3, at 25 °C. The time taken for the reaction to stop was measured. The experiment
was repeated using 5.0 cm3 of different solutions of acids. The acid was in excess in all of the
experiments.
(a) (i) Explain why it is important that the pieces of marble are the same size and the same
shape.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) How would you know when the reaction had stopped?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) The acids used for experiment 1 and experiment 3 have the same concentration.
Explain why experiment 3 is slower than experiment 1.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(iii) Explain in terms of collisions between reacting particles why experiment 4 is slower
than experiment 1.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 10]
CH2
H 2C CH2
H 2C CH2
CH2
(a) The name gives information about the structure of the compound.
Hex because there are six carbon atoms and cyclo because they are joined in a ring.
What information about the structure of this compound is given by the ending ane?
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Explain why cyclohexane and the alkene, hexene, are isomers.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) Describe a test which would distinguish between cyclohexane and the unsaturated
hydrocarbon hexene.
test ....................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 11]
Zn + Pb2+ → Zn2+ + Pb
...... → ...... + ...... most reactive metal : the best reductant (reducing agent)
Zn → Zn2+ + 2e–
Fe → Fe2+ + 2e–
Pb → Pb2+ + 2e–
Cu → Cu2+ + 2e–
Ag → Ag+ + e–
(i) In the space at the top of the list, write an ionic equation for a metal which is more
reactive than zinc. [1]
(ii) Write an ionic equation for the reaction between aqueous silver(I) nitrate and zinc.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(iii) Explain why the positive ions are likely to be oxidants (oxidising agents).
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
voltmeter
V
cadmium copper
electrode electrode
sulfuric acid
Results from cells using the metals tin, cadmium, zinc and copper are given in the table
below.
electrode 1 electrode 2
cell voltage / volts
positive electrode negative electrode
Write the four metals in order of increasing reactivity and explain how you used the data
in the table to determine this order.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 9]
6 Ammonia is a compound which only contains the elements nitrogen and hydrogen. It is a
weak base.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Given aqueous solutions of ammonia and sodium hydroxide, both having a
concentration of 0.1 mol / dm3, how could you show that ammonia is the weaker
base?
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
● 450 °C
● 200 atmospheres pressure
● iron catalyst
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [5]
(c) Another compound which contains only nitrogen and hydrogen is hydrazine, N2H4.
H H
N N
H H
Draw a diagram showing the arrangement of the valency electrons in one molecule of
the covalent compound hydrazine.
Use x to represent an electron from a nitrogen atom.
Use o to represent an electron from a hydrogen atom.
[3]
(i) One way it reduces the rate of rusting is by changing the pH of water.
What effect would hydrazine have on the pH of water?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Give a reason, other than pH, why hydrazine reduces the rate of rusting.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 15]
7 The hydroxides of the Group I metals are soluble in water. Most other metal hydroxides are
insoluble in water.
(a) (i) Crystals of lithium chloride can be prepared from lithium hydroxide by titration.
conical flask
25.0 cm3 of aqueous lithium hydroxide is pipetted into the conical flask.
A few drops of an indicator are added. Dilute hydrochloric acid is added slowly to the
alkali until the indicator just changes colour. The volume of acid needed to neutralise
the lithium hydroxide is noted.
A neutral solution of lithium chloride, which still contains the indicator, is left. Describe
how you could obtain a neutral solution of lithium chloride which does not contain an
indicator.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
(b) The concentration of the hydrochloric acid was 2.20 mol / dm3. The volume of acid needed
to neutralise the 25.0 cm3 of lithium hydroxide was 20.0 cm3. Calculate the concentration
of the aqueous lithium hydroxide.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Lithium chloride forms three hydrates. They are LiCl.H2O, LiCl.2H2O and LiCl.3H2O.
Which one of these three hydrates contains 45.9 % of water?
Show how you arrived at your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 10]
8 There are three types of giant structure - ionic, metallic and giant covalent.
(a) In an ionic compound, the ions are held in a lattice by strong forces.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Explain how the ions are held together by strong forces.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(c) The electrical conductivities of the three types of giant structure are given in the following
table.
Explain the differences in electrical conductivity between the three types of giant structure
and the difference, if any, between the solid and liquid states of the same structure.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [5]
[Total: 11]
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/M/J/13
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2013 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2013 0620 31
lubricating fraction – waxes / vaseline / grease, etc. or machinery example, e.g. (oil a) bike /
hinges / reducing friction [1]
paraffin fraction – jet fuel / (home) heating or tractors or cooking or lighting [1]
[Total: 8]
(c) N or P or As or Sb [1]
accept Bi
[Total: 6]
(c) (i) more concentrated or higher concentration (of acid) (in experiment 1) [1]
accept: arguments based on collision theory
(ii) ethanoic acid is a weak acid or hydrochloric acid is a strong acid [1]
accept: stronger or weaker
ethanoic acid less ionised / dissociated / lower / smaller concentration of hydrogen ions [1]
accept: less hydrogen ions and vice versa argument but not dissociation of ions
[Total: 10]
OR
potassium manganate(VII) [1]
note: oxidation state not essential but if given must be correct or [0]
accept: potassium permanganate
[Total: 11]
(iii) because they can accept or gain electrons / change into atoms or can be reduced [1]
higher reactivity metals are the negative electrode / copper is least reactive because it is the
positive electrode because copper would have the lowest voltage / copper cell V = 0 / the
bigger the difference in reactivity, the bigger the voltage / zinc has highest voltage because it
is most reactive / more reactive metals have higher voltage
[Total: 9]
• high pressure favours lower volume side / movement to right / ammonia side, or high
pressure increases the yield
• low temperature favours exothermic reaction / increases yield / favours the forward
reaction
• 450 °C low enough to give an economic yield but with catalyst gives a fast enough rate
note need whole concept to get this compromise temperature point [5]
(ii) oxygen needed for rusting / removes oxygen / reacts with oxygen [1]
[Total: 15]
OR
note: if correct option given mark this and ignore the rest of the response
allow: max 2 for applying a correct method to another hydrate, [1] for the method and [1] for
the correct value, working essential
[Total: 10]
ionic
in ionic solid ions cannot move [1]
liquid ionic compound ions can move [1]
metallic
(both solid and liquid) metals have delocalised (or alternative term) electrons [1]
[Total: 11]
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2013
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*9802488661*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on page 2 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB13 06_0620_51CI/3RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
[H] (d) 1 g, 2 g, 3 g and 5 g samples of anhydrous potassium carbonate, K2CO3, in four dry stoppered
tubes, labelled 1 g of solid C, 2 g of solid C, 3 g of solid C and 5 g of solid C
(e) 3.5 g of potassium hydrogen carbonate, KHCO3, in a dry stoppered tube, labelled solid D
[H] (f) 200 cm3 of aqueous hydrochloric acid of concentration 2 mol / dm3, labelled hydrochloric acid
For Question 2
(a) a stoppered test-tube, containing about 10 cm3 of aqueous ethanoic acid of concentration
1 mol / dm3, labelled liquid A
(d) splints
(k) a very dilute solution of aqueous potassium manganate(VII) made by dissolving one crystal
of potassium manganate(VII) in about 100 cm3 of distilled water. At this concentration the
solution should be pale pink.
[T] (l) aqueous potassium dichromate(VI) solution of concentration 0.01 mol / dm3
(n) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
JUNE 2013
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2013
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
IB13 06_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 You are going to investigate what happens when two different solids, C and D, react with Examiner’s
excess dilute hydrochloric acid. Use
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
You are going to carry out five experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Use a measuring cylinder to pour 30 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid into the polystyrene
cup supported in the beaker provided. Measure the temperature of the dilute hydrochloric
acid and record it in the table below. Add 1 g of solid C to the dilute hydrochloric acid and
stir the mixture with the thermometer.
Measure the maximum temperature reached by the liquid mixture. Record your result in
the table.
(b) Experiment 2
initial maximum
mass of temperature
Experiment temperature temperature
solid C / g change / °C
of acid / °C reached / °C
[4]
(e) Plot the results for Experiments 1, 2, 3 and 4 on the grid and draw a straight line graph.
temperature
change / °C
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
mass of solid C added / g
[4]
(f) (i) From your graph, deduce the temperature change of the solution when 6 g of solid
C is added to 30 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
............................................ °C [2]
(ii) From your graph, deduce the mass of solid C that would give a temperature rise of
9 °C when added to 30 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(h) Suggest the effect on the results if Experiment 3 was repeated using 60 cm3 of dilute
hydrochloric acid.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(i) Predict the temperature of the solution in Experiment 4 after 1 hour. Explain your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(j) When carrying out the experiments, what would be one advantage and one disadvantage
of taking the temperature readings after exactly one minute?
advantage .........................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
disadvantage ....................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 21]
tests observations
tests on liquid A
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 19]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/51 Paper 5 (Practical), maximum raw mark 40
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2013 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2013 0620 51
(e) appropriate scale on y-axis which uses at least half of the grid (1)
all points correctly plotted (2), –1 for any incorrect ignore: origin
best fit straight line graph drawn with a ruler (1) [4]
(f) (i) value from graph (1) extrapolation shown clearly (1) [2]
disadvantage e.g. reaction not finished / temperature still changing (1) [2]
2 tests on liquid A
tests on liquid B
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2013
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
IB13 06_0620_61/2RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 Electricity was passed through a solution of concentrated hydrochloric acid using the Examiner’s
apparatus shown. Use
hydrogen
concentrated
hydrochloric acid
+ –
(a) Complete the boxes to identify the parts of the apparatus labelled. [2]
test ....................................................................................................................................
(c) Describe how a sample of the gas given off at the positive electrode could be collected
and its volume measured.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) The experiment was repeated using a concentrated aqueous solution of sodium chloride
instead of hydrochloric acid.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 8]
The student decided to make some elderberry wine using the apparatus below.
airlock
water
fermenting mixture
Step 2 The crushed elderberries and sugar were added to the water and the mixture was
boiled for ten minutes. The crushed elderberries were then separated from the
mixture.
Step 3 Yeast was added to the liquid when it had cooled to room temperature.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Draw a labelled diagram of the apparatus used to separate the crushed elderberries from
the mixture in Step 2.
[2]
(d) Why was the yeast in Step 3 not added until the liquid was at room temperature?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Suggest how the rate of the fermentation reaction could be measured.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(f) Name the method that could be used to separate ethanol from the fermented mixture.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
(a) Experiment 1
A measuring cylinder was used to pour 30 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid into a polystyrene
cup. The temperature of the dilute hydrochloric acid was measured. 1 g of solid C was
added to the dilute hydrochloric acid and the mixture stirred with a thermometer.
The maximum temperature reached by the liquid mixture was measured.
(b) Experiment 2
Use the thermometer diagrams to record the results in the table below.
30 30
1 25 25
20 20
30 35
2 25 30
20 25
30 35
3 25 30
20 25
30 35
4 25 30
20 25
[3]
25 20
20 15
15 10
initial temperature of acid final temperature of liquid mixture
(e) Plot the results for Experiments 1, 2, 3 and 4 on the grid and draw a straight line graph.
15
10
temperature
difference / °C
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
mass of solid C / g
[4]
............................... °C [2]
(ii) From your graph, deduce the mass of solid C that would give a temperature rise of
9 °C when added to 30 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(g) What type of chemical process occurs when solid D reacts with dilute hydrochloric acid?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) Suggest the effect on the results if Experiment 3 was repeated using 60 cm3 of dilute
hydrochloric acid.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(i) Predict the temperature of the solution in Experiment 4 after 1 hour. Explain your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(j) When carrying out the experiments, what would be one advantage and one disadvantage
of taking the temperature readings after exactly one minute?
advantage .........................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
disadvantage ....................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 20]
tests observations
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 11]
graph A graph B
steel in boiling acid solution steel in boiling alkali solution
200 0.20
150 0.15
mass loss / mg
mass loss / mg
100 0.10
50 0.05
0 0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 0 2 4 6 8 10 12
time / hours time / hours
(a) Give one similarity in the change in mass of the steel in both liquids.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Describe two ways in which the mass loss shown in graph A is different from that shown
in graph B.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3]
(c) State two different safety precautions that would need to be taken when carrying out this
investigation.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. ................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 6]
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................ [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2013 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2012 0620 61
(c) graduated test-tube / measuring cylinder (1) not: gas syringe as will not work
filled with electrolyte / acid / water inverted over electrode / owtte (1) [2]
(ii) universal indicator with pH>7 / litmus turns blue (1) [1]
note: mark not awarded if (d)(i) is incorrect
(c) diagram of funnel and filter paper (1) labelled (1) [2]
(d) yeast would not work at high temperatures / kills yeast / denatures enzymes / owtte (1) [1]
allow: kills enzyme
3 °C (1)
disadvantage, e.g. reaction not finished / temperature still changing / may not reach
maximum temperature (1) [2]
4 tests on filtrate
(c) goggles / lab coat / tongs / fume cupboard / well ventilated area any two [2]
ignore: reference to hair
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice October/November 2013
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*6047676049*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 20.
Electronic calculators may be used.
IB13 11_0620_11/2RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
1 An attempt was made to compress a gas and a solid using the apparatus shown.
piston
gas solid
Which substance would be compressed and what is the reason for this?
substance reason
In one reaction, there is a change in mass of the reactants during the reaction.
A balance
B clock
C pipette
D thermometer
diagram 1
temperature / °C
147
0
0 time
diagram 2
23
5 Which statements about a sodium atom, 11 Na, are correct?
Which row shows the electron change taking place for rubidium and the correct formula of the
rubidium ion?
7 The diagrams show the electron arrangements in the atoms of four elements.
A B C D
key
e ee ee ee
e electron
ee ee ee ee
e e e e nucleus
e
ee ee ee
method 1
shake with
water
X+Y
method 2
shake with
ethanol
X+Y
1 2
A
B
C
D
W CuSO4.5H2O
X MgSO4.7H2O
Y Cu(NO3)2.6H2O
10 Which relative molecular mass, Mr, is not correct for the molecule given?
molecule Mr
A ammonia, NH3 17
B carbon dioxide, CO2 44
C methane, CH4 16
D oxygen, O2 16
11 The diagram shows the circuit for electrolysing lead(II) bromide and sodium chloride to liberate
the metal.
In what form are these salts electrolysed for liberating the metal?
+ –
anode cathode
carbon
rods
concentrated
aqueous sodium
chloride and litmus
What is the colour of the litmus at each electrode after five minutes?
A blue red
B red blue
C red colourless
D colourless blue
13 When anhydrous copper(II) sulfate is added to water a solution is formed and heat is given out.
thermometer
anhydrous
copper(II) sulfate
water
Which row correctly shows the temperature change and the type of reaction taking place?
A decreases endothermic
B decreases exothermic
C increases endothermic
D increases exothermic
A coal
B hydrogen
C methane
D petrol
15 A student investigates the rate of reaction between zinc and an excess of sulfuric acid.
X
volume of
hydrogen
0
0 time
A A catalyst is added in Y.
B A lower temperature is used in Y.
C Larger pieces of zinc are used in Y.
D Less concentrated acid is used in Y.
What can be added to anhydrous copper(II) sulfate to turn it into hydrated copper(II) sulfate?
17 The reactions shown may occur in the air during a thunder storm.
N2 + O2 → 2NO
2NO + O2 → 2NO2
NO + O3 → NO2 + O2
Which row shows what happens to the reactant molecules in each of these reactions?
N2 NO O3
1 2
A
B
C
D
property 1 property 2
A acidic covalent
B acidic ionic
C basic covalent
D basic ionic
test result
21 Calcium, on the left of Period 4 of the Periodic Table, is more metallic than bromine on the right of
this period.
Why is this?
Calcium has
A fewer electrons.
B fewer protons.
C fewer full shells of electrons.
D fewer outer shell electrons.
A B C D
23 An element has a melting point of 1084 °C and a density of 8.93 g / cm3. It’s oxide can be used as
a catalyst.
A B C
filament
argon
26 M is a shiny silver metal. It has a melting point of 1455 °C. Many of its compounds are green.
What is metal M?
A aluminium
B copper
C mercury
D nickel
27 Reactions of three metals and their oxides are listed in the table.
W no no
X no yes
Y yes no
A W X Y
B X W Y
C X Y W
D Y W X
28 Equations P and Q represent two reactions which occur inside a blast furnace.
P Q
A redox redox
B redox thermal decomposition
C thermal decomposition redox
D thermal decomposition thermal decomposition
29 Which row describes the uses of mild steel and stainless steel?
31 Farmers add calcium oxide (lime) and ammonium salts to their fields.
The compounds are not added at the same time because they react with each other.
A ammonia
B carbon dioxide
C hydrogen
D nitrogen
A B C D
33 Which air pollutant is not made when coal burns in a power station?
A carbon monoxide
B lead compounds
C nitrogen oxides
D sulfur dioxide
limestone
waste gases
gas burners
air
product
Which structure does not belong to any of these three types of compound?
A B
H H H
H H H
H C C C H
C C C H
H H H
H H
C D
H H H H H
H C C C O H H C C C OH
H H O H H H
reacts used
with as a
bromine fuel
steam
X and a Y
catalyst
used
polymerises as a
solvent
X Y
38 Petroleum is a mixture of hydrocarbons which can be separated into fractions using fractional
distillation.
A bitumen
B gasoline
C kerosene
D naphtha
H H
C C
H H
A B C D
H H H H H H H H H H
H C C H H C C C H H C C O H H C C C
H H H H H H H H H
40 A chemist carried out a cracking reaction on a hydrocarbon, X, and obtained two products, Y
and Z.
H H H H H H H
X H C C C C H + H C C C
H H H H H H
Y Z
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
0620/11/O/N/13
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2013 series for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level
components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – October/November 2013 0620 11
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 B 21 D
2 B 22 C
3 A 23 A
4 A 24 D
5 D 25 B
6 C 26 D
7 A 27 B
8 A 28 B
9 D 29 B
10 D 30 C
11 D 31 A
12 D 32 C
13 D 33 B
14 B 34 B
15 A 35 B
16 D 36 C
17 B 37 D
18 D 38 C
19 A 39 D
20 A 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 October/November 2013
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may need to use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
IB13 11_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 (a) Choose from the list of elements below to answer the following questions. Examiner’s
Use
calcium
helium
iodine
nickel
nitrogen
sodium
sulfur
Each element can be used once, more than once or not at all.
Which element:
(iv) has a single electron shell containing two electrons, .................................. [1]
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Many of the elements in the Periodic Table have metallic properties.
Describe three physical properties which are typical of most metals.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................................
3. ................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 10]
Cl H
[2]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
pH 2 pH 7 pH 9 pH 14
[1]
(c) Hydrochloric acid reacts with both metal oxides and carbonates.
(i) Complete the word equation for the reaction of hydrochloric acid with calcium
carbonate.
(ii) Complete the symbol equation for the reaction of magnesium oxide with hydrochloric
acid. Name the salt which is formed.
50
40
volume of hydrogen / cm3
30
20
10
0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350
time / seconds
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) What volume of hydrogen gas is given off during the first 50 seconds of the reaction?
1. ................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
(i) Draw the structure of ethanol, showing all atoms and bonds.
[2]
(ii) State the name of the two compounds formed when ethanol burns in excess air.
O O
C
H C O H
C C
C C
H C H
(i) On this structure, put a ring around the carboxylic acid functional group. [1]
(ii) How many carbon atoms are there in one molecule of salicylic acid?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) When making drugs and medicines, it is important that the chemicals used are pure.
State one other area of everyday life where purity is important.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 11]
= carbon atom
diamond graphite
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
test ....................................................................................................................................
(c) When graphite is burnt in a limited supply of air, carbon monoxide is formed.
State one adverse effect of carbon monoxide on health.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) In the blast furnace for the production of iron, carbon monoxide reduces iron(III) oxide.
How does this equation show that carbon monoxide is acting as a reducing agent?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Iron(III) oxide and coke (carbon) are raw materials used in the production of iron.
State the names of two other raw materials used in the blast furnace for the production
of iron.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. ................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 10]
(a) Write the correct labels in the boxes in the diagram above. [2]
(b) Draw an X on the diagram above to show where a drop of the pigment solution is placed
at the start of the experiment. [1]
(c) After leaving the apparatus for half an hour, the pigments separated from each other.
State the name given to this method of separating pigments.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Some plants can absorb nickel from the ground. The nickel can then be extracted from
the plants and purified by electrolysis.
power supply
rod of + – rod of
impure nickel pure nickel
electrolyte
(i) Which one of the following is the most suitable electrolyte for this electrolysis.
Tick one box.
water [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(e) Electroplating is used to put a thin layer of one metal on top of another by electrolysis.
Give two reasons for electroplating metals.
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. ................................................................................................................................. [2]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iii) How can you obtain a sample of green nickel(II) chloride starting with white nickel(II)
chloride?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 12]
water droplets
water vapour
kettle
(a) Describe this change of state in terms of the kinetic particle theory.
In your answer, include
● the difference in the closeness of the water molecules as the water vapour changes
to water,
● the difference in the motion of the water molecules as the water vapour changes to
water.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) When ammonium chloride dissolves in water the temperature of the solution falls.
State the name of the energy change which results in the temperature falling.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
ammonia gas
chlorine gas
[1]
(e) (i) Complete the symbol equation for the reaction of lithium with water to form lithium
hydroxide and hydrogen.
[1]
[Total: 11]
relative
density relative relative electrical
substance thermal
/ g per cm3 strength conductivity
conductivity
(a) Use the information in this table to answer the following questions.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Suggest why copper is preferred to iron for electrical wiring in houses.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(iv) Which pure metal in the table conducts electricity least well?
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(v) Suggest why steel rather than iron is used in making machinery.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) A solution of a metal salt reacts with aqueous sodium hydroxide to form a white precipitate.
The white precipitate is soluble in excess aqueous sodium hydroxide.
(i) Which one of the following ions is most likely to be present in the salt?
Put a ring around the correct answer.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
Cl – Cl – Cl – Cl –
Cu2+ Cu2+
Cl – Cl – Cl – Cl –
Cu2+ Cu2+
Cl – Cl – Cl – Cl –
Cu2+ Cu2+
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Suggest the product formed at each electrode when molten copper(II) chloride is
electrolysed.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 13]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/O/N/13
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2013 series for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level
components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – October/November 2013 0620 21
(b) substance containing only 1 type of atom / substance which cannot be broken down further
by chemical means [1]
(b) pH 2 [1]
(ii) 2 [1]
calcium chloride [1]
[Total: 13]
(b) (i)
H H
│ │
H–C– C–O–H [2]
│ │
H H
H H
│ │
H–C– C – OH (for 1 mark)
│ │
H H
(ii) 7 [1]
[Total: 10]
(d) (i) 2nd box down ticked / aqueous nickel(II) sulfate [1]
(e) protection from corrosion / make it less reactive / make it unreactive [1]
better appearance / more shiny [1]
(iii) add water (to white nickel(II) chloride) / hydrate (white nickel(II) chloride) [1]
[Total: 12]
(b) (i) substance which dissolves another / it dissolves a solute / substance which dissolves a
solute / it dissolves something; [1]
(ii) 20 g [1]
[Total: 11]
(ii) (copper is) better electrical conductor / iron is worse conductor [1]
IGNORE: copper is a good conductor
[Total: 13]
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 (Extended) October/November 2013
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
IB13 11_0620_31/3RP R
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 For each of the following, name an element which matches the description. Examiner’s
Use
(a) It is used as a fuel in nuclear reactors.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) It has the same electron distribution as the calcium ion, Ca2+.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 7]
1. .......................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................................
3. ................................................................................................................................. [3]
potassium
zinc
copper
For those metals which react with water or steam, name the products of the reaction,
otherwise write ‘no reaction’.
potassium .........................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
zinc ...................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
copper ...............................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [5]
[Total: 8]
(i) Nitrogen
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Hydrogen
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [3]
(b) The percentage of ammonia in the equilibrium mixture varies with temperature and
pressure.
(i) Which pair of graphs, A, B or C, shows correctly how the percentage of ammonia at
equilibrium varies with temperature and pressure?
percentage percentage
pair A NH3 at NH3 at
equilibrium equilibrium
temperature pressure
percentage percentage
pair B NH3 at NH3 at
equilibrium equilibrium
temperature pressure
percentage percentage
pair C NH3 at NH3 at
equilibrium equilibrium
temperature pressure
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [6]
(iii) Catalysts do not alter the position of equilibrium. Explain why a catalyst is used in
this process.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 14]
flask
balance
The mass of carbon dioxide given off was plotted against time.
mass of
carbon dioxide
0
0 time
In all the experiments mentioned in this question, the calcium carbonate was in excess.
(a) (i) Explain how you could determine the mass of carbon dioxide given off in the first five
minutes.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Label the graph F where the reaction rate is the fastest, S where it is slowing down
and 0 where the rate is zero. [2]
(iii) Explain how the shape of the graph shows where the rate is fastest, where it is
slowing down and where the rate is zero.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) Sketch on the same graph, the line which would have been obtained if 20.0 g of small
lumps of calcium carbonate and 80 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, concentration 1.0 mol / dm3,
had been used. [2]
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) The reaction rate would be faster if the experiment was carried out at a higher
temperature.
....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(d) Calculate the maximum mass of carbon dioxide given off when 20.0 g of small lumps of
calcium carbonate react with 40 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, concentration 2.0 mol / dm3.
[Total: 15]
CH3
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Give the structural formula of another hydrocarbon which is isomeric with the above.
[1]
(b) Give the structural formula and name of each of the products of the following addition
reactions.
[2]
(ii) Describe the colour change you would observe when an alkene is oxidised with
acidified potassium manganate(VII).
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
H H
C C
H CN
[3]
[Total: 16]
(a) Lead has a typical metallic structure which is a lattice of lead ions surrounded by a ‘sea’
of mobile electrons. This structure is held together by attractive forces called a metallic
bond.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) Basic lead(II) carbonate is heated in the apparatus shown below. Water and carbon
dioxide are produced.
basic lead
carbonate
heat
(i) Silica gel absorbs water. Silica gel often contains anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride.
When this absorbs water it changes from blue to pink.
Suggest a reason.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) Soda lime is a mixture of sodium hydroxide and calcium oxide. Why do these two
substances react with carbon dioxide?
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(iii) Name two substances formed when soda lime reacts with carbon dioxide.
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
When heated, the basic lead(II) carbonate gave 2.112 g of carbon dioxide and 0.432 g of
water.
[Total: 12]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) Bond forming is exothermic, bond breaking is endothermic. Explain the difference
between an exothermic reaction and an endothermic reaction.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
H H
H C H + Cl Cl → H C Cl + H Cl
H H
Cl –Cl +242
C–Cl +338
C–H +412
H–Cl +431
...................... .............................
...................... .............................
...................... .............................
...................... .............................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [4]
[Total: 8]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/O/N/13
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2013 series for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level
components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – October/November 2013 0620 31
[Total: 8]
(ii) high pressure favours side with lower volume / fewer moles [1]
this is RHS / product / ammonia [1]
%NH3 / yield increases as pressure increases [1]
[Total: 15]
5 (a) (i) have same molecular formula / both are C5H12 [1]
they have different structural formulae / different structures [1]
(d) -CH2-CH(CN)-CH2-CH(CN)-
correct repeat unit CH2-CH(CN) [1]
COND: at least 2 units in diagram [1]
continuation [1]
[Total:16]
(ii) lattice / rows / layers of lead ions / cations / positive ions [1]
NOT: atoms / protons / nuclei
can slide past each other / the bonds are non-directional [1]
[Total:12]
7 (a) (i) hydrogen (atoms) replaced by (atoms) of a different element e.g. chlorine [1]
NOT: substitute
[Total: 8]
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2013
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*6033463552*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on page 2 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB13 11_0620_51CI/2RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
[H] (d) 100 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide of concentration 0.2 mol / dm3 labelled sodium hydroxide
solution for question 1
(e) 100 cm3 of aqueous hydrochloric acid of concentration 0.2 mol / dm3 labelled acid K
For Question 2
(a) a stoppered test-tube containing about 10 cm3 of an aqueous solution of potassium iodide,
KI, of concentration 0.2 mol / dm3 labelled liquid L
(b) a stoppered test-tube containing about 3 cm3 of liquid paraffin (medicinal paraffin), labelled
liquid M
[N] [H] (c) a stoppered dry test-tube containing one small crystal of iodine, labelled iodine
The Supervisor should advise the candidates not to touch the crystal.
(g) aqueous barium nitrate of concentration suitable to give a positive test for sulfate ions
[N] [H] (j) aqueous silver nitrate of concentration suitable to give a positive halide test
[H] (m) 2 cm3 of 20 volume hydrogen peroxide solution, labelled hydrogen peroxide
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
NOVEMBER 2013
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2013
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
IB13 11_0620_51/2RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 You are going to investigate what happens when aqueous sodium hydroxide reacts with acid K. Examiner’s
Use
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Use a measuring cylinder to pour 25 cm3 of acid K into a conical flask. Add five drops of
phenolphthalein to the flask.
Fill the burette with the aqueous sodium hydroxide to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
Slowly add the aqueous sodium hydroxide to acid K in the flask and shake the mixture.
Continue to add aqueous sodium hydroxide to the flask until the solution shows a
permanent colour change.
Measure and record the volume in the table. Complete the table.
Pour the solution away and rinse the conical flask.
burette reading
[3]
(b) Experiment 2
Use a measuring cylinder to pour 50 cm3 of acid K into a conical flask. Add the 0.3 g of
powdered calcium carbonate to the flask and shake the flask until no further reaction is
observed.
Add five drops of phenolphthalein to the mixture in the flask.
Fill the burette with aqueous sodium hydroxide and record the burette reading. Slowly add
aqueous sodium hydroxide from the burette to the flask and shake the mixture. Continue
to add aqueous sodium hydroxide to the flask until the solution shows a permanent
colour change.
Measure and record the volume in the table. Complete the table.
burette reading
[3]
(d) What type of chemical reaction occurs when acid K reacts with sodium hydroxide?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) If Experiment 1 was repeated using 50 cm3 of acid K, what volume of sodium hydroxide
would be required to change the colour of the indicator?
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(f) (i) What is the effect of adding 0.3 g of powdered calcium carbonate to acid K?
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Use your answers from (b) and (e) to work out the difference in the volume of sodium
hydroxide added when 0.3 g of calcium carbonate is mixed with 50 cm3 of acid K in
Experiment 2.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(iii) Estimate the mass of calcium carbonate that would need to be added to 50 cm3 of
acid K to require 0.0 cm3 of sodium hydroxide.
[1]
(g) What would be the effect on the results if the solutions of acid K were warmed before
adding the sodium hydroxide? Give a reason for your answer.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 22]
tests observations
tests on liquid L
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) What conclusions can you draw about liquid M from test (b)(i)?
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 18]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/51 Paper 5 (Practical), maximum raw mark 40
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October / November 2013 series for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level
components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – October/November 2013 0620 51
(e) 2× volume for Experiment 1 from table (1) cm3 (1) [2]
allow: 1 mark for double the volume
(iii) estimate based on (ii) answer to (ii) / 3 divided into 50 × 0.1 e.g. 0.5
allow: 1 mark for 0.45–0.6g [1]
2
Page 3 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – October/November 2013 0620 51
3
UNIVERSITY OF CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*8106479956*
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2013
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use a pencil for any diagrams, graphs or rough working.
Do not use staples, paper clips, highlighters, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
IB13 11_0620_61/2RP
© UCLES 2013 [Turn over
2
For
1 A student investigated the products formed when ethanol was burned using the apparatus Examiner’s
shown. Use
suction
pump
liquid F
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
identity .......................................................................................................................
(ii) Why is the end of the delivery tube below the surface of liquid F?
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Give one expected observation in the horizontal part of the delivery tube.
Explain your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 7]
30
percentage corrosion of steel rod
20
10
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
pH of solution
(a) Draw a best fit straight line through the points. [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) State one other variable which should have been kept constant.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) State one conclusion that could be drawn from the results.
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 5]
(a) Experiment 1
Using a measuring cylinder, 25 cm3 of acid K was poured into a conical flask.
Phenolphthalein indicator was added to the flask. A burette was filled with aqueous
sodium hydroxide to the 0.0 cm3 mark. Aqueous sodium hydroxide was added from the
burette to the flask and the mixture shaken until the solution showed a permanent colour
change.
The final volume was measured. Use the burette diagram to record the final volume in
the table and complete the table.
37
38
39
final volume
burette reading
final volume / cm3
initial volume / cm3
difference / cm3
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
The solution was poured away and the conical flask rinsed.
Using a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of acid K was poured into the conical flask. 0.3 g of
powdered calcium carbonate was added to the flask and the flask shaken until no further
reaction was observed.
Phenolphthalein was added to the mixture in the flask.
A burette was filled with the same aqueous sodium hydroxide and the initial volume
measured. Aqueous sodium hydroxide was added from the burette to the flask and the
mixture shaken until the solution showed a permanent colour change.
Use the burette diagrams to record the initial and final volumes in the table and complete
the table.
9 28
10 29
11 30
burette reading
final volume / cm 3
(d) What type of chemical reaction occurred when acid K reacted with sodium hydroxide?
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) If Experiment 1 were repeated using 50 cm3 of acid K, what volume of sodium hydroxide
would be required to change the colour of the indicator?
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(f) (i) What were the effects of adding 0.3 g of powdered calcium carbonate to acid K?
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(ii) Use your answer in (e) to work out the difference between the volume of sodium
hydroxide needed to completely react with 50 cm3 of acid K and the volume of
sodium hydroxide used in Experiment 2.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
(iii) Estimate the mass of calcium carbonate that would be needed to be added to 50 cm3
of acid K to require 0.0 cm3 of sodium hydroxide.
.............................................................................................................................. [1]
(g) What would be the effect on the results if the solutions of acid K were warmed before
adding the sodium hydroxide? Give a reason for your answer.
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 20]
tests observations
tests on liquid L
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) What conclusions can you draw about liquid M from test (b)(ii)?
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 7]
gas syringe
aqueous
hydrogen peroxide
catalyst
The gas syringe diagrams show the volume of oxygen formed every 30 seconds in each
experiment.
(a) Use the syringe diagrams to complete the volumes in the table.
0 10 0 10
0
20 30 40 10 20 30
30
30 40 50 30 40 50
60
50 60 70 50 60 70
90
60 70 80 60 70 80
120
60 70 80 60 70 80
150
60 70 80 60 70 80
180
[4]
70
60
50
volume of
oxygen / cm3
40
30
20
10
0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180
time / s
[6]
..................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Which is the better catalyst in this reaction? Explain your answer.
...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Sketch a line on the grid to show the graph you would expect if the reaction with catalyst
R was repeated at 50 °C. [2]
[Total: 15]
Some documents are stored in containers with packets of silica gel crystals. These crystals
absorb water from air that enters the container. Water could damage the documents.
Anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride is added to the silica gel. As the crystals absorb water they
change colour from blue to pink. Heating the silica gel in an oven removes the water from the
crystals so that the crystals can be reused.
Plan an experiment to find the mass of water absorbed by a packet of silica gel crystals.
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................ [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
University of Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2013 series for most IGCSE,
GCE Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level
components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – October/November 2013 0620 61
(b) to move products through the apparatus / owtte e.g. let the gases go out (1) [1]
2 (a) straight line drawn with a ruler through all points missing point at pH 5 (1) [1]
(d) the lower the pH the greater the % corrosion / or converse / pH 1 is most corrosive (1) [1]
(e) 2 × volume for Experiment 1 from table / 76 (1) cm3 (1) [2]
(f) (i) reacts with the acid / neutralised (1) less sodium hydroxide needed (1) [2]
(iii) estimate based on (ii) answer to (ii) / 3 divided into 19 × 0.1 + 0.3 = 0.4 g [1]
(h) (i) more accurate (1) than a measuring cylinder (1) [2]
(ii) no effect / advantage (1) not measuring temperature changes (1) [2]
4 tests on liquid L
(f) organic (1) solvent (1) liquids do not mix (1) max [2]
0 0 0
30 23 16
60 34 36
90 59 51
120 66 63
150 71 69
180 72 72
(b) points plotted correctly (3) smooth curves (2) labels (1) [6]
(e) sketch to left of R graph / steeper (1) to same level (1) [2]
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice October/November 2014
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*4174905704*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 11_0620_11/2RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
mixture
funnel
filter paper
A chromatography
B crystallisation
C electrolysis
D fractional distillation
A nucleon number
B number of electron shells
C number of electrons in the outer shell
D proton number
e e
e e
key
e e e electron
e e n neutron
e 16n e
e e nucleus
e e
A Al B P C S D Si
6 Slate has a layered structure and can easily be split into thin sheets.
A B C D
8 Caesium chloride and rubidium bromide are halide compounds of Group I elements.
Caesium chloride has the formula ……1……, a relative formula mass ……2…… that of rubidium
bromide and bonds that are ……3…… .
1 2 3
A 1 B 2 C 5 D 6
11 Which metal could not be used for electroplating by using an aqueous solution?
A chromium
B copper
C silver
D sodium
12 Which products are formed at the electrodes when a concentrated solution of sodium chloride is
electrolysed?
A hydrogen chlorine
B hydrogen oxygen
C sodium chlorine
D sodium oxygen
15 The rate of a reaction depends on temperature, concentration, particle size and catalysts.
16 The diagram shows the change from an anhydrous salt to its hydrated form.
forward
anhydrous salt hydrated salt
reverse
P 2NaNO2 + O2 → 2NaNO3
Q 2HgO → 2Hg + O2
P Q
A
B
C
D
18 Which changes decrease the rate of reaction between magnesium and air?
substance pH
A calcium hydroxide 12
B lemon juice 4
C milk 6
D washing up liquid 8
Y
X Z
21 How many different salts could be made from a supply of dilute sulfuric acid, dilute hydrochloric
acid, copper, magnesium oxide and zinc carbonate?
A 3 B 4 C 5 D 6
22 The graph shows how the pH of soil in a field changes over time.
11 A
pH of 7 B
soil D
5 C
time
Which row describes the products made in the reaction and the trend in reactivity of the
elements?
1 It acts as a catalyst.
2 It forms colourless ions.
property 1 property 2
A
B
C
D
number of outer
structure of gas X
electrons in atoms of X
A 2 single atoms
B 2 diatomic molecules
C 8 single atoms
D 8 diatomic molecules
26 The table shows the reactions of four different metals with water.
metal reaction
What is the correct order of reactivity, from most reactive to least reactive?
A W→X→Y→Z
B W→Z→Y→X
C Z→W→X→Y
D Z→W→Y→X
27 Which information about an element can be used to predict its chemical properties?
A boiling point
B density
C melting point
D position in the Periodic Table
A low density
B resistance to corrosion
C good conductor of electricity
D poor conductor of heat
Element X does not react with cold water, steam or dilute hydrochloric acid.
What is X?
A copper
B iron
C magnesium
D zinc
A a bicycle frame
B a hammer
C a saucepan
D an aeroplane body
33 Which method of purification would produce water most suitable for drinking?
A
filtration
B
chlorination
muddy purified
river water
water C
settlement filtration
D
filtration chlorination
35 Which is an air pollutant that affects a part of the body other than the lungs and blood system?
A lead compounds
B nitrogen
C oxides of nitrogen
D sulfur dioxide
36 Increasing the number of atoms in one molecule of a hydrocarbon increases the amount of
energy released when it burns.
A B
H H H H H H H H H H H
H C C C C C C H C C C C C C H
H H H H H H H H H H H H
C D
H H H H H H H H H H H O
H C C C C C C O H H C C C C C C
H H H H H H H H H H H O H
38 The diagram shows three repeat units in the structure of an addition polymer.
H Cl H H H Cl
C C C C C C
H H H Cl H H
A B C D
Cl Cl H Cl H H Cl H
H C C H H C C H C C C C
H H H H H Cl H Cl
catalyst
substance X + steam ethanol
What is substance X?
A carbon dioxide
B ethene
C hydrogen
D oxygen
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
0620/11/O/N/14
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2014 series for
most Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 D 21 B
2 A 22 B
3 D 23 B
4 A 24 B
5 B 25 A
6 A 26 D
7 C 27 D
8 C 28 D
9 D 29 A
10 D 30 B
11 D 31 C
12 A 32 B
13 C 33 D
14 C 34 A
15 B 35 A
16 B 36 D
17 B 37 A
18 D 38 C
19 B 39 B
20 A 40 B
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 October/November 2014
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 11_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
A B C
H H H H H Br Br
H C C C H C C H C C H
H H H H H H H
D E
H H O
H C H H C C
H H O H
(a) Answer the following questions about these compounds. Each compound may be used once,
more than once or not at all.
(ii) Which two compounds are saturated hydrocarbons? ..................... and ..................... [1]
(iii) Which compound is the main constituent of natural gas? ............................................ [1]
(iv) Which compound reacts with steam to form ethanol? .................................................. [1]
(vi) Which two compounds are in the same homologous series? ................ and .............. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) Complete the symbol equation for the complete combustion of compound A.
[Total: 9]
2 The diagram shows a bottle of mineral water. The concentration of the ions present in the water is
shown on the label. The pH of the water is also shown.
concentration
ions present in mg / 1000 cm3
poly(ethene) chloride, Cl – 0.71
bottle X, F –
0.31
magnesium, Mg2+ 0.02
2+
manganese, Mn 0.01
–
Y, NO3 0.70
+
potassium, K 0.44
sodium, Na+ 1.22
pH = 6.6
(a) (i) Which positively charged ion is present in the highest concentration?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
ion X ...................................................................................................................................
ion Y ...................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) Calculate the mass, in mg, of sodium ions in 200 cm3 of mineral water.
..................... mg [1]
(iv) Which one of the following phrases best describes the pH of this mineral water?
Tick one box.
neutral
strongly acidic
strongly alkaline
weakly acidic
weakly alkaline
[1]
test .............................................................................................................................................
result ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
Complete the following sentence about poly(ethene) using words from the list below.
[Total: 9]
H H
C C H H
H C C C C O H
C C H H
H H
(a) On the structure above, draw a ring around the alcohol functional group. [1]
test .............................................................................................................................................
result ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) She then filters the solution through some glass wool.
Suggest why she does not use filter paper.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The student uses the apparatus shown below to identify the different pigments in the mixture.
glass cover
filter paper
pure solvent
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) On the diagram above, draw a spot, ●, to show where the mixture of pigments is placed at
the start of the experiment. [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) The student also puts four spots of pure pigments, A, B, C and D, onto the filter paper.
The diagram below shows the results of her experiment.
pigments A B C D
from
rose petal
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
[2]
[Total: 12]
4 A student wants to compare the energy released when different fuels are burned.
He measures the increase in temperature of the water in a metal can when the fuels are burned.
clamp
water
metal can
top-pan balance
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) State two things the student should keep the same when burning each fuel.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) What happens to the reading on the top-pan balance as the fuel burns?
Give a reason for your answer.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) The results of burning four fuels, D, E, F and G, are shown in the table below.
D 20 45
E 19 43
F 16 44
G 21 46
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(f) The metal can is made of mild steel coated with tin.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Why does the tin prevent the steel can from rusting?
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
oxygen atom
silicon atom
Which one of the following best describes the structure of silicon dioxide?
Tick one box.
giant covalent
giant ionic
simple atomic
simple molecular
[1]
[Total: 11]
5 (a) Describe how acids react with metals and with metal oxides.
In your answer:
● refer to a particular metal and metal oxide,
● illustrate your answer with at least one word equation.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(b) When metals react with hydrochloric acid, the temperature of the reaction mixture increases.
Which one of the following words best describes this reaction?
Draw a ring around the correct answer.
(c) Uranium is a metal which has several radioactive isotopes. Some of these are used as sources
of energy.
State one other use of radioactive isotopes.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Complete the table below to show the number of protons, neutrons and electrons in two
isotopes of uranium.
235 238
isotope 92 U 92 U
protons
neutrons
electrons
[3]
[Total: 9]
6 The organic compound 1-bromobutane reacts with excess sodium hydroxide to form butan-1-ol.
A scientist studied the rate of this reaction by finding out how the concentration of sodium hydroxide
changed with time.
The graph below shows the results.
0.25
0.20
0.15
concentration of
sodium hydroxide
in mol / dm3
0.10
0.05
0.00
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
time / hours
(a) (i) Describe how the concentration of sodium hydroxide changes with time.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Determine the time it took for the concentration of sodium hydroxide to fall to 0.15 mol / dm3.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) On the grid above, draw a line to show how the concentration of sodium hydroxide changes
when the concentration of 1-bromobutane in the reaction mixture is increased.
All other conditions remain the same.
[2]
(v) Increasing the concentration of 1-bromobutane increases the rate of this reaction.
Suggest one other way of increasing the rate of this reaction.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) The concentration of aqueous sodium hydroxide can be found by titrating samples of the
reaction mixture with hydrochloric acid.
Describe how you would carry out this titration.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(c) Hydrochloric acid is made by dissolving hydrogen chloride gas, HCl, in water.
Draw a dot-and-cross diagram to show a molecule of hydrogen chloride.
Show hydrogen electrons as x.
Show chlorine electrons as ●.
[2]
[Total: 13]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) Aqueous ammonia reacts with nitric acid to make another compound often found in fertilisers.
State the name of this compound.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
SO42– SO42–
SO42– SO42–
SO42– SO42–
Deduce the simplest ratio of ammonium and sulfate ions in ammonium sulfate.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
Use this information to explain why adding slaked lime to fields which have fertilisers spread
on them may result in loss of nitrogen.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
positive
negative
[3]
[Total: 9]
solvent
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(b) Astatine, At, is below iodine in Group VII of the Periodic Table.
(i) The table shows the states of the Group VII elements at room temperature.
element state
fluorine gas
chlorine gas
bromine liquid
iodine solid
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Astatine is radioactive. A lot of heat is given off due to this radioactivity.
The small samples of astatine that have been isolated are often liquid.
Suggest why they are often liquid.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Although few compounds of astatine have been made, scientists think that sodium astatide
will react with iodine.
Complete the equation for this reaction.
[Total: 8]
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/O/N/14
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2014 series for
most Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
(iii) D [1]
(iv) B [1]
(v) D [1]
5 (O2) [1]
note: mark dependent on 4 (H2O)
[Total: 9]
Y is nitrate [1]
monomer [1]
[Total: 9]
(c) (i) to break up the cells / to extract the pigment / to separate the pigment from
the petals / idea of getting the colour out of the petals, e.g. otherwise the
colour won’t come out [1]
idea that solvent dissolves the pigment / idea of making a solution [1]
ignore: find out how pure the rose petals are / reference to separating
colours
(ii) pigment might be absorbed onto filter paper / pigment sticks to filter paper
[1]
(ii) spot near the bottom and above the solvent level [1]
(e) structure of ethanol with ALL atoms and bonds shown [2]
[Total: 12]
(e) F [1]
prevents contact with air / prevents contact with water / so air (or water) does
no react with steel [1]
do not allow: reference to tin being more reactive / sacrificial protection (for
second marking point)
[Total: 11]
(c) suitable use of radioactive isotope e.g. detecting leaks in pipes / checking
thickness of paper / tracer / cancer treatment / investigating thyroid function [1]
ignore: atomic bombs / explosions
[Total: 9]
• acid in burette
• use (volumetric) pipette to put sodium hydroxide into flask
allow: sodium hydroxide in burette / acid in flask
• idea of correct setup of apparatus, i.e.flask under burette
• indicator in flask
• run hydrochloric acid into sodium hydroxide
• until indicator changes colour
• any indication of good technique e.g. repeating experiment / add acid
• slowly / shaking flask after each addition of acid
note: answers must be in the correct context, e.g. do not allow indicator in
burette
(c) bonding pair of electrons between H and Cl and no additional electrons on the H
atom [1]
six non-bonding electrons around the chlorine atom [1]
ignore: inner shell electrons in Cl.
[Total: 13]
7 (a) for better crop / for better plant growth / to replace elements (or named elements
or minerals) lost from soil when crops harvested / for more plant protein [1]
allow: to give more nutrients to plants
ignore: for healthy plant growth / to give plants the compounds they need to grow
/ to help plants grow
• slaked lime can form an alkaline solution with water / slaked lime is calcium
• hydroxide / slaked lime is a hydroxide / slaked lime is basic
• slaked lime reacts with ammonium (salts)
allow:: slaked lime reacts with fertiliser
• ammonia escapes from soil / gas escapes from soil
[Total: 9]
• dissolving
• diffusion
• in iodine solid the particles are close together
• in iodine solid the particles only vibrate ALLOW: particles do not move
• in solution the iodine molecules are further / far apart
• in solution the particles are randomly arranged/ no particular arrangement
• in solution, particles move (fairly) freely / in solution particles slide over
solvent molecules
allow: in solution particles move slowly (from place to place)
• in solution there is bulk movement of particles from higher to lower
concentration / particles spread out in solution / move everywhere / mix up
allow: particles move from higher to lower concentration
• ideas of explanation of dissolving in terms of solvent molecules getting
between the iodine particles
• ideas about forces between particles of iodine being weakened on dissolving
(ii) heat causes astatine to melt / energy causes astatine to melt [1]
allow:: the astatine has melted / radioactivity melts the astatine
[Total: 8]
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 (Extended) October/November 2014
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 11_0620_31/2RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 3 7 10 13
solution pH
(b) Explain why solutions of hydrochloric acid and ethanoic acid with the same concentration, in
mol / dm3, have a different pH.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) Measuring pH is one way of distinguishing between a strong acid and a weak acid.
Describe another method.
method .......................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
results ........................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 9]
2 Two macromolecular forms of carbon are graphite and diamond. The structures of graphite and
diamond are given below.
graphite diamond
(a) Explain in terms of its structure why graphite is soft and is a good conductor of electricity.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
(b) State two uses of graphite which depend on the above properties.
It is soft ......................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Predict two physical properties which diamond and silicon(IV) oxide have in common.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) The Contact process changes sulfur dioxide into sulfur trioxide.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Vanadium(V) oxide is an efficient catalyst at any temperature in the range 400 to 450 °C.
Scientists are looking for an alternative catalyst which is efficient at 300 °C.
What would be the advantage of using a lower temperature?
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) The process does not use a high pressure because of the extra expense.
Suggest two advantages of using a high pressure?
Explain your suggestions.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [4]
(d) Sulfuric acid is made by dissolving sulfur trioxide in concentrated sulfuric acid to form oleum.
Water is reacted with oleum to form more sulfuric acid.
Why is sulfur trioxide not reacted directly with water?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 12]
waste gases
raw materials:
coke, C
firebrick lining iron ore, Fe2O3
limestone, CaCO3
CO forms
CO2 forms
air
slag
molten iron
(a) The coke reacts with the oxygen in the air to form carbon dioxide.
C + O2 → CO2
(i) Explain why carbon monoxide is formed higher in the Blast Furnace.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Write an equation for the reduction of hematite, Fe2O3, by carbon monoxide.
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) (i) Limestone decomposes to form two products, one of which is calcium oxide.
Name the other product.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Calcium oxide reacts with silicon(IV) oxide, an acidic impurity in the iron ore, to form slag.
Write an equation for this reaction.
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) Explain why the molten iron and the molten slag form two layers and why molten iron is
the lower layer.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iv) Suggest why the molten iron does not react with the air.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Iron and steel rust. Iron is oxidised to hydrated iron(III) oxide, Fe2O3.2H2O, which is rust.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Explain why an aluminium article coated with aluminium oxide is protected from further
corrosion but a steel article coated with rust continues to corrode.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
steel pipe
connected block of zinc
electrically
to steel pipe
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [4]
The second method is to make the steel article the cathode in a circuit for electrolysis.
power
– +
steel girder
inert anode
bubbles of
hydrogen gas sea-water
(ii) Mark on the diagram the direction of the electron flow. [1]
(iii) The steel girder does not rust because it is the cathode. Reduction takes place at the
cathode. Give the equation for the reduction of hydrogen ions.
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 19]
5 Three common pollutants in the air are carbon monoxide, the oxides of nitrogen, NO and NO2, and
unburnt hydrocarbons. They are all emitted by motor vehicles.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) Describe how a catalytic converter reduces the emission of these three pollutants.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(c) Other atmospheric pollutants are lead compounds from leaded petrol.
Explain why lead compounds are harmful.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 7]
(a) Esters can be made from alcohols and carboxylic acids. For example, the ester ethyl ethanoate
can be made by the following reaction.
(i) Name the carboxylic acid and the alcohol from which the following ester could be made.
O CH3
(ii) 6.0 g of ethanoic acid, Mr = 60, was reacted with 5.5 g of ethanol, Mr = 46.
Determine which is the limiting reagent and the maximum yield of ethyl ethanoate, Mr = 88.
HOOC COOH HO OH
Draw the structural formula of this polyester. Include two ester linkages.
[3]
(c) Fats and vegetable oils are esters. The formulae of two examples of natural esters are given
below.
ester 1 ester 2
test ......................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
[3]
(ii) Deduce which one of the above esters is unsaturated. Give a reason for your choice.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) Both esters are hydrolysed by boiling with aqueous sodium hydroxide.
What types of compound are formed?
[Total: 17]
7 Nitrogen can form ionic compounds with reactive metals and covalent compounds with non-metals.
(a) Nitrogen reacts with lithium to form the ionic compound lithium nitride, Li3N.
(i) Write the equation for the reaction between lithium and nitrogen.
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Lithium nitride is an ionic compound. Draw a diagram which shows its formula, the charges
on the ions and the arrangement of the valency electrons around the negative ion.
[2]
(i) Draw a diagram showing the arrangement of the valency electrons in one molecule of the
covalent compound nitrogen trifluoride, NF3.
[2]
(ii) Lithium nitride has a high melting point, 813 °C. Nitrogen trifluoride has a low melting point,
–207 °C.
Explain why the melting points are different.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/O/N/14
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2014 series for
most Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
1 3 7 10 13
The solutions all have the same concentration.
solution pH
aqueous ammonia, weak base 10
dilute hydrochloric acid, a strong acid 1
aqueous sodium hydroxide, a strong base 13
aqueous sodium chloride, a salt 7
dilute ethanoic acid, a weak acid 3 [5]
(b) Hydrochloric acid strong acid or ethanoic acid weak acid [1]
OR: hydrochloric acid completely ionised or ethanoic acid
partially ionised
hydrochloric acid greater concentration of/more H+ ions (than ethanoic acid) [1]
Strong (hydrochloric) acid bubbles faster or more bubbles or dissolves faster [1]
[Total: 9]
(c) (i) every silicon atom is bonded/attached to 4 oxygen atoms or every oxygen
bonded/attached to two silicon atoms [1]
[Total: 8]
(d) (the reaction is) too violent/too exothermic or produces mist/fumes (of acid) [1]
[Total: 12]
(iv) No oxygen in contact with iron or layer of slag prevents hot iron reacting with
oxygen/air or (all) oxygen reacts with carbon (so no oxygen left to react with
iron) [1]
[Total: 19]
(b) M1 carbon monoxide (converted to) carbon dioxide or 2CO + O2 → 2CO2 [1]
(c) lead compounds are toxic or brain damage or reduce IQ or nausea or kidney
failure or anaemia [1]
[Total: 7]
alcohol [1]
[Total: 17]
[Total: 8]
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2014
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*1100683816*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB14 11_0620_51CI/3RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
(d) 100 cm3 of aqueous hydrochloric acid of concentration 0.1 mol / dm3, labelled solution A
(e) 100 cm3 of aqueous hydrochloric acid of concentration 0.4 mol / dm3, labelled solution B
[H] (f) 100 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide of concentration 0.1 mol / dm3, labelled solution C
For Question 2
(d) splints
(f) aqueous barium nitrate of suitable concentration to give a positive sulfate test
[N][H] (g) aqueous silver nitrate of suitable concentration to give a positive halide test
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
NOVEMBER 2014
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2014
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 11_0620_51/2RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between two different solutions of dilute hydrochloric acid,
A and B, and a solution of substance C which is an alkali.
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Fill the burette with the solution A of dilute hydrochloric acid to the 0.0 cm3 mark. Using a
measuring cylinder, pour 20 cm3 of solution C into the conical flask. Add a few drops of methyl
orange to the flask.
Add solution A to the flask, with shaking. Continue to add solution A to the flask until the
mixture just changes colour. Record the burette reading in the table and complete the table.
Pour away the contents of the conical flask and rinse the flask with distilled water.
difference / cm3
[3]
(b) Experiment 2
Empty the burette and rinse it first with distilled water, and then with a little of solution B. Fill the
burette with the solution B of dilute hydrochloric acid to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
Record the burette readings in the table and complete the table.
difference / cm3
[3]
(c) (i) What colour change was observed when dilute hydrochloric acid was added to solution C?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) What type of chemical reaction takes place when hydrochloric acid reacts with alkaline
solutions?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) (i) In which experiment was the greater volume of dilute hydrochloric acid used?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Compare the volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in Experiments 1 and 2.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Suggest, in terms of the concentration of solutions A and B, an explanation for the
difference in volumes used.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) If Experiment 2 was repeated using 10 cm3 of solution C, what volume of dilute hydrochloric
acid would be used? Explain your answer.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(f) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder for solution C.
advantage ..................................................................................................................................
disadvantage .............................................................................................................................
[2]
(g) Describe a method other than titration, using a different reactant, that could be used to
compare the concentrations of the two solutions of dilute hydrochloric acid, A and B.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
[Total: 21]
tests observations
..................................................................... [2]
..................................................................... [2]
tests observations
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(g) What conclusions can you draw about the identity of solid D?
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 19]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/51 Paper 5 (Practical), maximum raw mark 40
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2014 series for
most Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
(c) (i) yellow, not orange to pink / orange (1) not red [1]
(e) half value / half value from table result for experiment 2 (1) cm3 (1) [2]
(f) advantage
easy to use / quick / convenient (1)
disadvantage
not accurate (1) [2]
(g) same volume of each solution (1) add suitable named reactant (1)
expected observation (1) comparison (1)
e.g. 10 cm3 of each acid (1) add strip of magnesium/named carbonate (1)
effervescence (1) more rapid bubbles means stronger acid (1) [4]
(ii) drops / condensation at top of tube (1) colour change to green/grey (1)
green on cooling (1) max [2]
(ii) green / grey not white precipitate (1) insoluble (1) [2]
(c) blue / green (1) glowing splint (1) relights / glows brighter (1)
effervescence / bubbles (1) max [3]
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2014
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 11_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 A student reacted dilute nitric acid with lead(II) oxide to prepare lead(II) nitrate. The diagram shows
the stages in the method used.
2 Lead(II) oxide
was added until
all the nitric acid
had reacted
1 50 cm3 of dilute nitric
acid was measured into
a beaker
DILUTE
NITRIC
ACID
heat
3 The mixture
was separated
solution of
lead(II) nitrate
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) The lead(II) oxide was weighed before and after the additions.
19 15
18 14
17 13
16 g 12 g
before after
Use the balance diagrams to work out the mass of lead(II) oxide added to the dilute nitric acid.
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(d) (i) How would the student know when all of the dilute nitric acid had reacted in stage 2?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Describe the effect of heating the solution of lead(II) nitrate until it boils and then heating for a
further ten minutes.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 10]
2 Two experiments were carried out to show what factors affect the rate of decomposition of hydrogen
peroxide, H2O2.
In each experiment the volume of gas produced was measured every minute for ten minutes.
Experiment 1
The student used a mixture of 50 cm3 of hydrogen peroxide, 50 cm3 of water and
1 g of manganese(IV) oxide at a room temperature of 20 °C.
The results were plotted to obtain the graph shown.
Experiment 2
The student repeated Experiment 1 but did not record how much of each substance was used. The
points were plotted on the grid.
80 Experiment 2
70
60
50
volume of
gas / cm3
40 Experiment 1
30
20
10
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
time / minutes
(b) Suggest the composition of the mixture used in Experiment 2. Explain your suggestion.
composition ...............................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
explanation ................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Sketch on the grid the curve that you would expect if Experiment 1 was repeated at 10 °C. [2]
[Total: 8]
3 A student investigated the colours present in a fruit drink. The fruit drink was tested to check that
no artificial colours had been added. The apparatus below was used.
glass cover
beaker
paper
solvent
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
solvent front
colours from
artificial colours fruit drink
(i) How many different coloured compounds were present in the fruit drink?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Are there any of the artificial colours present in the fruit drink? Explain your answer.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 6]
4 A student investigated the reaction between two different solutions of dilute hydrochloric acid, A
and B, and solution C which is alkaline.
(a) Experiment 1
A burette was filled with solution A of dilute hydrochloric acid to the 0.0 cm3 mark. Using a
measuring cylinder, 20 cm3 of solution C was poured into a conical flask. A few drops of methyl
orange were added to the flask.
Solution A was added to the flask, with shaking, until the mixture just changed colour.
Use the burette diagram to record the burette reading in the table and complete the table.
24
25
26
initial reading
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
The burette was emptied and rinsed, first with distilled water, and then with a little of
solution B. The burette was filled with solution B of dilute hydrochloric acid to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
final reading
[2]
(c) (i) What type of chemical reaction takes place when hydrochloric acid reacts with alkaline
solutions?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Why was the burette rinsed, first with distilled water and then with solution B, before starting
Experiment 2?
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) (i) In which experiment was the greater volume of dilute hydrochloric acid used?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Compare the volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in Experiments 1 and 2.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Suggest, in terms of the concentration of solutions A and B, an explanation for the
difference in volumes used.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(f) If Experiment 2 was repeated using 10 cm3 of solution C, what volume of dilute hydrochloric
acid would be used? Explain your answer.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(g) Give one advantage and one disadvantage of using a measuring cylinder for solution C.
advantage ..................................................................................................................................
(h) Describe a method other than titration, using a different reactant, that could be used to
compare the concentrations of the two solutions of dilute hydrochloric acid, A and B.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
[Total: 20]
tests observations
tests on solid D
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(f) What conclusions can you draw about the identity of solid D?
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 8]
6 Fizzy water
Fizzy water contains carbon dioxide dissolved under pressure. When the water is heated, the gas
is given off.
(a) (i) Complete the labelled diagram to show how you could collect and measure the volume of
gas given off when fizzy water is heated.
fizzy
water
heat
[2]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) A label on a bottle of fizzy water stated that ‘when evaporated completely the mass of solid
residue remaining is 200 mg / dm3 of water’.
Plan an experiment to check the mass of solid formed when the fizzy water is completely
evaporated. You are provided with a 500 cm3 bottle of fizzy water. You can use the space below
to draw a diagram of the apparatus used if you wish.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
[Total: 8]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October / November 2014 series for
most Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
explanation
double volume of gas (1)
faster reaction (1) [2]
(d) sketch graph less steep than original for Experiment 1 (1)
to same level (1) [2]
(b) when the solvent is near the top of the paper / before the solvent reaches the top of the
paper (1) [1]
6 (a) (i) gas syringe / inverted measuring cylinder in trough of water (1)
labelled (1) [2]
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice May/June 2014
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*8079009177*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 06_0620_11/2RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 The diagram shows the result of dropping a purple crystal into water.
water purple
after five hours solution
purple
crystal
chemical
diffusing dissolving
reaction
A
B
C
D
2 The four pieces of apparatus shown below are used in chemical experiments.
3 Alcohol and water are completely miscible. This means when mixed together they form only one
liquid layer.
A crystallisation
B filtration
C fractional distillation
D precipitation
e
key
e e e = electron
n = neutron
5p p = proton
6n
= nucleus
e e
What is X?
A boron
B carbon
C sodium
D sulfur
1 2
e e
e e
2p 3p key
2n 3n e = an electron
n = a neutron
e e
p = a proton
= nucleus
3 4
e e
e e
3p 3p
3n 4n
e e
e
Which two diagrams show atoms that are isotopes of each other?
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
7 Element X is in Group I of the Periodic Table. X reacts with element Y to form an ionic compound.
Which equation shows the process that takes place when X forms ions?
A X + e – → X+
B X – e – → X–
C X + e – → X–
D X – e – → X+
8 Solid F is an element.
Solid G is a compound.
Neither solid conducts electricity but G conducts electricity when dissolved in water.
These properties suggest that F is ……1…… and that G is ……2…… with ……3…… bonds.
1 2 3
9 A compound contains one atom of calcium, two atoms of hydrogen and two atoms of oxygen.
10 In athletics, banned drugs such as nandrolone have been taken illegally to improve performance.
Nandrolone has the molecular formula C18H26O2.
A aluminium
B copper
C plastic
D steel
12 Which products are formed at the anode and cathode when electricity is passed through molten
lead(II) bromide?
1 2
A C + O2 → CO2
D N2O4 → 2NO2
16 In separate experiments, a catalyst is added to a reaction mixture and the temperature of the
mixture is decreased.
What are the effects of these changes on the rate of the reaction?
catalyst temperature
added decreased
A faster faster
B faster slower
C slower faster
D slower slower
17 An experiment is carried out to investigate the rate of reaction when calcium carbonate is reacted
with hydrochloric acid.
The volume of carbon dioxide gas given off is measured at different intervals of time.
1 2 3
downward delivery gas measuring over water in
syringe graduated tube
Which apparatus is suitable to collect and measure the volume of the carbon dioxide?
forward reaction
CuSO4.5H2O CuSO4 + 5H2O
A
B
C
D
20 Only two elements are liquid at 20 °C. One of these elements is shiny and conducts electricity.
This suggests that this element is a ......1...... and therefore its oxide is ......2...... .
1 2
A metal acidic
B metal basic
C non-metal acidic
D non-metal basic
21 Which acid reacts with ammonia to produce the salt ammonium sulfate?
A hydrochloric
B nitric
C phosphoric
D sulfuric
A Elements in the same period have the same number of outer electrons.
B The elements on the left are usually gases.
C The most metallic elements are on the left.
D The relative atomic mass of the elements increases from right to left.
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
25 An element melts at 1455 °C, has a density of 8.90 g / cm3 and forms a green chloride.
26 The diagrams show two items that may be found in the home. Each item contains zinc.
bucket door-knocker
A
B
C
D
27 In an experiment, three test-tubes labelled X, Y and Z were half-filled with dilute hydrochloric
acid. A different metal was added to each test-tube. After a few minutes the following
observations were made.
resistance to
density strength
corrosion
C
D
1 2 3
For which uses is it important for the water to have been treated?
31 Four steel paper clips are treated as described before being placed in a beaker of water.
32 Which compound contains two of the three essential elements needed for a complete fertiliser?
A ammonium chloride
B ammonium nitrate
C ammonium phosphate
D ammonium sulfate
33 When compound X is heated, it changes colour from green to black. Compound Y is formed and
a gas is given off which turns limewater milky.
X Y
34 Acid rain is formed when sulfur dioxide and oxides of nitrogen dissolve in rain water.
A breathing difficulties
B dying trees
C erosion of statues
D lowered pH of lakes
A carbon monoxide
B methane
C nitrogen oxide
D sulfur dioxide
H H H
H C C C OH
H H H
A alcohol
B alkane
C alkene
D carboxylic acid
37 The table shows the composition of four different types of petroleum (crude oil).
gasoline 18 21 21 23
kerosene 11.5 13 13 15
diesel oil 18 20 20 24
fuel oil 52.5 46 46 38
A Arabian Heavy
B Arabian Light
C Iranian Heavy
D North Sea
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Tin Antimony Tellurium Xenon
0620/11/M/J/14
Indium Iodine
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2014 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2014 0620 11
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 D 21 D
2 A 22 A
3 C 23 C
4 A 24 D
5 D 25 C
6 C 26 C
7 D 27 C
8 B 28 C
9 D 29 B
10 C 30 A
11 C 31 D
12 B 32 C
13 A 33 C
14 B 34 A
15 A 35 B
16 B 36 A
17 B 37 D
18 B 38 B
19 D 39 B
20 B 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 May/June 2014
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 06_0620_21/2RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 (a) Choose from the list of substances below to answer the following questions.
calcium oxide
carbon dioxide
carbon monoxide
copper
hydrogen
magnesium
methane
oxygen
water
Each substance may be used once, more than once or not at all.
Which substance:
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) is produced at the cathode when concentrated aqueous sodium chloride is electrolysed,
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Complete the following sentences about the Periodic Table of elements using words from the
list below.
Chlorine, bromine and iodine are elements in Group ......................... of the Periodic Table.
They all react rapidly with ......................... to form ionic compounds. [4]
[Total: 9]
2 In 1904, J. J. Thomson suggested a model of the atom. He called this the ‘plum pudding’ model.
This model of an atom, containing 14 electrons, is shown below.
electrons
(a) Describe how Thomson’s model of the atom differs from our present ideas of the structure of
an atom.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
(b) Lithium has two naturally-occurring isotopes. These can be written as:
6 7
3 Li and 3 Li
(i) Describe the difference between these isotopes.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
Deduce:
(d) Lithium reacts with water. An alkaline solution and a colourless gas are formed.
pH 2 pH 5 pH 7 pH 13
[1]
[2]
[Total: 12]
3 The table shows some fractions obtained from the distillation of petroleum.
(a) What is the relationship between the number of carbon atoms and the boiling points of the
fractions?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) State the names of two petroleum fractions not given in the table.
(c) Two of the compounds present in refinery gas are methane and ethane.
(i) Draw the structure of ethane. Show all atoms and bonds.
[1]
(ii) Complete the dot and cross diagram of methane to show all the electrons.
H C H
[2]
C3H8 → ............... + H2
[1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
4 The diagram shows the changes of state when tin vapour is cooled slowly to room temperature.
(a) Explain what happens to the arrangement and motion of the atoms during these changes.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) The table below describes the reaction of some metals with dilute hydrochloric acid.
[2]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 11]
mixture of
iron ore
and coke
● the letter A to show where the air blast enters the furnace,
● the letter W to show where the waste gases exit the furnace.
[2]
(c) In the furnace, the coke burns to form carbon dioxide. This reaction is exothermic.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
test ......................................................................................................................................
(d) In the blast furnace, carbon dioxide reacts with more coke to form carbon monoxide.
The carbon monoxide reduces iron(III) oxide to iron.
How does this equation show that iron(III) oxide is being reduced?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 7]
H H
H C C O H
H H
(a) On the structure above, put a ring around the alcohol functional group. [1]
(d) The diagram below shows how the rate of fermentation changes with temperature.
rate
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
temperature / °C
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
methanol CH4O – 94 65
ethanol C 2 H 6O –117 79 0.789
propanol C 3 H 8O –126 98 0.804
butanol C4H10O – 89 117 0.810
pentanol C5H12O – 79 138 0.815
(i) Describe how density changes with the number of carbon atoms in the alcohol.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Which one of these alcohols has the lowest melting point?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 10]
7 A student used chromatography to separate the dyes in the blue ink from a ball-point pen.
She used the equipment shown in the diagrams below.
(a) Complete the diagram below to show how she set up the apparatus.
[3]
(b) Describe how chromatography could be used by the student to separate the dyes.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
(c) The student used water as a solvent. Suggest a different solvent that she could use.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) The diagram below shows the results of the chromatography using the blue ink, B, and several
pure dyes, W, X, Y and Z.
B W X Y Z
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) How many dyes in the ink had been separated by this chromatography?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) The diagram shows the ball-point pen used in the experiment.
poly(ethene) cap
alloy tip
ink
● monomer,
● polymer.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
thermal
strength density
alloy conductivity
/ GPa in g / cm3
in W / m / K
(i) How does the strength of the steel and aluminium alloys vary with their thermal
conductivity?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Which one of these alloys is the best one to use to make the body of an aircraft?
Give two reasons for your answer.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 16]
(a) In the first step, zinc sulfide is heated in air to produce zinc oxide.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) In the second step, zinc oxide reacts with sulfuric acid to form zinc sulfate.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) In the third step, zinc is extracted from zinc sulfate by electrolysis using the cell shown below.
+ –
lead rod aluminium rod
[Total: 7]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/M/J/14
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2014 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2014 0620 21
[Total: 9]
(b) (i) different number of neutrons / different mass number / different nucleon
number [1]
(ii) pH 13 [1]
[Total: 12]
3 (a) the more (carbon) atoms, the higher the boiling point [1]
(c) (i) correct structure of ethane showing all atoms and bonds; [1]
[Total: 8]
[Total: 11]
5 (a) A shown correctly (on either left or right top pipes at base of furnace) [1]
W shown correctly on one of the two pipes at the top [1]
[Total: 7]
(b) (i) (on left) sugar / glucose / any other suitable sugar; [1]
(on right) carbon dioxide; [1]
(e) (i) (density) increases as the number of carbon atoms increases; [1]
allow: decreases as the number of C atoms gets lower
(iii) liquid because its melting point is below room temperature and boiling point
is above room temperature / becomes liquid at –79 °C (and does not become
a) gas until 138 °C / room temperature is between the boiling point and
melting point (room temperatures for last answer can be between 5 and
40 °C) [1]
[Total: 10]
let the solvent run up the paper / solvent moves the dyes up the paper / some
idea that solvent is needed for the movement of the spots; [1]
(c) any suitable solvent e.g. ethanol / butanol / ester / alcohol [1]
(e) (i) idea that ethene is the monomer / idea that monomers are the simple (or
basic) units which add together; [1]
idea that poly(ethene) is the polymer / idea that the polymer is formed by
adding ethene units / simple units combine to form polymer / idea that
polymer is a very long (hydrocarbon) chain; [1]
(f) (i) increasing strength decreases (thermal) conductivity / the lower the
conductivity the higher the strength; [1]
[Total: 16]
3 (O2); [1]
(ii) last / 4th box ticked (zinc at negative electrode and O2 at positive electrode); [1]
[Total: 7]
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 (Extended) May/June 2014
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 06_0620_31/2RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 The table below gives the composition of six particles which are either atoms or ions.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) Which particle is a negative ion and why has this particle got a negative charge?
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 7]
(i) Rain water is collected in reservoirs. How is it treated before entering the water supply?
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) In many regions, drinking water is obtained by the distillation of sea-water. Explain how
distillation separates the water from sea-water.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 7]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) What property of a gas molecule affects the speed at which it diffuses?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Helium is a gas used to fill balloons. It is present in the air in very small quantities. Diffusion can
be used to separate it from the air.
Air at 1000 °C is on one side of a porous barrier. The air which passes through the barrier has
a larger amount of helium in it.
(i) Why does the air on the other side of the barrier contain more helium?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Most helium is obtained from natural gas found in the USA. Natural gas contains methane and
7% helium. One possible way to obtain the helium would be to burn the methane.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Suggest why this would not be a suitable method to obtain the helium.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Suggest another method, other than diffusion, by which helium could be separated from
the mixture of gases in natural gas.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 7]
4 In the Periodic Table, the elements are arranged in columns called Groups and in rows called
Periods.
(a) (i) Complete the table for some of the elements in Period 3.
symbol Na Mg Al Si P S Cl
number of
valency electrons
valency
[2]
(ii) What is the relationship between the group number and the number of valency electrons?
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Explain the relationship between the number of valency electrons and the valency
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
[4]
(i) Describe how the type of oxide changes across this period.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Describe how the type of bonding in the chlorides formed by these elements changes
across this period.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 11]
BLANK PAGE
(a) Describe the extraction of zinc from its ore, zinc blende. Include at least one balanced equation
in your description.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 7]
6 Hydrogen peroxide decomposes to form water and oxygen. This reaction is catalysed by
manganese(IV) oxide.
The rate of this reaction can be investigated using the following apparatus.
oxygen gas
40 cm3 of aqueous hydrogen peroxide was put in the flask and 0.1 g of small lumps of manganese(IV)
oxide was added. The volume of oxygen collected was measured every 30 seconds. The results
were plotted to give the graph shown below.
volume of
oxygen
0
0 t t2 t3
1
time
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Explain the trend in reaction rate that you described in (a)(i).
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) The experiment was repeated using 0.1 g of finely powdered manganese(IV) oxide. All the
other variables were kept the same.
(i) On the axes opposite, sketch the graph that would be expected. [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Describe how you could show that the catalyst, manganese(IV) oxide, was not used up in the
reaction. Manganese(IV) oxide is insoluble in water.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(d) In the first experiment, the maximum volume of oxygen produced was 96 cm3 measured at
r.t.p. Calculate the concentration of the aqueous hydrogen peroxide in mol / dm3.
.......................................... [1]
[Total: 15]
(a) A series of experiments was carried out using the metals lead, magnesium, zinc and silver.
Each metal was added in turn to aqueous solutions of the metal nitrates.
= reacts
= does not react
metal
aqueous lead magnesium zinc silver
solution Pb Mg Zn Ag
lead(II)
nitrate
magnesium
nitrate
zinc
nitrate
silver
nitrate
[3]
Zn + Pb2+ → Zn2+ + Pb
[2]
(b) Another way of determining the order of reactivity of metals is by measuring the voltage and
polarity of simple cells. The polarity of a cell is shown by which metal is the positive electrode
and which metal is the negative electrode. An example of a simple cell is shown below.
voltmeter
V
+ –
lead electrode zinc electrode
electrolyte of
dilute acid
(i) Mark on the above diagram the direction of the electron flow. [1]
(ii) Explain, in terms of electron transfer, why the more reactive metal is always the negative
electrode.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) The following table gives the polarity of cells using the metals zinc, lead, copper and
manganese.
What information about the order of reactivity of these four metals can be deduced from
the table?
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iv) What additional information is needed to establish the order of reactivity of these four
metals using cells?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 12]
CH CH
CH3 CH3 n
This polymer is made by addition polymerisation. Draw the structural formula of its
monomer.
[1]
(ii) The two monomers shown below form a nylon which is a condensation polymer.
H 2N NH2
HOOC COOH
Draw its structural formula showing one repeat unit of the polymer.
[3]
(iii) Name the natural macromolecule which contains the same linkage as nylon.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) Explain the difference between addition polymerisation and condensation polymerisation.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
(c) Storage tanks for cold water are now made from polymers because they are cheaper than
metal tanks. Suggest two other advantages of making cold water tanks from polymers.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 14]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/M/J/14
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2014 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2014 0620 31
1 (a) A, D, E (1)
(b) C (1)
more electrons than protons / 36e– and 34p+ / it has gained electrons (1) [2]
[Total: 7]
[Total: 7]
3 (a) (i) (particles) spread to fill total available volume / move from high concentration
to low concentration / moves down a concentration gradient (1) [1]
(b) (i) helium atoms / molecules are lighter than molecules in air or N2 and O2
or helium is less dense than air or N2 and O2.
or helium diffuses (through the porous barrier) faster than air or N2 and
O2. (1) [1]
(ii) faster rate of diffusion / molecules move faster (at high temperatures). (1) [1]
[Total: 7]
4 (a) (i)
Group I II III IV V VI VII
number
symbol Na Mg Al Si P S Cl
number of 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
valency
electrons
valency 1 2 3 4 3 2 1
(1) for each line [2]
(iii) for Na to Al
the valency is the same as the number of valency (outer) electrons (1)
(because) this is the number of electrons lost (for full energy level) (1)
for P to Cl
the valency is 8 – [number of valency (outer) electrons]
or valency + valency electrons = 8 (1)
[Total: 11]
[Total: 7]
(rate at t3 zero / reaction stopped because) hydrogen peroxide is used up (1) [2]
(b) (i) steeper and must come from the origin (1)
final volumes the same (1) [2]
concentration of the hydrogen peroxide in mol / dm3 = 0.008 / 0.04 = 0.2 (1) [3]
[Total:15]
7 (a) (i)
aqueous lead magnesium zinc silver
solution Pb Mg Zn Ag
lead (II)
nitrate
magnesium
X
nitrate
zinc
nitrate
silver(I)
nitrate
(ii) Zn (1)
the more reactive metal / zinc will lose electrons more readily (making the
electrode negatively charged). (1) [2]
(iii) manganese and zinc are more reactive than lead (and / or copper) (1)
[Total: 12]
two correct amide links and rest of structure correct (including additional
monomers if seen) and correct continuation bonds (1) [3]
condensation: the polymer and a small molecule / water / HCl is formed (1) [2]
toxic gases when burnt or greenhouse gases produced when burned (1)
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2014
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*6529401984*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on page 2 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB14 06_0620_51CI/4RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
(d) 100 cm3 of aqueous hydrochloric acid of concentration 0.2 mol / dm3, labelled hydrochloric
acid
[H] (e) 50 cm3 of an aqueous solution which is a mixture of sodium hydroxide, NaOH, of concentration
0.05 mol / dm3, and sodium carbonate, Na2CO3, of concentration 0.05 mol / dm3 labelled
solution R
For Question 2
[N] [H] (a) a stoppered test-tube containing about 1 g of manganese(II) sulfate crystals, MnSO4.1H2O,
labelled solid U
(d) splints
(h) aqueous barium nitrate of suitable concentration to give a positive sulfate test
[N] [H] (j) aqueous silver nitrate of suitable concentration to give a positive halide test
(l) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
JUNE 2014
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2014
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 06_0620_51/4RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate what happens when dilute hydrochloric acid reacts with an
aqueous solution R, containing two different substances S and T.
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
You are going to carry out three experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Using a measuring cylinder, pour 25 cm3 of solution R into the conical flask. Add five drops of
the phenolphthalein indicator to the flask.
Fill the burette with hydrochloric acid to the 0.0 cm3 mark. Using the burette, add hydrochloric
acid to solution R and shake the flask. Continue to add hydrochloric acid to the flask until the
colour just disappears.
Record the volume of hydrochloric acid added when the indicator changes colour.
Keep the mixture in the flask for Experiment 2.
burette readings
difference / cm3
[3]
(b) Experiment 2
Add four drops of methyl orange indicator to the mixture in the flask from Experiment 1.
Check that the burette reading is the same as your final reading in Experiment 1. This is the
initial volume reading for Experiment 2.
Using the burette, add hydrochloric acid to the mixture in the flask and shake the mixture.
Record the volume of hydrochloric acid added when the indicator just changes colour.
burette readings
difference / cm3
[4]
(c) Experiment 3
Pour about 5 cm3 of solution R into a test-tube. Using a teat pipette, add hydrochloric acid to
the solution. Note any observations.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) (i) When phenolphthalein indicator was used in Experiment 1 the colour changed
(ii) What was the colour of the indicator at the end-point in Experiment 2?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) The volume of hydrochloric acid added in Experiment 1 reacted with all of substance S and half
of substance T.
The volume of hydrochloric acid in Experiment 2 reacted with half of substance T.
(i) Work out the volume of hydrochloric acid which reacted with substance S.
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Work out the volume of hydrochloric acid which reacted with substance T.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Compare the volumes of hydrochloric acid which reacted with substances S and T.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) (i) Predict the volume of hydrochloric acid which would be added in Experiments 1 and 2 if
the experiments were repeated using 100 cm3 of solution R. Explain your answer.
Experiment 1 ......................................................................................................................
Experiment 2 ......................................................................................................................
(ii) Suggest a practical problem that would occur when carrying out these repeat experiments
and how you could solve this problem.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 22]
tests observations
tests on solid U
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 18]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/51 Paper 5 (Practical Test), maximum raw mark 40
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2014 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2014 0620 51
to colourless (1)
not: clear [2]
(ii) volume of acid used > 50 cm3 / more than burette can hold (1)
2 tests on solid U
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2014
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB14 06_0620_61/2RP
© UCLES 2014 [Turn over
2
1 A student separated a mixture of two alcohols, ethanol (boiling point 78 C) and
butanol (boiling point 118 C).
The apparatus used is shown below.
mixture of
alcohols
heat
(a) Complete the boxes to identify the pieces of apparatus labelled. [2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) How would the student know when all of this liquid had collected?
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 9]
10 cm3 of aqueous lead nitrate was placed in a beaker and 10 cm3 of aqueous potassium
chloride added. Lead chloride, a white solid, was formed. The solid was separated from the
mixture.
Water was then added to the solid and the mixture boiled. A clear liquid was formed. On
cooling, white crystals were deposited.
(a) What type of chemical reaction resulted in the formation of the lead chloride?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) What method should be used to separate the crystals from the mixture?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 4]
3 A student investigated the reaction of zinc powder with dilute hydrochloric acid using the apparatus
below.
gas syringe
hydrochloric acid
zinc
The same mass of zinc was added to different volumes of hydrochloric acid at room temperature,
20 C. The total volume of hydrogen gas given off in each experiment was measured.
(a) Use the gas syringe diagrams to record the volumes of hydrogen gas in the table.
volume of
volume of hydrogen gas
hydrochloric acid gas syringe diagram
/ cm3
/ cm3
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
5
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
10
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
15
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
20
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
30
0 10 20 30 40 50 60
40
[3]
(b) On the grid, plot the points and draw a smooth line graph.
60
40
volume of
hydrogen
gas / cm3
20
0
0 10 20 30 40
volume of hydrochloric acid / cm3
[4]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Use your graph to work out the volume that would be expected to be formed.
Show clearly on the grid how you got your answer.
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) Explain why the volume of hydrogen gas does not increase after 30 cm3 of hydrochloric acid.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) Sketch on the grid the graph you would expect if the experiments were repeated using the
same mass of zinc granules. [2]
[Total: 15]
4 A student investigated the reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and an aqueous alkaline
solution R, containing two different substances, S and T.
Experiment 1
Using a measuring cylinder, 25 cm3 of solution R was poured into a conical flask and five drops of
phenolphthalein were added to the flask.
A burette was filled with hydrochloric acid up to the 0.0 cm3 mark. Hydrochloric acid was added to
the solution R and the flask shaken. Addition of hydrochloric acid was continued until the colour just
disappeared.
The mixture in the flask was kept for Experiment 2.
(a) Use the burette diagram to record the final volume in the table of results and complete the
table.
16
17
18
final burette reading
burette readings
final volume / cm3
initial volume / cm3
difference / cm3
[3]
Experiment 2
Five drops of methyl orange indicator were added to the mixture in the flask from Experiment 1. The
mixture turned yellow. The initial volume reading of the burette was the same as the final reading
in Experiment 1. Hydrochloric acid was added from the burette to the mixture in the flask and the
mixture shaken.
The volume of hydrochloric acid added was recorded when the indicator just changed colour.
(b) Use the burette diagram to record the final volume in the table of results and complete the
table.
24
25
26
final burette reading
burette readings
final volume / cm3
initial volume / cm3
difference / cm3
[3]
© UCLES 2014 0620/61/M/J/14
7
(c) Experiment 3
(d) When phenolphthalein indicator was used in Experiment 1 the colour changed
(e) In a similar experiment, methyl orange indicator was used in Experiment 1 followed by
phenolphthalein in Experiment 2.
Suggest why this experiment would not work.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(g) The volume of hydrochloric acid added in Experiment 1 reacted with all of substance S and half
of substance T.
The volume of hydrochloric acid in Experiment 2 reacted with half of substance T.
(i) Work out the volume of hydrochloric acid which reacted with substance S.
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Work out the volume of hydrochloric acid which reacted with substance T.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Compare the volumes of hydrochloric acid which reacted with substances S and T.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) (i) The experiments were repeated using 100 cm3 of solution R.
Predict the volume of hydrochloric acid which would be added in Experiments 1 and 2.
Explain your answer.
Experiment 1 ......................................................................................................................
Experiment 2 ......................................................................................................................
(ii) Suggest a practical problem that would occur when carrying out these repeat experiments
and how you could solve this problem.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 18]
tests observations
tests on solid U
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 7]
6 Nuts contain oil. Nuts can be burned to produce energy. The apparatus shown can be used to
compare the energy produced by burning different nuts.
thermometer
water
nut
Plan an investigation to show which of three different types of nut produce the most energy. You are
provided with peanuts, brazil nuts and hazelnuts.
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... [7]
[Total: 7]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2014 series for most IGCSE, GCE
Advanced Level and Advanced Subsidiary Level components and some Ordinary Level components.
Page 2 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
IGCSE – May/June 2014 0620 61
condenser (1)
allow condensing tube, condensating tube, etc. [2]
(b) arrows labelled – water (in) and water (out) (1) [1]
(ii) leak / loss / escape of gas or wrong amount / too little HC l or zinc (1) [1]
allow: syringe sticking
initial and final volume boxes completed correctly (1) 0.0 and 16.8
initial (1) and final volume (1) boxes completed correctly 16.8 (1) and 25.2 (1)
(e) coloured reacting mixture masks colour of phenolphthalein / reaction is finished / solution is
acidic (1) [1]
(ii) volume of acid used > 50 cm3 / more than burette can hold (1)
set up more than two burettes / 100.8 won’t fit into 2 (1) [2]
allow: impurities / contamination (1)
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice May/June 2015
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*4319041575*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 06_0620_11/3RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
1 The changes that occur when a substance changes state are shown below.
W X
solid liquid gas
Z Y
1 2 3 4
A W X Y Z
B W Y X Z
C X Y Z W
D X Z Y W
2 A student uses the apparatus shown in the diagram below to measure the volume of carbon
dioxide gas made when different masses of marble chips are added to 25 cm3 of dilute
hydrochloric acid.
gas syringe
bung
25 cm3 dilute
hydrochloric acid
marble chips
key
e
p proton
n n e electron
p
p n p
n neutron
n p n
What is X?
A aluminium
B beryllium
C boron
D fluorine
5 Which statements comparing the properties of electrons, neutrons and protons are correct?
A
B
C
D
6 Rescuers are drilling through fallen rock in order to rescue some men trapped in a cave. The drill
needs lubricating from time to time.
The following statements were made about the materials used for the drill tip and the lubricant
and the reasons for their use.
1 Diamond was used for the drill tip as it does not conduct electricity.
2 Diamond was used for the drill tip as it is very hard.
3 Graphite was used as the lubricant as it conducts electricity.
4 Graphite was used as the lubricant as it is soft and flaky.
1 methane
2 lead bromide
3 sodium chloride
A 50 B 68 C 100 D 204
copper hydrogen
A anode anode
B anode cathode
C cathode anode
D cathode cathode
3V
– +
copper sulfate
solution
A B
steam flame
water
natural gas
calcium oxide
C D
final temperature
initial temperature
alkali
heat acid
12 Powdered marble reacts with hydrochloric acid using the apparatus shown.
gas syringe
gas
How long does it take to fill the gas syringe in this experiment?
A 9 seconds
B 18 seconds
C 36 seconds
D 72 seconds
13 When pink crystals of cobalt(II) chloride are heated, steam is given off and the colour of the solid
changes to blue.
colour temperature
CrO3
B
A
Cr CrO CrO2
C
D
Cr2O3
substance pH
W 7
X 9
Y 2
Z 5
Which row shows the colour of each solution after the indicator is added?
W X Y Z
The acid reacts with the oxide layer on the surface of the metal, forming a salt and water.
A alloy
B base
C element
D indicator
17 Four steps to prepare a salt from an excess of a solid base and an acid are listed.
1 crystallisation
2 evaporation
3 filtration
4 neutralisation
A 2→3→4→1
B 3→1→2→4
C 4→2→1→3
D 4→3→2→1
18 Which two compounds give a white precipitate when their aqueous solutions are mixed?
A high 0.97
B high 8.93
C low 0.07
D low 3.12
20 Which properties of the element titanium, Ti, can be predicted from its position in the Periodic
Table?
A
B
C
D
22 In the outline of the Periodic Table below, some elements are shown as numbers.
1 2
3 4
5 6
7
23 Solder is an alloy of lead and tin. It is used for joining pieces of metal.
heated solder
molten solder
metal
A making brass
B making cutlery
C making electrical wiring
D making food containers
25 Which row describes the conditions used to make steel from the iron produced by a blast
furnace?
calcium oxide
oxygen heat
(lime)
A
B
C
D
What is the correct order of these metals in the reactivity series (most reactive first)?
A X, W, Y, Z B X, Y, W, Z C Z, W, Y, X D Z, Y, W, X
A B C D
sedimentation filtration anti-bacterial storage mains
reservoir
tank tank treatment tank tank supply
A carbon dioxide
B carbon monoxide
C nitrogen
D oxygen
29 Which combination of chemical compounds could be used to produce the fertiliser shown?
N P K
21 : 16 : 8
SUPERGROW
A (NH4)3PO4, KCl
B NH4NO3, Ca3(PO4)2
C NH4NO3, CO(NH2)2
D NH4NO3, K2SO4, (NH4)2SO4
30 The pollutants released into the air from car exhausts and some power stations include oxides of
the type XO and YO2.
X Y
32 Carbon dioxide and methane are ‘greenhouse gases’ which contribute to global warming.
waste gases
lime kiln
limestone
fuel in fuel in
air in air in
A calcium carbonate
B calcium hydroxide
C calcium oxide
D calcium sulfate
H H H H H H H
H C H H C C H C C H C C O H
H H H H H H H
A 1 and 2 only
B 1 and 3
C 1, 2 and 4
D 2, 3 and 4
alkene alkane
A A B and C
B B A and C
C C A and B
D – A and C
A 1 and 2 only
B 1 and 3 only
C 2 and 3 only
D 1, 2 and 3
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Tin Antimony Tellurium Xenon
0620/11/M/J/15
Indium Iodine
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 B 21 C
2 C 22 D
3 C 23 B
4 B 24 D
5 B 25 A
6 D 26 B
7 A 27 C
8 C 28 B
9 D 29 A
10 D 30 D
11 C 31 A
12 D 32 D
13 B 33 C
14 A 34 C
15 B 35 B
16 B 36 D
17 D 37 A
18 A 38 C
19 A 39 B
20 B 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 May/June 2015
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 06_0620_21/2RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
A B C
O C O H C C H
CO32– Ca2+ CO32– Ca2+
H H
Ca2+ CO32– Ca2+ CO32–
D E F
C C
C
C C
C C H H Zn2+ CO32– Zn2+ CO32–
C
C C C C
C C C
C C C C
C
CO32– Zn2+ CO32– Zn2+
H H
C C Zn2+ CO32– Zn2+ CO32–
C C C C
C C C C
C C C C
C
C C
C C C CO32– Zn2+ CO32– Zn2+
C C
(iii) is added to the blast furnace to help in the extraction of iron, .......................... [1]
(b) Complete the word equation for the thermal decomposition of substance B.
heat
............................................... calcium oxide + ...............................................
[2]
test .............................................................................................................................................
result ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 10]
2 A small piece of sodium is added to some ethanol. The temperature was measured before and after
the sodium was added.
19 °C 29 °C
sodium
ethanol
(a) Explain how this experiment shows that the reaction is exothermic.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) Complete the structure of ethanol to show all atoms and bonds.
H C
H
[1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
enzyme catalyst
presence of light
[2]
(iii) What will be observed when ethene is bubbled through aqueous bromine?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
Suggest how the ethanol can be purified from this fermentation mixture.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 9]
3 The diagram shows the apparatus used for the electrolysis of molten sodium bromide.
+ –
S U
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.......................... [1]
(b) Complete the word equation for the electrolysis of molten sodium bromide.
pH 0 pH 6 pH 7 pH 10 pH 14
[1]
(d) The diagram below shows the arrangement of the particles in sodium bromide at room
temperature.
Na+ Br – Na+ Br –
P
Br – Na+ Br – Na+
Na+ Br – Na+ Br –
(i) Give the name of the type of particles, P, present in sodium bromide.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 11]
She measured the volume of gas given off at various times during the reaction.
(a) Complete the diagram of the apparatus she would use to measure the volume of the gas given
off.
Label the apparatus.
flask
hydrochloric
acid
magnesium
ribbon
[3]
(b) The student carried out the reaction at 25 °C using magnesium ribbon.
Her results are shown below.
60
50
40
volume of
gas / cm3 30
20
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140
time / seconds
(iii) On the grid above, draw a line to show how the volume of gas changes when the experiment
is carried out at 15 °C and all other conditions remain the same. [2]
(iv) The student repeated the experiment using magnesium powder. All other conditions
remain the same.
How does the rate of reaction with magnesium powder compare with the rate of reaction
with magnesium ribbon?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) (i) Draw a diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of hydrogen.
[1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
Give the name of two compounds which react together to form magnesium sulfate.
[Total: 12]
H O
H C C
O O H
H
(a) On the structure above, put a ring around the carboxylic acid functional group. [1]
(b) Glycolic acid is prepared by heating a mixture of methanal, carbon monoxide and water with a
sulfuric acid catalyst.
[1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Glycolic acid can also be prepared by the reduction of oxalic acid.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Give the name of the reducing agent in the following reaction.
heat
2CuO(s) + C(s) → 2Cu(s) + CO2(g)
Describe how you could obtain a solution of these pigments from grape skins.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
catalyst
ethene poly(ethene)
high temperature
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(f) Long chain alkanes can be cracked to produce shorter chain alkanes and alkenes.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Complete the equation for the cracking of hexadecane, C16H34, to form octane, C8H18, and
ethene only.
[Total: 13]
(a) (i) Which two metals in the table are Group I metals?
Give a reason for your answer.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
Give two properties of transition elements or their compounds that make them different
from metals A, B, C and D.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
(b) When lithium reacts with water it moves about on the surface of the water, bubbles are seen
and the lithium disappears slowly.
Predict how the reaction of potassium with water compares with the reaction of lithium with
water.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
[Total: 14]
syringe
plunger
syringe
water helium
Describe and explain these results using ideas about particles in liquids and gases.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(b) The table shows some properties of the Group 0 elements helium, neon, argon and krypton.
density of the
electron melting point boiling point
element liquefied gas
arrangement / °C / °C
in g / cm3
(i) Describe how the density of the liquefied noble gases changes down Group 0.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) Which element in the table has the highest melting point?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) The table below shows the number of electrons, protons and neutrons in some isotopes of
helium, argon and neon.
10 10 11
.................
[3]
[Total: 11]
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/M/J/15
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
3(a)(i) breakdown / decomposition of compound using electricity; 1 A separation of compounds to elements using
electricity
A substances in place of compounds
A breakdown of ionic bonds using electricity
I separation of elements by electricity / plating using
electricity / separation of compounds to elements
unqualified / separating metals by electricity
3(a)(ii) U; 1
3(b) sodium / Na; R sodium ions
bromine / Br2; 2 R bromide / bromine water / Br
3(c) pH 7; 1
3(d)(i) ions / cations and anions; 1 A ionic / ionic bond
I cations on own / anions on own
3(d)(ii) solid
(particles / ions) close together; A atoms or molecules for ions
A packed together / no spaces / attached to each other /
held together
I comments about movement
(particles / ions) regularly arranged / in rows / lattice; 2 A fixed shape / fixed positions
I neat structure / reference to electrostatic forces
© Cambridge International Examinations 2015
Page 5 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – May/June 2015 0620 21
3(e) Br2;
2(Na); 2
3(f) atoms with same number of protons but different number of neutrons / A nucleon number for mass number
atoms with same atomic number but different number of neutrons / A elements with same number of protons but different
atoms with same number of protons but different mass number; 1 number of neutrons / atoms of same elements with
different numbers of neutrons
I atoms / elements with different (relative) atomic
masses
I same elements with different numbers of neutrons
I reference to molecules
I different neutrons (no number)
4(a) (gas) syringe or measuring cylinder correctly labelled; A burette / graduated test-tube drawn and labelled test-
tube
(gas) tube leading from closed apparatus to flask or from inverted measuring R if tube goes to surface of water or under water in
cylinder with mouth underwater to flask; reaction flask
ends up at same final volume; 2 A line not reached final volume but still going up and
likely to reach final volume
A final horizontal line two small squares below the 25 ºC
line
R if a single straight line is drawn from 0–0 to point
49–140
4(b)(iv) increased (rate) / faster (rate) / quicker; 1 I reference to time unless it contradicts increased rate
4(c)(i) pair of electrons between two (hydrogen) atoms; 1 hydrogen atoms do not have to be labelled H
4(c)(ii) covalent; 1 I single bond
4(d) sulfuric acid; A correct formulae
magnesium oxide / magnesium hydroxide / magnesium carbonate; 2 R magnesium
(grape skins) in water / in solvent / in named solvent; NOTE: mark for the idea that the grape skins are in
solvent but NOT solvent in context of chromatography.
I grapes in acids / alkalis
filter (off the solid / grape skins); 3
5(e) ethene; 1 A alkene
5(f)(i) high temperature; A heat / stated temperatures between 200–1000 oC
catalyst / aluminium oxide / zeolites; 2 A absence of oxygen (for 2nd mark)
I high pressure / enzymes (unqualified) / oxygen
5(f)(ii) 4 (C2H4); 1
hydrogen / H2;
7(a) • liquids / water have particles close together / touching; A no spaces between particles
• gases / helium have particles far apart / room between gas particles / more
space between gas particles;
• volume of liquid does not decrease / liquid not compressed / liquid not A syringe is not reduced
squeezed / plunger does not move;
• volume of gas decreases / gas compressed / plunger moves; 4 A syringe is reduced
I there is room / not room (reference to space between
particles)
7(b)(i) increases / gets larger; 1 A becomes heavier
7(b)(ii) 2,8; 1 A 2 in the first shell and 8 in the second
7(b)(iii) liquid; 1
7(b)(iv) krypton; 1
7(c) He: number of neutrons = 1;
Ar: number of electrons = 18;
symbol for neon is
21
10 Ne ; 3
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 (Extended) May/June 2015
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 06_0620_31/FP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) Two of the elements present in a sample of coal are carbon and sulfur.
A sample of coal was heated in the absence of air and the products included water, ammonia
and hydrocarbons.
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) Sulfur, present in coal, is one major cause of acid rain. Sulfur burns to form sulfur dioxide which
reacts with rain water to form sulfuric acid.
(i) Describe how the high temperatures in vehicle engines are another cause of acid rain.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) In 2010, a large coal-burning power station in the UK was converted to burn both coal and
wood.
Explain why the combustion of wood rather than coal can reduce the effect of the emissions
from this power station on the level of carbon dioxide in the atmosphere.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 12]
2 Iron from the Blast Furnace is impure. It contains about 5% of impurities, mainly carbon, sulfur,
silicon and phosphorus, which have to be removed when this iron is converted into steel.
(a) Explain how the addition of oxygen and calcium oxide removes these impurities. Include an
equation for a reaction of oxygen and a word equation for a reaction of calcium oxide in this
process.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[5]
(b) Mild steel is the most common form of steel. Mild steel contains a maximum of 0.3% of carbon.
High carbon steel contains 2% of carbon. It is less malleable and much harder than mild steel.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
(iv) Suggest an explanation why high carbon steel is less malleable and harder than mild
steel.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 12]
3 (a) The reactions between metals and acids are redox reactions.
Zn + 2H+ → Zn2+ + H2
(i) Which change in the above reaction is oxidation, Zn to Zn2+ or 2H+ to H2? Give a reason
for your choice.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Which reactant in the above reaction is the oxidising agent? Give a reason for your choice.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) The rate of reaction between a metal and an acid can be investigated using the apparatus
shown below.
20 40 60 80 100
gas syringe
hydrochloric acid
zinc foil
A piece of zinc foil was added to 50 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, of concentration 2.0 mol / dm3. The
acid was in excess. The hydrogen evolved was collected in the gas syringe and its volume
measured every minute. The results were plotted and labelled as graph 1.
graph 1
volume
0
0 time
The experiment was repeated to show that the reaction between zinc metal and hydrochloric
acid is catalysed by copper. A small volume of aqueous copper(II) chloride was added to the
acid before the zinc was added. The results of this experiment were plotted on the same grid
and labelled as graph 2.
(i) Explain why the reaction mixture in the second experiment contains copper metal. Include
an equation in your explanation.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Explain how graph 2 shows that copper catalyses the reaction.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
(c) If the first experiment was repeated using ethanoic acid, CH3COOH, instead of hydrochloric
acid, how and why would the graph be different from graph 1?
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(d) Calculate the maximum mass of zinc which will react with 50 cm3 of hydrochloric acid, of
concentration 2.0 mol / dm3.
Zn + 2HCl → ZnCl 2 + H2
[3]
[Total: 16]
(a) (i) Give three characteristics which all members of a homologous series share.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
(iii) Deduce the molecular formula of the alcohol whose Mr = 158. Show your working.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
CH3
CH3
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(i) When butan-1-ol, CH3–CH2–CH2–CH2–OH, is passed over the catalyst silicon(IV) oxide,
water is lost.
Deduce the name and the structural formula of the organic product in this reaction.
name .........................................
structural formula
[2]
(ii) Suggest the name of the ester formed from butanol and ethanoic acid.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
Deduce the name and the structural formula of the organic product in this reaction.
name .........................................
structural formula
[2]
[Total: 13]
5 The halogens are a group of non-metals in Group VII of the Periodic Table.
Describe an experiment which shows that chlorine is more reactive than iodine. Include an
equation in your answer.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
(b) The halogens form interhalogen compounds. These are compounds which contain two different
halogens.
Deduce the formula of the compound which has the composition 0.013 moles of iodine atoms
and 0.065 moles of fluorine atoms.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) Iodine reacts with chlorine to form a dark brown liquid, iodine monochloride.
chlorine
supplied
crystals
of iodine
When more chlorine is added and the tube is sealed, a reversible reaction occurs and the
reaction comes to equilibrium.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) Chlorine is removed from the tube and a new equilibrium is formed.
Explain why there is less of the yellow solid and more dark brown liquid in the new equilibrium
mixture.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) A sealed tube containing the equilibrium mixture is placed in ice-cold water. There is an increase
in the amount of yellow solid in the equilibrium mixture.
What can you deduce about the forward reaction in this equilibrium?
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 13]
(i) In terms of proton transfer, explain what is meant by the term weak base.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Given aqueous solutions of both bases, describe how you could show that sodium
hydroxide is the stronger base. How could you ensure a ‘fair’ comparison between the two
solutions?
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
(i) Complete the equation for the reaction between sulfuric acid and ethylamine. Name the
salt formed.
(ii) Amines and their salts have similar chemical properties to ammonia and ammonium salts.
Suggest a reagent that could be used to displace the weak base, ethylamine, from its salt
ethylammonium chloride.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Gases diffuse, which means that they move to occupy the total available volume.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) When the colourless gases hydrogen bromide and ethylamine come into contact, a white
solid is formed.
The following apparatus can be used to compare the rates of diffusion of the two gases
ethylamine and hydrogen bromide.
A B C
Predict at which position, A, B or C, the white solid will form. Explain your choice.
.............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 14]
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
12
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/M/J/15
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
1(a) Any two fossil fuels from: I ethane / oil / naphtha / coal / gas
crude oil / petroleum;
natural gas / methane; R coke / bitumen / lubricating oil / wood
petrol / gasoline;
kerosene / paraffin;
diesel (oil) / gas oil;
fuel oil;
refinery gas / LPG;
propane;
butane; 2
1(b) hydrogen, oxygen, nitrogen; 2 A H, O, N
All three for 2 marks I H2, O2, N2
two for 1 mark
1(c)(i) M1 oxygen and nitrogen (from air) react; A nitrogen combust for M1
R M1 if oxygen or nitrogen originate from
the fuel
M2 oxides of nitrogen OR nitrogen oxide(s) are formed; A named oxide of nitrogen e.g. nitrogen
dioxide
A correct formulae
A NOx
M3 nitrogen oxides formed react with water (to form acid); 3
M1 lowers pH or acidifies lakes / rivers or kills fish; R ‘increases pH of lakes so kills fish’ for M1
M2 changes composition of soils or reduces fertility of soil or reduces crop A removes nutrients / leaches the soil
yields deforestation or kills crops / trees / plants / leaves;
M3 rows or layers slide over one another; 3 A ECF on particle named in M1 for M3
I ‘atoms’ slide over one another
2(b)(iv) M1 carbon atoms or particles in structure different size (to cations); R ions and molecules for M1
it accepts electrons or takes electrons (from zinc atoms); 2 A because it is reduced or because it
decreases in oxidation number
A it causes zinc to lose electrons
3(b)(i) zinc displaces copper or zinc more reactive than copper; A copper less reactive than zinc
I zinc reacts with copper ions or with Cu2+
or with copper chloride
I zinc reacts with copper
I Cu2+ ions are reduced
if not, look for evidence of some correct working for one mark 2 A (10 × 12) + (22 × 1) + 16 = 158 for one
158 – 17 = 141 (working) mark
OR
12n + 2n + 1 = 141
OR
n = 10
4(b) they have the same molecular formula (C4H10O); A same number of each type of atom
I same number of atoms
M3 A multiples
Cl2 + 2KI 2KCl + I2 I state symbols but KI(aq) would allow the
Cl2 + 2I– 2Cl – + I2 ; 3 solution aspect of mark in M1
5(b) M1 (0.013 moles of I and 0.065 moles of F atoms gives a) ratio 1:5; Award 2 marks for IF5
5(c)(i) example of a reversible reaction including attempts at removing / adding A written description of the reaction e.g.
waters of crystallisation ‘Haber process’ unless equation is
OR example of a reaction which under closed conditions would be reversible; 1 attempted in which case ignore written
description
A word equations / unbalanced equations
A equations without equilibrium arrows
I descriptions of physical changes
5(c)(ii) Any two from: I reference to ‘closed system’
(a reaction)
M1 which can take place in both directions OR which can be approached A ‘a reaction which can go forwards and
from both directions; backwards’ for M1
I ‘a reaction with an equilibrium arrow’ or
with ‘⇌’ for M1
M2 in which concentrations / macroscopic properties do not change (with R concentrations (of reactants and
time); products) are the same
M2 because the concentration of chlorine decreases; 2 A ‘reactant’ for ‘chlorine’ but not reactants
A to replace missing chlorine
5(e) M1 equilibrium goes to RHS OR equilibrium goes to products side; A reaction goes to RHS but
R ‘equilibrium goes to RHS and to
reactants side’
A forward reaction is favoured
I more yield or more products
M2 exothermic reactions are favoured by low temperatures; A for M1 and M2 ‘decreasing temperature
makes the equilibrium go to RHS’
M2 does not accept (protons) readily A ‘hydrogen ion’ or ‘H+’ for proton
OR less able to accept protons (than strong bases); 2 I accepts fewer / less protons
6(a)(ii) M1 same concentration of both bases;
M3 the higher pH is the stronger base; 3 A suitable colours of both weak strong
bases e.g. ethylamine is (greeny)blue,
NaOH is darker blue / purple
6(b)(ii) sodium hydroxide / calcium hydroxide / NaOH / Ca(OH)2 ; 1 A any Group 1 or Group 2 hydroxide or
oxide
6(c)(i) Any two from:
(particles move in) random motion;
(particles) move from a region of high concentration to low concentration; 2 A down a concentration gradient
6(c)(ii) C;
M2 it has a lower (relative) molecular mass (than HBr); A ethylamine is less dense
A ethylamine is a lighter molecule but
M3 ethylamine diffuses faster (than HBr); I ‘ethylamine is lighter’
3 I ethylamine is a smaller molecule
A ethylamine molecules or particles
move faster
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2015
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*9170745782*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB15 06_0620_51CI/3RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
[C] (d) 150 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide, NaOH, of concentration 1.0 mol / dm3, labelled aqueous
sodium hydroxide for question 1
[H] (e) 100 cm3 of aqueous hydrochloric acid, HCl, of concentration 2.0 mol / dm3, labelled acid A
[C] (f) 100 cm3 of aqueous sulfuric acid, H2SO4, of concentration 2.0 mol / dm3, labelled acid B
For Question 2
(e) aqueous barium nitrate of concentration suitable to give a positive test for sulfate ions
[N][H] (i) aqueous silver nitrate of concentration suitable to give a positive halide test
(j) spatula
(o) splints
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
JUNE 2015
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2015
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 06_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate what happens when aqueous sodium hydroxide reacts with aqueous
solutions of two different acids, A and B.
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Use a measuring cylinder to pour 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide into the polystyrene
cup provided. Put the cup into a 250 cm3 beaker for support. Measure the initial temperature of
the solution and record it in the table below.
Fill the burette with the solution of acid A provided to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
Add 5.0 cm3 of acid A to the aqueous sodium hydroxide in the cup and stir the mixture.
Measure and record the maximum temperature of the solution in the table below. Add a further
5.0 cm3 of acid A to the cup and stir the mixture. Measure and record the temperature of the
mixture in the table below.
Continue to add 5.0 cm3 portions of acid A to the cup, until a total volume of 40 cm3 of acid has
been added. Stir after each addition and measure and record the temperatures in the table.
At the end of this experiment, pour the solution away and rinse the polystyrene cup.
temperature of solution
volume of acid A added / cm3
in polystyrene cup / °C
0.0
5.0
10.0
15.0
20.0
25.0
30.0
35.0
40.0
[3]
(b) Experiment 2
Empty the burette and rinse it with distilled water. Half fill the burette with the solution of acid B
and swirl the contents. Discard this acid.
Now fill the burette to the 0.0 cm3 mark with the solution of acid B.
temperature of solution
volume of acid B added / cm3
in polystyrene cup / °C
0.0
5.0
10.0
15.0
20.0
25.0
30.0
35.0
40.0
[3]
(c) Plot the results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid and draw a smooth line graph for each
experiment.
Clearly label your graphs.
50
40
temperature
of solution
/ °C
30
20
10
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40
volume of acid added / cm3
[5]
(d) Use your graph to estimate the temperature of the reaction mixture when 8 cm3 of acid B were
added to 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your answer.
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) What type of chemical reaction, other than neutralisation, occurs when acid A reacts with
sodium hydroxide?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(f) Why was the burette rinsed firstly with distilled water and then with acid B before starting
Experiment 2?
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Suggest why the maximum temperature change is greater in this experiment.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) Describe one source of error in Experiment 2. Suggest an improvement to reduce this source
of error.
[Total: 20]
2 You are provided with solid C, which is a salt containing two cations and one anion.
Carry out the following tests on solid C recording all of your observations in the table.
Conclusions must not be written in the table.
tests observations
tests on solid C
tests on a solution of C
(g) What does test (b) tell you about the nature of solid C?
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(h) What does test (e) tell you about the nature of solid C?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) What conclusions can you draw about the identity of solid C?
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 20]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/51 Paper 5 (Practical), maximum raw mark 40
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2015
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
MODIFIED LANGUAGE
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 06_0620_61/RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
1 Ethanol was reacted with hot acidified potassium manganate(VII) solution using the apparatus
below. Ethanoic acid was formed.
condenser
ethanol +
electric acidified potassium
heater
manganate(VII)
(a) (i) Complete the box to identify the piece of apparatus labelled. [1]
(b) (i) Suggest and explain why an electric heater is used to heat this reaction and not a
Bunsen burner.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Complete the table to show the difference in smell between ethanol and ethanoic acid.
smell
ethanol
ethanoic acid
[2]
[Total: 7]
2 Electricity was passed through molten lead(II) bromide using the apparatus shown.
light bulb
electrodes
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) (i) Name a non-metal that could be used for the electrodes.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Suggest the result of testing this gas with damp blue litmus paper.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(e) State one safety precaution that should be used when doing this experiment.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 7]
3 A mixture of coloured dyes, M, was separated by chromatography. The dyes were insoluble in
water.
The chromatogram below shows the result of separating the mixture and the chromatography of
three known dyes 1, 2 and 3.
1 2 3 M
known dyes
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) What are your conclusions about the identity of the dyes in the mixture, M?
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 7]
4 A student investigated the reaction of aqueous sodium hydroxide with aqueous solutions of two
different acids, A and B.
(a) Experiment 1
Using a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide solution was poured into a
polystyrene cup. The initial temperature of the solution was measured.
A burette was filled with the solution of acid A to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
5.0 cm3 of acid A was added to the aqueous sodium hydroxide in the cup and the mixture
stirred.
The temperature of the solution was measured. Another 5.0 cm3 of acid A was added to the
cup and the mixture stirred. The temperature of the mixture was measured.
More 5.0 cm3 portions of acid A were added to the cup until a total volume of 40.0 cm3 of acid
had been added. After each addition, the mixture was stirred and the temperature measured.
0.0 25
20
30
5.0 25
20
35
10.0 30
25
35
15.0 30
25
35
20.0 30
25
40
25.0 35
30
40
30.0 35
30
40
35.0 35
30
40
40.0 35
30
[3]
The burette was emptied and rinsed with distilled water, and then with acid B. This acid was
discarded. The burette was then filled up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with acid B.
(b) Experiment 2
0.0 25
20
40
5.0 35
30
45
10.0 40
35
45
15.0 40
35
40
20.0 35
30
40
25.0 35
30
40
30.0 35
30
40
35.0 35
30
40
40.0 35
30
[3]
(c) Plot the results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid and draw a smooth line graph for each
experiment.
Clearly label your graphs.
50
temperature of solution / °C
40
30
20
0 10 20 30 40
volume of acid added / cm3
[5]
(d) Use your graph to estimate the temperature of the reaction mixture when 8.0 cm3 of acid B
were added to 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) What type of chemical reaction, other than neutralisation, occurred when acid A reacted with
sodium hydroxide?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(f) Why was the burette rinsed firstly with distilled water and then with acid B before starting
Experiment 2?
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Suggest why the maximum temperature change was greater in this experiment.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) Describe one source of error in Experiment 2. Suggest one improvement to reduce this
source of error.
improvement ..............................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 20]
5 Solid C was analysed. Solid C was a mixture of salts containing aluminium ions, sulfate ions and
another cation (positive ion).
Tests on solid C, and some of the observations, are in the table.
Complete the observations in the table.
tests observations
tests on solid C
tests on a solution of C
(g) What does the formation of condensation in test (b) tell you about the nature of solid C?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(h) What does test (e) tell you about the nature of solid C?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) What is your conclusion about the identity of the other cation in solid C?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 11]
6 A catalyst is a substance that speeds up the rate of a chemical reaction and remains unchanged
at the end of the reaction.
Hydrogen peroxide solution, H2O2, breaks down to form oxygen. This decomposition is very slow
if a catalyst is not used.
Plan an investigation to show that copper(II) oxide is a suitable catalyst for this reaction.
You can use aqueous hydrogen peroxide and common laboratory apparatus.
Step 1 Show that copper(II) oxide catalyses the decomposition of hydrogen peroxide and
measure the rate of the reaction.
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
Step 2 Show that the copper(II) oxide is unchanged at the end of the decomposition.
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
[Total: 8]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
1(a)(i) flask; 1
1(a)(ii) top arrow water and bottom arrow water; 1
1(b)(i) to prevent fire / ref. to safety / controlled heating; I dangerous
ethanol is flammable; 2
1(b)(ii) to prevent evaporation / loss of reactants or ethanol; 1
1(c) ethanol: sweet / nail varnish remover / alcohol / spirit;
ethanoic acid: vinegar / sour / acid / sharp / pungent; 2 I strong / pleasant
4(a) 25, 27, 30, 32, 34, 36, 35, 34, 33 please put an ‘x’ by any incorrectly plotted
all 9 = 3 marks points
8 = 2 marks
7 = 1 mark 3
4(b) 25, 34, 41, 40, 39, 38, 37, 36, 34
all 9 = 3 marks
8 = 2 marks
7 = 1 mark 3
4(c) all 18 points plotted within half a small square = 3 marks
17 points plotted within half a small square = 2 marks
16 points plotted within half a small square = 1 mark;
smooth line graph;
labels; 5
4(d) value read from graph, 38.5 °C;
indication clearly shown; 2
4(e) exothermic; 1
5(c) white;
precipitate;
dissolves / clears; 3
5(d) white precipitate; 1
5(e) no reaction / no change / no precipitate / colourless solution; 1
5(f) white;
precipitate; 2
5(g) hydrated / water; 1
5(h) not a halide / not a named halide; 1
5(i)(i) ammonia / NH3; 1
5(i)(ii) ammonium / NH4+; 1
6 step 1
add copper oxide or catalyst to hydrogen peroxide;
measure volume of gas / mass loss / collect gas / count bubbles;
over time;
known volume of hydrogen peroxide;
compare to hydrogen peroxide on its own;
test gas with glowing splint;
splint relights;
step 2
filter copper(II) oxide;
dry;
weigh;
compare to original mass;
OR
filter (copper(II) oxide) / evaporate to dryness;
add to hydrogen peroxide;
measure rate of reaction;
compare to first experiment; max 8
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice October/November 2015
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*0290816641*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 20.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 11_0620_11/5RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
X Y Z
A X to Y B Y to Z C Z to X D Z to Y
P Q R S
50 cm3 25 cm3
3 3
100 cm 50 cm
Which row describes the correct apparatus for the measurement made?
4 Which diagram correctly shows the ions present in the compound potassium fluoride?
–
+ e e
e e e e
e e
e e e e e e
A K+ e e e e e e F–
key
e e
e e e e = nucleus
e e
e = electron
+
– e e
e e e e
e e
e e e e e e
B K– e e e e e e F+
e e
e e e e
e e
e e + –
e e e e
e e
e e e e e e
C K+ e e e e e e F–
e e
e e e e
e e
–
e e +
e e e e
e e
e e e e e e
D K– e e e e e e F+
e e
e e e e
e e
X Y
7 Two atoms of magnesium, Mg, react with one molecule of oxygen, O2.
A bromine hydrogen
B bromine potassium
C hydrogen bromine
D potassium bromine
steel
ceramic
aluminium
The mixture was stirred and the temperature recorded every 10 seconds.
25
20
15
temperature
/ °C
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
time / s
A neutralisation endothermic
B neutralisation exothermic
C thermal decomposition endothermic
D thermal decomposition exothermic
12 The effect of temperature on the rate of the reaction between marble chips and hydrochloric acid
can be investigated by measuring the production of carbon dioxide.
A condenser
B gas syringe
C stopclock
D thermometer
A VO2 → V2O3
B V2O5 → VO2
C V2O3 → VO
D V2O3 → V2O5
14 Some crystals of hydrated cobalt(II) chloride are heated in a test-tube until no further change is
observed.
The test-tube is allowed to cool and a few drops of water are then added to the contents.
W X
Y
Adding aqueous ammonia to the solution formed gives a white precipitate. Adding excess
aqueous ammonia causes the precipitate to re-dissolve.
A aluminium nitrate
B ammonium nitrate
C calcium carbonate
D zinc carbonate
18 Four stages in the preparation of a salt from an acid and a solid metal oxide are listed.
A 1→3→4→2
B 2→1→3→4
C 4→1→3→2
D 4→2→1→3
19 Which statements about Group I and Group VII elements are correct?
statement 1 statement 2
A
B
C
D
The melting points of Group I elements ....... 2 ....... down the group.
The melting points of Group VII elements ....... 3 ....... down the group.
1 2 3
A good 0.97 98
B good 7.86 1535
C poor 2.33 1410
D poor 3.12 –7
This gas is unreactive because it has ....... Y....... electrons in its outermost shell.
X Y
A argon eight
B argon two
C helium eight
D helium two
A B
– + –
+ – +
– + –
+ – +
– + –
+ – +
– + –
+ – +
– + –
C D
24 The diagrams show what happens when three different metals are added to water.
bubbles flame
of gas
X Y Z
X Y Z
A aluminium
B brass
C mild steel
D pure iron
A carbon dioxide
B hydrogen
C nitrogen
D oxygen
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
29 Carbon monoxide is an air pollutant produced when petrol is burned in a car engine.
30 Fertilisers are mixtures of different compounds used to increase the growth of crops.
Which pair of substances contains the three essential elements for plant growth?
air
water
Which diagram shows the level of the water at the end of the week?
A B C D
making
making lime
cement
1 2
limestone
A 1, 2 and 3
B 1 and 2 only
C 1 and 3 only
D 2 and 3 only
35 The diagram shows the structure of a simple hydrocarbon and the products of two of its
reactions.
1 2 3
H H H H H H
bromine steam
Br C C Br C C H C C O H
H H H H H H
dibromoethane ethane ethanol
structure
1 2 3
A
B
C
D
monomer polymer
A ethane poly(ethane)
B ethane poly(ethene)
C ethene poly(ethane)
D ethene poly(ethene)
1 fermentation
2 reaction between steam and ethene
1 2
A
B
C
D
H H H H H H
H C C C H H C C C H
H H H H O H H
H H H H H
H C C C O H H C C C H
H H O H H C H H
A alcohols
B alkanes
C alkenes
D carboxylic acids
Which row describes the size of the molecules in hydrocarbons P and Q and the effect of Q on
aqueous bromine?
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
20
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
0620/11/O/N/15
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/11 Paper 1 (Multiple Choice), maximum raw mark 40
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 B 21 B
2 A 22 D
3 C 23 C
4 C 24 A
5 D 25 A
6 D 26 A
7 A 27 C
8 B 28 C
9 A 29 D
10 C 30 C
11 A 31 C
12 A 32 B
13 D 33 B
14 C 34 A
15 D 35 B
16 D 36 D
17 A 37 A
18 C 38 A
19 D 39 C
20 C 40 A
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name in the spaces at the top of this page.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 11_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
A B C
Cl Cl Cl H
O
Al Al H H C
Cl Cl Cl H H
H
D E F
(b) Compound A can be made by direct combination of chlorine and aluminium using the apparatus
shown below.
compound A
aluminium foil Al 2Cl 6
(i) On the diagram above, draw an arrow to show where heat is applied. [1]
(ii) Suggest one safety precaution that should be taken when carrying out this experiment.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
2 A student measures the maximum temperature changes when five different solids, P, Q, R, S and T,
are dissolved separately in water. She uses the apparatus shown below.
solid
thermometer
stirrer
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) Suggest two factors which should be kept the same to make the experiment a fair test.
1. ................................................................................................................................................
2. .......................................................................................................................................... [2]
Q 18 23
R 19 16
S 22 23
T 20 18
(i) Which solid gave the greatest temperature change when dissolved in water?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Which solids gave an endothermic energy change when dissolved in water?
(ii) An isotope of radium, Ra, has 226 nucleons in its nucleus.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Fractions obtained from the distillation of petroleum are also sources of energy.
(i) Which one of the following fractions is used as a fuel for jet aircraft?
Put a ring around the correct answer.
Complete the equation for the cracking of heptadecane to form two hydrocarbons.
[Total: 11]
3 (a) Nickel is extracted from nickel(II) oxide, NiO, by heating with carbon.
+ –
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
1. . ........................................................................................................................................
2. . ........................................................................................................................................
[2]
diamond graphite
(i) Explain how the structure of diamond relates to its use in cutting hard materials.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Explain how the structure of graphite relates to its use as a lubricant.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
4 A teacher demonstrated the reactivity of calcium with water. He used the apparatus shown below.
gas syringe
water
calcium
(a) The teacher measured the volume of gas given off at various times during the reaction. He
then repeated the experiment using strontium but keeping all the conditions the same.
The graph obtained from the results is shown below.
60
strontium
50
40
calcium
volume of
30
gas / cm3
20
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
time / s
(i) Explain how the graph shows that strontium is more reactive than calcium.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) For the reaction between calcium and water, deduce the volume of gas produced in the
first 50 seconds.
(iii) At what time was the reaction between strontium and water complete?
................. s [1]
(iv) How do you know from the graph that the reaction between calcium and water was not
complete 100 seconds after the reaction started?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(v) Suggest how the rate of reaction changes when the same mass of calcium is used but in
smaller pieces.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) The solution formed at the end of the reaction between strontium and water is alkaline. It is a
solution of strontium hydroxide.
The teacher titrated this solution with hydrochloric acid using the apparatus shown below.
hydrochloric acid
burette
25 cm3 strontium
hydroxide solution
(i) What piece of apparatus should be used to put exactly 25.0 cm3 of the strontium hydroxide
solution into the flask?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Explain why litmus is added to the flask and describe what happens to the litmus as the
titration proceeds.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) The graph below shows how the pH of the solution in the flask changes as the acid is added.
12
10
pH
6
0
0 10 20 30 40 50
volume of hydrochloric acid / cm 3
(i) Describe how the pH of the solution changes as the titration proceeds.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) What volume of acid had been added when the solution had a neutral pH?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 13]
5 A student left a cube of ice on a plate in a warm room. The diagrams below show what happened
to the ice.
(a) Describe and explain what happened to the ice. In your answer,
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) The symbol equation for the reaction of lithium with water is shown below.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Describe two observations which can be made when lithium reacts with water.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) Describe how the reactivity of potassium with water compares with the reactivity of lithium
with water.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Draw the structure of ethene showing all atoms and all bonds.
[1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) The table below describes the reaction of water or steam with different metals.
metal observations
cerium reacts slowly with hot water and very rapidly with steam
iron reacts very slowly with hot water and readily with steam
[2]
[Total: 16]
H H C H H
C C C C
H H H
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
test . ............................................................................................................................................
(i) What feature of the isoprene molecule is responsible for it forming an addition polymer?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Explain why.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(e) State the names of two substances formed when isoprene undergoes incomplete combustion.
alcohols
alkanes
alkenes
carboxylic acids
[1]
[Total: 9]
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
(b) Sodium carbide, Na2C2, reacts with water to form ethyne, C2H2.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[1]
[Total: 9]
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/21/O/N/15
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/21 Paper 2 (Core Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
2(a) make sure temperature change is the same throughout / make sure that there are no hot spots / no local heating; 1
2(b) any two from: 2
• same amount of solid / same mass of solid;
• same volume of water;
• same amount of stirring;
2(c)(i) Q 1
2(c)(ii) R; T; 2
235
2(d)(i) U; 1
2(d)(ii) 138; 1
2(d)(iii) cancer treatment / tracer / test thyroid function; 1
2(e)(i) kerosene; 1
2(e)(ii) C5H10; 1
3(a) 2 (Ni); 1
CO2 (on right); 1
3(b)(i) positive electrode / anode in box on left; 1
negative electrode / cathode in upper box on right; 1
electrolyte / named suitable electrolyte in lower box on right;
3 correct = [2]
1 or 2 correct = [1]
3(b)(ii) cathode / negative electrode; 2
3(c)(i) the positive electrode: chlorine; 1
the negative electrode: nickel;
3(c)(ii) inert / unreactive; 1
conducts electricity; 1
3(d)(i) giant structure / lots of carbon atoms joined to each other / lattice of covalent bonds; 1
strong (covalent) bonds throughout; 1
3(d)(ii) weak forces between layers; 1
layers can slide (over each other); 1
4(a)(ii) 11 (cm3); 1
4(a)(iii) 64–66 (s); 1
4(a)(iv) the line was still going up / the line was still rising; 1
4(a)(v) (rate) increases; 1
4(b)(i) (volumetric) pipette; 1
4(b)(ii) to show end point of titration / to show when the solution has been neutralised; 1
litmus goes from blue to pink (at end point); 1
4(c)(i) decreases slowly at first; 1
then sudden decrease in pH; 1
then slow decrease; 1
4(c)(ii) 26 (cm3); 1
4(c)(iii) strontium chloride; 1
5(b)(i) coolant / for making ethanol / for making specified chemicals / solvent; 1
5(b)(ii) washing / cooking / cleaning etc.; 1
5(c)(i) lithium + water → lithium hydroxide + hydrogen; 1
5(c)(ii) any two from: 2
• floats on surface (of water);
• bubbles of gas;
• fizzes / fizzing sound;
• decreases in size / disappears;
• moves around;
5(c)(iii) (potassium) more reactive / lithium less reactive; 1
5(d)(i) correct structure of ethene; 1
5(d)(ii) high temperature; 1
catalyst / phosphoric acid; 1
5(e) cobalt → iron → cerium → calcium; 2
one pair reversed or all reversed = [1]
6(a) C5H8; 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 11_0620_31/3RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
Select from the list of particles to answer the following questions. A particle may be selected
once, more than once or not at all.
(i) Which two ions have the same electronic structure? . .................................................. [1]
(ii) Which ion has the same electronic structure as an atom of argon? . ............................ [1]
(iii) Which atom can form an ion of the type X3–? ................................................................ [1]
(iv) Which atom can form a hydride which has a formula of the type XH4? . ....................... [1]
(b) (i) How many protons, neutrons and electrons are there in one copper(II) ion 64
29 Cu 2+ ?
(ii) 45
21 Sc represents an atom of scandium.
How many nucleons and how many charged particles are there in one atom of scandium?
23 24
(c) Two different atoms of sodium are 11 Na and 11 Na .
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) 24
11 Na is radioactive. It changes into an atom of a different element which has one more
proton.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
2 Describe how to separate the following. In each example, give a description of the procedure used
and explain why this method works.
(a) Copper powder from a mixture containing copper and zinc powders.
procedure ...................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
procedure ...................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
(c) Glycine from a mixture of the two amino acids glycine and alanine. Glycine has the lower Rf
value.
procedure ...................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(d) Magnesium hydroxide from a mixture of magnesium hydroxide and zinc hydroxide.
procedure ...................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 11]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) The following equation represents the equilibrium in the Contact process.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(d) The forward reaction is exothermic. The reaction is usually carried out at a temperature between
400 and 450 °C.
(i) What is the effect on the position of equilibrium of using a temperature above 450 °C?
Explain your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) What is the effect on the rate of using a temperature below 400 °C?
Explain your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(e) A low pressure, 2 atmospheres, is used. At equilibrium, about 98% SO3 is present.
(i) What is the effect on the position of equilibrium of using a higher pressure?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(g) Describe how concentrated sulfuric acid is made from sulfur trioxide.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 15]
(i) Describe two problems caused by the disposal of synthetic polymers in landfill sites.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) The structural formulae of two synthetic polymers are given below.
CH2 CH CH2 CH
polymer A
CH3 CH3
O O O O
polymer B
C C O O C C O O
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Deduce the two types of organic compound which have reacted to form polymer B.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) Explain the difference between addition and condensation polymers. Classify A and B as
either addition or condensation polymers.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 12]
5 (a) A compound, X, contains 55.85% carbon, 6.97% hydrogen and 37.18% oxygen.
(i) How does this prove that compound X contains only carbon, hydrogen and oxygen?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Use the above percentages to calculate the empirical formula of compound X.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) (i) Bromine water changes from brown to colourless when added to X.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[1]
[Total: 8]
6 Carbon and silicon are elements in Group IV. They both form oxides of the type XO2.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) State three properties which silicon(IV) oxide and diamond have in common.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(iii) How could you show that silicon(IV) oxide is acidic and not basic or amphoteric?
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) Explain why the physical properties of carbon dioxide are different from those of diamond and
silicon(IV) oxide.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 9]
(a) The decomposition of silver bromide is the basis of film photography. This is a redox reaction.
step 2 Ag+ + e– → Ag
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) A piece of white paper was coated with silver bromide and exposed to the light. Sections of the
paper were covered as shown in the diagram.
not covered
covered with
thin paper
covered with
thick card
Predict the appearance of the different sections of the paper after exposure to the light and the
removal of the card. Explain your predictions.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
(c) Photosynthesis is another example of a photochemical reaction. Green plants can make simple
carbohydrates, such as glucose. These can polymerise to make more complex carbohydrates,
such as starch.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Name the substance which is responsible for the colour in green plants and is essential for
photosynthesis.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Draw part of the structural formula of starch which contains two glucose units.
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 12]
7 9 11 12 14 16 19 20
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Lithium Beryllium Boron Carbon Nitrogen Oxygen Fluorine Neon
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Sodium Magnesium Aluminium Silicon Phosphorus Sulfur Chlorine Argon
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Potassium Calcium Scandium Titanium Vanadium Chromium Manganese Iron Cobalt Nickel Copper Zinc Gallium Germanium Arsenic Selenium Bromine Krypton
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
12
85 88 89 91 93 96 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
0620/31/O/N/15
Rubidium Strontium Yttrium Zirconium Niobium Molybdenum Technetium Ruthenium Rhodium Palladium Silver Cadmium Indium Tin Antimony Tellurium Iodine Xenon
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
133 137 139 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
Caesium Barium Lanthanum Hafnium Tantalum Tungsten Rhenium Osmium Iridium Platinum Gold Mercury Thallium Lead Bismuth Polonium Astatine Radon
55 56 57 * 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
226 227
Fr Ra Ac
Francium Radium Actinium
87 88 89
140 141 144 150 152 157 159 162 165 167 169 173 175
*58-71 Lanthanoid series
Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
90-103 Actinoid series Cerium Praseodymium Neodymium Promethium Samarium Europium Gadolinium Terbium Dysprosium Holmium Erbium Thulium Ytterbium Lutetium
58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
a a = relative atomic mass 232 238
Key X X = atomic symbol Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
Thorium Protactinium Uranium Neptunium Plutonium Americium Curium Berkelium Californium Einsteinium Fermium Mendelevium Nobelium Lawrencium
b b = proton (atomic) number 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/31 Paper 3 (Extended Theory), maximum raw mark 80
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
4(c)(i) CH2=CHCH3 2
double bond is shown;
rest of structure correct;
4(c)(ii) ester; 1
4(c)(iii) (carboxylic) acid; 1
alcohol; 1
4(d) addition – polymer only product / only one product; 1
condensation – (polymer and) simple molecule / water / hydrogen chloride made; 1
polymer A is an addition polymer and polymer B is a condensation polymer; 1
explanation:
the more light, the more silver ions are reduced; 1
7(c)(i) carbon dioxide + water → glucose + oxygen
reactants correct; 1
products correct; 1
7(c)(ii) chlorophyll; 1
7(c)(iii)
1
one correct –O– link between rectangles;
1
two correct glucose units with continuation bonds;
7(c)(iv) the reaction of glucose with oxygen to release (carbon dioxide and water and) energy; 1
or
the reaction of glucose in a biological system to release energy;
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*0468745378*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary. Safety spectacles
may be provided if considered necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Please also see under ‘General Apparatus’ on the use of pipette fillers and safety goggles.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 11_0620_51CI/3RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
[F] (a) five strips of magnesium ribbon, each 4 cm long , labelled magnesium ribbon
(j) a stop clock or timer. Candidates may use their own watches
(l) a test-tube
(m) splint
For Question 2
[H] (a) a stoppered test-tube containing about 8 cm3 of aqueous iron(II) chloride, FeCl 2.4H2O,
of concentration 0.2 mol / dm3 labelled solution X. This solution should be prepared just
before the examination.
[N][H] (b) a stoppered test-tube containing about 6 cm3 of aqueous silver nitrate, AgNO3, of
concentration 0.1 mol / dm3, labelled solution Y
[N][H] (i) aqueous silver nitrate of suitable concentration to give a positive halide test
(o) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
NOVEMBER 2015
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
UCLES on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2015
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB15 11_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2015 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate the rate of reaction when magnesium ribbon reacts with four solutions
of dilute sulfuric acid, of different concentrations, labelled solutions A, B, C and D. The sulfuric acid
is in excess in all experiments.
Read all the instructions below carefully before starting the experiments.
Instructions
You are going to carry out five experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Using a measuring cylinder, pour 30 cm3 of dilute sulfuric acid A into the beaker.
Start the timer and add the 4 cm length of magnesium to the sulfuric acid in the beaker.
Stir the mixture constantly.
Measure the time taken for all of the magnesium to react and disappear.
Record the time in the table below.
Rinse out the beaker with distilled water.
(b) Experiment 2
Repeat Experiment 1, using the solution B of sulfuric acid. Record the time in the table.
(c) Experiment 3
Repeat Experiment 1, using the solution C of sulfuric acid. Record the time in the table.
(d) Experiment 4
Repeat Experiment 1, using the solution D of sulfuric acid. Record the time in the table.
1 A 1.0
2 B 0.8
3 C 0.6
4 D 0.5
[4]
(e) Experiment 5
Pour about 3 cm3 of the solution C of sulfuric acid into a test-tube and record its temperature.
Add a 4 cm length of magnesium.
Record all of your observations and test the gas given off with a splint.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(f) Plot the results for Experiments 1, 2, 3 and 4 on the grid and draw a smooth line graph.
180
160
140
120
100
time in
seconds
80
60
40
20
0
0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2
concentration of sulfuric acid in mol / dm3
[3]
(g) (i) From your graph, deduce the concentration of the sulfuric acid if the time for the reaction
was 80 s.
Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your answer.
(ii) From your graph, deduce how long the reaction would take if a solution of sulfuric acid of
concentration 1.2 mol / dm3 was used.
Show clearly on the graph how you worked out your answer.
.................................... s [2]
(h) Why was the same amount of magnesium used in Experiments 1, 2, 3 and 4?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) What type of chemical reaction occurs when magnesium reacts with sulfuric acid?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Suggest the effect on the temperature change if this experiment was repeated using 2 cm
of magnesium ribbon.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(j) Suggest a different method which could be used to investigate the rate of the reaction between
magnesium and sulfuric acid. State the difference in the apparatus used and measurements to
be taken.
apparatus ...................................................................................................................................
measurements ...........................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 20]
tests observations
tests on solution X
tests observations
tests on solution Y
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 20]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/51 Paper 5 (Practical), maximum raw mark 40
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
1(d) time boxes correctly completed, ascending in magnitude; 3 I: decimal places if given
in seconds; 1
1(e) any two from: 2
• effervescence / bubbles;
• lighted splint pops;
• temperature increased;
1(f) points correctly plotted: 2
4 correct = 2
3 correct = 1
2 or fewer correct = 0
measurements
volume of gas / temperature of reaction; 1
over time; 1
0620 CHEMISTRY
0620/61 Paper 6 (Alternative to Practical), maximum raw mark 60
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of
the examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not
indicate the details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began,
which would have considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner
Report for Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2015 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some
Cambridge O Level components.
3(a) electrolysis; 1
3(b) bulb lights / bubbles; 1
3(c) platinum; 1 R: copper
3(d) glowing splint; 1 R: relights a lighted splint
relights; 1 A: lighted splint glows brighter
3(e) hydrogen (ions) positive / opposites attract 1
3(f) chlorine produced; 1
poisonous / toxic; 1
4(d) all time readings correctly recorded: 48, 68, 96, 132 3
4 correct = 3
3 correct = 2
2 correct = 1
0 or 1 correct = 0
in seconds; 1
4(e) all points correctly plotted: 48, 68, 96, 132 2
4 correct = 2
3 correct = 1
2 or fewer correct = 0
measurements
volume of gas / temperature of reaction; 1
over time; 1
6 7 from: 7
• weighed amount / x g of toothpaste;
• add water;
• stir / heat;
• filter (to obtain calcium carbonate);
• wash;
• dry;
• weigh residue;
• calculate percentage calcium carbonate;
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2016
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*6275559010*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 20.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 11_0620_11/6RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
1 ‘Particles moving very slowly from an area of higher concentration to an area of lower
concentration.’
2 A student mixes 25 cm3 samples of dilute hydrochloric acid with different volumes of aqueous
sodium hydroxide.
In each case, the student measures the change in temperature to test if the reaction is
exothermic.
A B C D
3 Information about the solubility of four solids, P, Q, R and S, is given in the table.
P Q R S
A student attempted to separate mixtures of these solids using the following method.
A a mixture of P and R
B a mixture of Q and P
C a mixture of Q and R
D a mixture of R and S
chlorine 17 35 17 W 17
chlorine 17 X 17 19 17
argon Y 40 18 22 18
potassium 19 39 19 20 Z
W X Y Z
A 18 35 18 19
B 18 36 18 19
C 19 35 19 18
D 19 36 19 18
5 The diagrams show the structures of two forms of the same element.
T U
What are the reasons for using T in cutting tools and U as a lubricant?
T U
A It is very hard because each atom is The layers can slide over each other
held in place by strong covalent bonds. because the covalent bonds are weak.
B It is very hard because each atom is The layers can slide over each other
held in place by strong covalent bonds. due to weak forces between the layers.
C It is very hard because there are The layers can slide over each other
no electrons able to move. because the covalent bonds are weak.
D It is very hard because there are The layers can slide over each other
no electrons able to move. due to weak forces between the layers.
7 A molecule of X contains two carbon atoms, four hydrogen atoms and two oxygen atoms.
anode cathode
A B key
+ – + – = copper sheet
= iron nail
C D
+ – + –
10 When anhydrous copper(II) sulfate is added to water a solution is formed and heat is given out.
thermometer
anhydrous
copper(II) sulfate
water
Which row shows the temperature change and the type of reaction taking place?
A decrease endothermic
B decrease exothermic
C increase endothermic
D increase exothermic
What is X?
A ethanol
B hydrogen
C methane
D uranium
12 The rate of reaction between magnesium and excess dilute hydrochloric acid was followed by
measuring the mass of magnesium present at regular time intervals.
Both experiments used 0.1 g of magnesium ribbon. The acid in experiment 1 was less
concentrated than in experiment 2.
A B
mass of mass of
magnesium magnesium
1 2
2 1
0 0
0 time 0 time
C D
2 1
mass of 1 mass of 2
magnesium magnesium
0 0
0 time 0 time
A It is burnt.
B It is electrolysed.
C It is oxidised.
D It is reduced.
A B
C
D
substance
test
P Q R S
gas given off gas given off
dilute hydrochloric
which ‘pops’ with which turns no reaction no reaction
acid added
a lighted splint limewater milky
P Q R S
A key
B = gas is produced
C = no gas is produced
D
filter paper
stirrer
excess of solid X
solid X
Y aqueous
copper(II) sulfate
heat
X Y
A Elements in the same period have the same number of electron shells.
B The elements change from metals to non-metals from left to right.
C The number of protons in an atom of an element increases from left to right.
D The oxides of the elements change from acidic to basic from left to right.
A orange 113
B orange 1535
C white 113
D white 1535
23 Which row describes the trends in the properties of the Group VII elements as the group is
descended?
reactivity with
colour density
halide ions
magnesium
zinc
iron
copper
Titanium reacts with acid and cannot be extracted from its ore by heating with carbon.
A below copper
B between iron and copper
C between magnesium and zinc
D between zinc and iron
oxygen
26 A student added dilute hydrochloric acid to four metals and recorded the results.
results
metal gas given off
1 copper yes
2 iron yes
3 magnesium no
4 zinc yes
Which metals would be suitable for use in electrical wiring and aircraft manufacture?
A P Q
B Q P
C Q R
D R P
A The distilled sample boils at exactly 100 °C and contains dissolved salts.
B The distilled sample boils at 103 °C and does not contain dissolved salts.
D The filtered sample boils at exactly 100 °C and does not contain dissolved salts.
A argon
B carbon dioxide
C nitrogen
D oxygen
damp, red
litmus paper
X and Y
gentle heat
X Y
X
limewater
X Y
yes no
yes no yes no
A B C D
catalyst
butane butene + hydrogen
and heat
A combustion
B cracking
C polymerisation
D reduction
A B C D
H H H H O H H H H
H C C C H H C C H C C OH C C
H H H H OH H H H H
A It burns readily in a plentiful supply of air to form only carbon dioxide and water.
B It decolourises aqueous bromine.
A B C D
A B C D
H H H H H H O
H C H H C C H C C H C C
H H H H H H O H
A
B
C
D
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2016
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
20
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/11/O/N/16
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.)
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice October/November 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2016 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 C
2 B 22 B
3 C 23 B
4 B 24 C
5 B 25 D
6 D 26 D
7 C 27 B
8 B 28 C
9 A 29 C
10 D 30 B
11 B 31 D
12 A 32 D
13 B 33 B
14 D 34 C
15 C 35 B
16 A 36 C
17 C 37 B
18 C 38 C
19 D 39 C
20 C 40 B
© UCLES 2016
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2016
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*6942475041*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 20.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 11_0620_21/6RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
1 ‘Particles moving very slowly from an area of higher concentration to an area of lower
concentration.’
2 A student mixes 25 cm3 samples of dilute hydrochloric acid with different volumes of aqueous
sodium hydroxide.
In each case, the student measures the change in temperature to test if the reaction is
exothermic.
A B C D
3 Information about the solubility of four solids, P, Q, R and S, is given in the table.
P Q R S
A student attempted to separate mixtures of these solids using the following method.
A a mixture of P and R
B a mixture of Q and P
C a mixture of Q and R
D a mixture of R and S
chlorine 17 35 17 W 17
chlorine 17 X 17 19 17
argon Y 40 18 22 18
potassium 19 39 19 20 Z
W X Y Z
A 18 35 18 19
B 18 36 18 19
C 19 35 19 18
D 19 36 19 18
H O
H C C
H O H
Which diagram shows the arrangement of outer shell electrons in a molecule of ethanoic acid?
A B
H H
O O
H C C H C C
O H O H
H H
C D
H H
O O
H C C H C C
O H O H
H H
A B C D
– –
+ – +
+ + +
– – + –
– – + –
+ +
– – – + – +
– –
+ – +
+ + +
– + –
A 1 mole of benzene and 1 mole of ethene contain the same number of atoms.
B 1 mole of benzene and 1 mole of ethene both have a volume of 24 dm3 at room temperature
and pressure.
C Both benzene and ethene have the same empirical formula.
D The number of carbon atoms in 0.5 moles of ethene is equal to the Avogadro constant.
What is the maximum mass of sodium carbonate that can be made from 0.100 moles of
sodium hydrogencarbonate?
A B key
+ – + – = copper sheet
= iron nail
C D
+ – + –
voltmeter
V
metal X metal Y
electrolyte
X Y
A magnesium copper
B magnesium iron
C zinc copper
D zinc iron
12 When anhydrous copper(II) sulfate is added to water a solution is formed and heat is given out.
thermometer
anhydrous
copper(II) sulfate
water
Which row shows the temperature change and the type of reaction taking place?
A decrease endothermic
B decrease exothermic
C increase endothermic
D increase exothermic
Ea products
energy
ΔH
reactants
A It could be the energy level diagram for the reaction when petrol is burnt.
B Less energy is released in bond forming than is needed for bond breaking.
C The activation energy, Ea, has a positive value.
14 The rate of reaction between magnesium and excess dilute hydrochloric acid was followed by
measuring the mass of magnesium present at regular time intervals.
Both experiments used 0.1 g of magnesium ribbon. The acid in experiment 1 was less
concentrated than in experiment 2.
A B
mass of mass of
magnesium magnesium
1 2
2 1
0 0
0 time 0 time
C D
2 1
mass of 1 mass of 2
magnesium magnesium
0 0
0 time 0 time
15 Which statement explains why coal dust forms an explosive mixture with air?
16 The following reversible reaction takes place in a closed vessel at constant temperature.
A P, Q, R and S
B P and Q only
C P, Q and R only
D S only
3 Fe2+(aq) → Fe3+(aq) + e–
A acidic
B amphoteric
C basic
D neutral
19 Hydrogen chloride gas reacts with water to produce an acidic solution. The equation for the
reaction is shown.
filter paper
stirrer
excess of solid X
solid X
Y aqueous
copper(II) sulfate
heat
X Y
Which equation shows a reaction which cannot be used to make a silver salt?
substance
test
P Q R S
gas given off gas given off
dilute hydrochloric
which ‘pops’ with which turns no reaction no reaction
acid added
a lighted splint limewater milky
P Q R S
oxygen
26 The ionic equations represent the reactions between four metals, P, Q, R and S, and solutions of
the salts of the same metals.
P + Q2+ → no reaction
R + P2+ → R2+ + P
Q + S2+ → Q2+ + S
S + P2+ → S2+ + P
S + R2+ → S2+ + R
S + Q2+ → no reaction
most least
A P R S Q
B Q R S P
C Q S R P
D S Q P R
From which ore is aluminium extracted and at which electrode is aluminium deposited during
electrolysis?
ore electrode
A bauxite negative
B bauxite positive
C cryolite negative
D cryolite positive
A 2ZnO + C → 2Zn + CO
C ZnO + C → Zn + CO
D ZnO + 2C → Zn + 2CO2
A argon
B carbon dioxide
C nitrogen
D oxygen
31 Underwater steel pipes can be protected from corrosion by attaching magnesium blocks to them.
A Fe → Fe2+ + 2e–
B Fe2+ → Fe3+ + e–
C Mg → Mg2+ + 2e–
D Mg2+ + 2e– → Mg
What are the reactants and the catalyst for this reaction?
reactants catalyst
yes no
yes no yes no
A B C D
catalyst
butane butene + hydrogen
and heat
A combustion
B cracking
C polymerisation
D reduction
What is substance Z?
A ethane
B ethanoic acid
C ethanol
D ethyl ethanoate
Which row shows an advantage and a disadvantage of using the catalytic addition of steam to
ethene compared to fermentation?
advantage disadvantage
CH3 H CH3 H
C C C C
H CH3 H CH3
A CH2=CH2
B CH3CH=CH2
C CH3CH=CHCH3
D CH3CH2CH=CH2
O O O
C O O C C O
O O
A HO C C OH + HO OH
O O
B HO C OH + HO C OH
O O
C HO OH + HO C C OH
O O O O
D HO C C OH + HO C C OH
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2016
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
20
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/21/O/N/16
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.)
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice October/November 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2016 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 D
2 B 22 C
3 C 23 A
4 B 24 B
5 B 25 D
6 C 26 C
7 A 27 A
8 D 28 C
9 B 29 C
10 A 30 B
11 A 31 C
12 D 32 C
13 A 33 B
14 A 34 B
15 B 35 C
16 C 36 B
17 C 37 C
18 B 38 B
19 C 39 C
20 C 40 A
© UCLES 2016
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*3756670404*
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 11_0620_31/3RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
H
Li B C N O F Ne
Na Al Si P S Cl Ar
K Ca Cu Zn Br Kr
Answer the following questions using only the elements in the diagram.
Each element may be used once, more than once or not at all.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) is formed at the cathode when a dilute solution of sulfuric acid is electrolysed,
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) has an oxide of the type XO2 which is used to bleach wood pulp,
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) forms ions which when tested with excess aqueous sodium hydroxide produce a white
precipitate,
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
204
(ii) How many neutrons are there in one atom of the isotope 80 Hg ?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
204
(iii) How many protons are there in one atom of the isotope 80 Hg ?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 10]
2 The bar charts compare the concentrations of the main ions in two samples of seawater, sample A
and sample B.
sample A sample B
20 20
15 15
concentration
concentration
in mg / dm3
in mg / dm3
10 10
5 5
0 0
Na+ Ca2+ K+ Mg2+ SiO32– Cl – HCO3– Na+ Ca2+ K+ Mg2+ SiO32– Cl – HCO3–
(a) Use the information in the bar charts to answer the following questions.
(i) Describe two differences in the composition of the seawater in sample A and sample B.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
test . ............................................................................................................................................
result . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) River water contains small particles of clay. When these particles are viewed under a microscope
they show a random, jumpy motion even when the water is still.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Carbon dioxide dissolves in water to form a mixture which contains hydrogencarbonate ions
and hydrogen ions.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Describe how you would use Universal Indicator paper to determine the pH of this solution.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) State the name of one other greenhouse gas and give one source of this gas.
gas . .....................................................................................................................................
source . ................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 14]
[2]
• anode,
• cathode,
• electrolyte.
calcium
forming
+
[2]
(c) Calcium reacts with water to form calcium hydroxide and a gas which ‘pops’ with a lighted
splint.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [4]
[Total: 10]
4 A porous pot has tiny holes in its walls which allow gases to move in or out of the pot.
A teacher filled a porous pot with green chlorine gas. The teacher then placed the pot in a large jar
of air. After 10 minutes, a green colour was seen outside the porous pot.
air
porous
chlorine pot
gas
(a) Use the kinetic particle model of matter to explain this observation.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
(b) A porous barrier can be used to separate uranium fluoride molecules containing different
isotopes of uranium.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Chlorine reacts with potassium bromide to form bromine and potassium chloride.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) A teacher heated a test-tube containing anhydrous copper(II) chloride. A piece of damp
litmus paper was placed at the top of the test-tube.
litmus paper
heat
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 12]
(a) Use the information in the table to answer the following questions.
(i) What is the relationship between the percentage of carbon in the steel and its strength?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) State whether there is a relationship between the percentage of carbon in the steel and its
melting point range.
Explain your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Which steel would be best to use for making a bicycle chain?
Explain your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Cr Fe Fe Fe Ni Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Ni Ni Ni Ni Ni
Fe Fe Cr Fe Ni Ni Ni Ni Fe Fe Fe Fe Ni Ni Ni Ni
Fe Fe Fe Fe Ni Cr Cr Cr Cr Cr Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Ni Ni Ni Ni Ni
Fe Ni Fe Cr Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Fe Ni Ni Ni Ni
A B C D
[1]
(c) High voltage electricity cables are made from aluminium with a steel core.
(i) Apart from conducting electricity, what is the purpose of the steel core?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Give one other use of aluminium and state a property of aluminium which makes it suitable
for this use.
use . .....................................................................................................................................
property ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
(d) Aluminium powder reacts with powdered iron(III) oxide. The equation for this reaction is shown.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
2Al + Fe2O3
energy
Al 2O3 + 2Fe
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 10]
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
(b) The table shows some properties of the first five members of the carboxylic acid homologous
series.
(i) How does the density of the carboxylic acids vary with the number of carbon atoms in the
molecule?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iv) Draw the structure of the functional group present in carboxylic acids.
Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
[2]
(c) Identify the following as either physical changes or chemical changes by writing either ‘physical’
or ‘chemical’ in the spaces provided.
The condensation of ethanoic acid vapour to liquid ethanoic acid is a ......................... change.
[Total: 14]
A .................................................................................................................................................
B .................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(b) Describe the arrangement and motion of the particles in sulfur vapour.
arrangement ...............................................................................................................................
motion . .......................................................................................................................................
[2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
Explain why the presence of sulfur in coal has an adverse effect on human health when the
coal is burnt.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
H H
C C
C C
H H
S
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Thiophene can be made in the laboratory by heating ethyne, C2H2, with hydrogen sulfide,
H2S, in the presence of a catalyst.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) When 2.6 g of ethyne react with excess hydrogen sulfide, 4.2 g of thiophene are formed.
Calculate the mass of thiophene formed when 15.6 g of ethyne react with excess hydrogen
sulfide.
[1]
[Total: 10]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2016
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/O/N/16
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Core Theory October/November 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2016 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) H / hydrogen 1
1(a)(ii) H / hydrogen 1
1(a)(iii) S / sulfur 1
1(a)(iv) Ca / calcium 1
1(a)(v) Al / aluminium 1
1(b)(i) atoms 1
with the same number of protons but different number of neutrons 1
OR
atoms 1
of the same element with different number of neutrons 1
1(b)(ii) 124 1
1(b)(iii) 80 1
1(b)(iv) 78 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 3 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 31
2(a)(ii) Mg2+ 1
2(a)(iii) 2 mg = [2] 2
200
× (10) = [1]
1000
OR
0.2 × (10) = [1]
© UCLES 2016
Page 4 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 31
3(b) 2
cathode
electrolyte
anode
3(d) 4
manufacture (max = [2])
• limestone / calcium carbonate heated
• thermal decomposition
• heated in kiln / heated in current of air / coke for heating / carbon for heating
© UCLES 2016
Page 5 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 31
4(b)(ii) any suitable use, e.g. treatment of cancer / tracer / thyroid function / sterilising (medical) instruments / 1
4(c)(ii) any suitable use, e.g. sterilising / killing bacteria / swimming pools / bleach / 1
4(c)(iii) acidic because chlorine is a non-metal / acidic because chlorine is on the right of the Periodic Table 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 6 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 31
5(a)(ii) 1
(no) the melting point range does not increase regularly / the melting point range goes up and down / the melting
point range remains fairly constant
OR
(yes) the more carbon, the greater the melting point range / the difference between the higher and lower number is
greater with more carbon
OR
(yes) the average melting point range is higher the more carbon (except for D) / the general trend is for a higher
melting point range with more carbon
5(b) A 1
5(c)(i) gives strength / so the wire does not break / so the wire does not sag / for support 1
5(c)(ii) use: any suitable use, e.g. food container / saucepan / aircraft body / 1
property: any suitable property related to the use, e.g.(food container) resistant to acidic foods / (saucepan) good 1
conductor of heat / (aircraft body) low density /
5(d)(i) Al / aluminium 1
it gains oxygen 1
5(d)(ii) exothermic because the reactants have more energy than the products / exothermic because the products have 1
less energy than the reactants
© UCLES 2016
Page 7 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 31
6(a) 4
effect on indicator (max = [1])
• turn (blue) litmus red
• turn methyl orange red / pink
6(b)(iii) solid 1
its melting point is above 15 °C / 15 °C is below its melting point 1
6(b)(iv) displayed structure of COOH group showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds 1
6(b)(v) 88 2
4 × C OR 8 × H OR 2 × O OR C = 48 OR O = 32 scores [1]
© UCLES 2016
Page 8 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 31
7(c) any suitable use, e.g. tyre manufacture / making sulfur dioxide / making sulfuric acid / pesticide / insecticide / 1
7(e)(i) C4H4S 1
© UCLES 2016
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*6396621448*
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 11_0620_41/3RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
electrical electrical
melting point boiling point solubility
substance conductivity conductivity
/ °C / °C in water
when molten when solid
F –97 65 very soluble does not conduct does not conduct
G 1600 2230 insoluble does not conduct does not conduct
H 801 1413 soluble conducts does not conduct
I –57 126 insoluble does not conduct does not conduct
J 1085 2562 insoluble conducts conducts
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) Name a method you could use to separate a mixture of substance J and water.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Name a method you could use to obtain substance F from a mixture of substance F and water.
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) Describe how you could obtain a solid sample of substance H from a mixture of substance H
and substance G.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 10]
2 Matter can exist as solid, liquid or gas. The arrows show some changes of state.
solid
A B
liquid gas
(b) Explain why energy has to be supplied to turn a liquid into a gas.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(c) The diagrams represent the same number of particles of a gas in two containers, D and E,
which have different volumes. The two containers are at the same temperature.
D E
In which container will the pressure be higher? Explain your answer.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 5]
X
O
petroleum
(i) What happens to the petroleum at point X, before it enters the fractionating column?
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) Most of the hydrocarbons obtained from petroleum are alkanes. The alkanes are an
homologous series of saturated hydrocarbons with the general formula CnH2n+2.
Give two characteristics, other than having the same general formula, of members of an
homologous series.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) The alkane with the molecular formula C5H12 can exist as a number of structural isomers.
[2]
H H
H C C H
H H
When a mixture of ethane and chlorine is exposed to ultraviolet light a substitution reaction
takes place.
Draw the structure of one organic product from this substitution reaction.
[1]
(i) Explain how the name of isoprene suggests that it contains a C=C double bond.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) A sample of isoprene had the following composition by mass: C, 88.24%; H, 11.76%.
(iii) What additional information would be required to calculate the molecular formula of
isoprene?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 13]
4 (a) Ammonia, NH3, is made by reacting nitrogen with hydrogen in the Haber process.
(i) Write a chemical equation for the formation of ammonia in the Haber process.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Name the raw materials from which nitrogen and hydrogen are obtained.
nitrogen . ..............................................................................................................................
hydrogen . ............................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) State the temperature and pressure used in the Haber process. Include the units.
temperature .........................................................................................................................
pressure . .............................................................................................................................
[2]
The graph shows how the yield of ammonia at equilibrium changes with temperature and
pressure.
yield of
ammonia 300 °C
100 °C
pressure
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Using information from the graph, explain whether the reaction is endothermic or
exothermic.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) State and explain the effect of increasing the pressure on the yield of ammonia in this
reaction.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 12]
copper wire
Identify this gas and give the test for this gas.
gas . ............................................................................................................................................
test . ............................................................................................................................................
(b) During electrolysis, electricity passes through the copper(II) sulfate solution.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
(c) The electrolysis was repeated using copper electrodes in place of carbon electrodes. The ionic
half-equations for the reactions at the two electrodes are shown.
(i) Which species is reduced during the electrolysis? Explain your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) The masses of the copper electrodes changed during the electrolysis.
State how and explain why the masses of the two copper electrodes changed.
Use the ionic half-equations to help you.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(iii) Explain why, during the electrolysis, the colour of the copper(II) sulfate solution does not
change.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 12]
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
O O
C C N N
H H
O O
H O O H H O C C O H
[3]
[Total: 9]
7 Calcium chloride can be made by reacting calcium carbonate with hydrochloric acid.
An excess of calcium carbonate was added to 50.0 cm3 of 0.500 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid. The
solution was filtered to remove the excess calcium carbonate.
(b) Deduce the number of moles of carbon dioxide gas made in this reaction.
........................................ g [2]
(d) Calculate the volume, in dm3, of carbon dioxide made in this reaction at room temperature and
pressure (r.t.p.).
[Total: 6]
An excess of magnesium carbonate pieces was added to dilute hydrochloric acid. The apparatus in
the diagram was used to measure the volume of gas produced. The total volume of gas collected
was recorded every 20 seconds.
bung
inverted
measuring cylinder
conical flask
dilute
hydrochloric water
magnesium carbonate
pieces acid trough
120
100
80
total volume of
gas collected 60
/ cm3
40
20
0
0 100 200 300 400 500
time / s
(i) Describe how the rate of this reaction changed during the reaction. Explain why the rate
changed in this way.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [4]
(ii) The experiment was repeated using the same mass of powdered magnesium carbonate
with the same volume and concentration of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Explain how the initial rate of reaction and total volume of gas collected would compare to
the first experiment.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
[4]
(b) A piece of magnesium ribbon was cleaned. The experiment was repeated using this clean
magnesium ribbon instead of magnesium carbonate.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
[Total: 13]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2016
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/O/N/16
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Extended Theory October/November 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2016 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a) H 1
1(b) G 1
1(c) filtration 1
1(d) fractional 1
distillation 1
1(f) electrons 1
(electrons) move / flow (throughout structure) 1
2(a)(i) melt(ing) 1
2(c) E AND particles hit the walls (of the container) more often 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 3 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 41
3(d) correct structure with any number from 1 to 6 of the hydrogen atoms replaced by chlorine atoms 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 4 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 41
© UCLES 2016
Page 5 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 41
© UCLES 2016
Page 6 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 41
7(a) 0.025
M1 50 / 1000 (=0.05) 1
M2 (0.05 × 0.5) = 0.025 1
7(b) 0.0125 1
7(c) 0.55
M1 44 1
M2 0.55 1
7(d) 0.3 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 7 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 41
© UCLES 2016
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*3546960466*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Safety glasses should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
F = flammable O = oxidising
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by email: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
IB16 11_0620_51CI/3RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
[C] (d) 100 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide of concentration 1.0 mol / dm3, labelled solution N
[C] (f) 100 cm3 of aqueous nitric acid of concentration 2.0 mol / dm3, labelled nitric acid
For Question 2
(a) one stoppered tube containing 0.5 g of aluminium sulfate, Al 2(SO4)3.18H2O, labelled
solid P
(g) aqueous barium nitrate of concentration suitable to give a positive sulfate test
[MH][N] (k) aqueous silver nitrate of concentration suitable to give a positive halide test
(l) spatulas
(q) splints
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in preparing materials for the Practical Test;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
CIE on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 11_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate what happens when nitric acid reacts with aqueous solutions of two
different alkalis, solution N and solution O.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Use a measuring cylinder to pour 50 cm3 of solution N into the polystyrene cup provided. Put
the polystyrene cup into a 250 cm3 beaker for support. Measure the initial temperature of the
solution and record it in the first row of the table.
Fill the burette with nitric acid to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
Add 5.0 cm3 of nitric acid to solution N in the polystyrene cup and stir the solution.
Measure and record the maximum temperature of the solution in the table.
Add a further 5.0 cm3 of nitric acid to the polystyrene cup and stir the solution. Measure and
record the maximum temperature of the solution in the table.
Continue to add 5.0 cm3 portions of nitric acid to the polystyrene cup, until a total volume of
40 cm3 of nitric acid has been added. Stir after each addition and measure and record the
maximum temperatures in the table.
0.0
5.0
10.0
15.0
20.0
25.0
30.0
35.0
40.0
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
0.0
5.0
10.0
15.0
20.0
25.0
30.0
35.0
40.0
[2]
(c) Plot the results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid and draw two smooth line graphs.
Clearly label your graphs.
40
30
maximum
temperature
of solution
/ °C
20
10
0 10 20 30 40
(d) Use your graph to estimate the maximum temperature of the solution when 13 cm3 of nitric acid
were added to 50 cm3 of solution N in Experiment 1.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
In which experiment is the temperature change greater? Suggest why the temperature change
is greater in this experiment.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(g) How would the results differ in Experiment 1 if 100 cm3 of solution N were used?
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(h) Suggest why a polystyrene cup is used in these experiments and not a copper can.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) State one source of error in the experiments. Suggest an improvement to reduce this source
of error.
improvement . .............................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 17]
tests on solid P
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) test 1
Heat the first portion of solid P in a hard-glass test-tube.
Test any gases given off with cobalt(II) chloride paper.
Record your observations.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) test 2
Carry out a flame test on the second portion of solid P.
Record your observations.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
tests on a solution of P
Add about 10 cm3 of distilled water to the third portion of solid P in a test-tube. Stopper the test-tube
and shake it to dissolve solid P.
(c) Divide the solution into four equal portions in four test-tubes. Carry out the following tests.
(i) To the first portion of the solution, add several drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Then add excess aqueous sodium hydroxide to the mixture.
Record your observations.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) To the second portion of the solution, add excess aqueous ammonia.
Record your observations.
. ...........................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) To the third portion of the solution, add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of
aqueous silver nitrate.
Record your observations.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iv) To the fourth portion of the solution, add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of
aqueous barium nitrate.
Record your observations.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
Suggest what the appearance of solid P in (a) tells you about the identity of the metal ion.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 17]
3 Agri Limes are mixtures of calcium carbonate and calcium oxide. Farmers use Agri Limes on fields
to neutralise acidity.
Plan an investigation to find out which of two different Agri Limes, Q or R, will neutralise more acid.
You are provided with common laboratory apparatus and chemicals, including dilute nitric acid.
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt. or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp, red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2016 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(f) Experiment 1 1
solution N is a stronger acid / has a higher pH 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 3 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 51
2(c)(i) white 1
precipitate 1
dissolves / clears 1
2(c)(iv) white 1
precipitate 1
2(f) it is not any named metal that gives a positive flame test 1
2(g) aluminium 1
sulfate 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 4 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 51
3 6
method adding Agri Lime to acid
add weighed amount / known mass of Agri Lime Q
to a known volume of acid
with a named indicator added to the acid
until the indicator changes colour
note the mass of Agri Lime Q added
repeat with Agri Lime R
conclusion, e.g. ‘the experiment using the smaller amount of Agri Lime is better’
OR
method adding acid to Agri Lime
use weighed amount / known mass of Agri Lime Q
add acid to it gradually / from a burette
with a named indicator added to the acid
until the indicator changes colour
note volume of acid added
repeat with Agri Lime R
conclusion, e.g. ‘the experiment using the larger volume of acid is better’
© UCLES 2016
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*0345891151*
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 11_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
1 The diagram shows the apparatus used to electrolyse dilute sulfuric acid.
oxygen hydrogen
dilute
platinum ............................
sulfuric acid
+ –
(a) Complete the box to show the role of the platinum. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
test . ............................................................................................................................................
[Total: 7]
2 A student investigated what happened when dilute nitric acid reacted with aqueous solutions of two
different alkalis, solution N and solution O.
(a) Experiment 1
A measuring cylinder was used to pour 50 cm3 of solution N into a polystyrene cup. The initial
temperature of the solution was measured.
A burette was filled with nitric acid to the 0.0 cm3 mark.
5.0 cm3 of nitric acid were added to solution N in the polystyrene cup and the solution stirred.
The maximum temperature of the solution was measured.
A further 5.0 cm3 of nitric acid were added to the polystyrene cup and the solution stirred. The
maximum temperature of the solution was measured.
The student continued to add 5.0 cm3 portions of nitric acid to the polystyrene cup, until a total
volume of 40 cm3 of nitric acid had been added. After each addition, the solution was stirred
and the maximum temperature measured.
Use the thermometer diagrams to record the maximum temperatures in the table.
30 30 35 35 35 40 35 35 35
thermometer
25 25 30 30 30 35 30 30 30
diagram
20 20 25 25 25 30 25 25 25
maximum temperature
of the solution in the
polystyrene cup / °C
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30
thermometer
25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25
diagram
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
maximum temperature
of the solution in the
polystyrene cup / °C
[2]
(c) Plot the results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid and draw two smooth line graphs.
Clearly label your graphs.
35
30
maximum
temperature
of solution
/ °C 25
20
15
0 10 20 30 40
(d) Use your graph to estimate the maximum temperature of the solution when 13 cm3 of nitric acid
were added to 50 cm3 of solution N in Experiment 1.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
In which experiment is the temperature change greater? Suggest why the temperature change
is greater in this experiment.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(g) How would the results differ in Experiment 1 if 100 cm3 of solution N were used?
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(h) Suggest why a polystyrene cup was used in these experiments and not a copper can.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) State one source of error in the experiments. Suggest an improvement to reduce this source
of error.
improvement . .............................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 17]
tests on solid P
(a) test 1
Solid P was divided into three portions. The first portion of solid P was heated.
Any gases given off were tested with cobalt(II) chloride paper.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) test 2
tests on a solution of P
Distilled water was added to the rest of solid P in a test-tube and shaken to dissolve.
(c) The solution was divided into four equal portions in four test-tubes. The following tests were
carried out.
(i) test 3
Several drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the first portion of the solution.
observations ........................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) test 4
Several drops of aqueous ammonia were added to the second portion of the solution.
observations ........................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
Two further tests were carried out and the following observations made.
test 5
Dilute nitric acid and aqueous silver nitrate were no visible reaction
added to the third portion of the solution.
test 6
Dilute nitric acid and aqueous barium nitrate white precipitate formed
were added to the fourth portion of the solution.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 10]
4 Agri Limes are mixtures of calcium carbonate and calcium oxide. Farmers use Agri Limes on fields
to neutralise acidity.
Plan an investigation to find out which of two different Agri Limes, Q or R, will neutralise more acid.
You are provided with common laboratory apparatus and chemicals, including dilute nitric acid.
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2016 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a) electrodes 1
1(c)(ii) water 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 3 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 61
© UCLES 2016
Page 4 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 61
3(c)(i) white 1
precipitate 1
dissolves 1
© UCLES 2016
Page 5 Mark Scheme Syllabus Paper
Cambridge IGCSE – October/November 2016 0620 61
4 6
method adding Agri Lime to acid
add weighed amount / known mass of Agri Lime Q
to a known volume of acid
with a named indicator added to the acid
until the indicator changes colour
note the mass of Agri Lime Q added
repeat with Agri Lime R
conclusion, e.g. ‘the experiment using the smaller amount of Agri Lime is better’
OR
method adding acid to Agri Lime
use weighed amount / known mass of Agri Lime Q
add acid to it gradually / from a burette
with a named indicator added to the acid
until the indicator changes colour
note volume of acid added
repeat with Agri Lime R
conclusion, e.g. ‘the experiment using the larger volume of acid is better’
© UCLES 2016
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2016
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*0022143872*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 06_0620_11/4RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
W X
gas liquid solid
Y Z
A line is drawn across a piece of chromatography paper and a spot of the dye is placed on it.
chromatography
paper
what is used to
position of spot
draw the line
A a burette
B a conical flask
C a measuring cylinder
D a pipette
W 2,8,1
X 2,8,4
Y 2,8,7
Z 2,8,8
A 13 B 14 C 27 D 40
7 What happens when a bond is formed between a green gaseous element and a soft metallic
element?
8 The equation shows the reaction between magnesium and sulfuric acid.
[Ar: H, 1; O, 16; Mg, 24; S, 32]
Mg + H2SO4 → MgSO4 + H2
In this reaction, which mass of magnesium sulfate is formed when 6 g of magnesium react with
excess sulfuric acid?
A 8 B 24 C 30 D 60
plastic coating
metal core
P Q
substance X
– +
What is substance X?
11 The energy level diagram for the reaction between sodium hydrogen carbonate and dilute
hydrochloric acid is shown.
energy
sodium hydrogen carbonate +
dilute hydrochloric acid
Which row correctly describes the type of reaction and the energy of the reactants and products?
used as
compound A an energy
source
C
B D
radioactive
Which two diagrams show suitable methods for investigating the rate (speed) of the reaction?
1 2
cotton wool cotton wool
X X
Y Y
balance
3 4
stopper stopper
X X
Y Y
balance
14 An experiment, S, is carried out to measure the volume of hydrogen produced when excess dilute
sulfuric acid is added to zinc.
A second experiment, T, is carried out using the same mass of zinc but under different
conditions.
total volume S
of hydrogen
T
0
0 time
A
B
C
D
A Aluminium is oxidised.
B Aluminium oxide is reduced.
A Cu + ZnSO4 → CuSO4 + Zn
C CuO + H2 → Cu + H2O
1 2
A
B
C
D
A B C
D
step 3 step 4
A to ensure all of the acid has reacted to obtain solid copper(II) sulfate
B to ensure all of the acid has reacted to remove excess copper(II) oxide
C to speed up the reaction to obtain solid copper(II) sulfate
D to speed up the reaction to remove excess copper(II) oxide
test observation
What is X?
A copper(II) chloride
B copper(II) iodide
C iron(II) chloride
D iron(II) iodide
21 Where in the Periodic Table is the metallic character of the elements greatest?
A left bottom
B left top
C right bottom
D right top
Two of these elements are in Group I of the Periodic Table and two are in Group VII.
physical state at
element reaction with water
room temperature
A P is below R in Group I.
B Q is above R in Group I.
C Q is below S in Group VII.
D R is below S in Group VII.
Which is correct?
25 Three students, X, Y and Z, were told that solid P reacts with dilute acids and also conducts
electricity.
X Y Z
26 W, X and Y are metals, one of which is copper and one of which is iron.
Which metal is the most reactive and what is the possible identity of W?
A X Cu
B X Fe
C Y Cu
D Y Fe
27 Tin is a metal that is less reactive than iron and is extracted from its ore cassiterite, SnO2.
A Aluminium is used in the manufacture of aircraft because of its strength and high density.
B Copper is used in electrical wiring because of its strength and high density.
C Mild steel is used in the manufacture of car bodies because of its strength and resistance to
corrosion.
D Stainless steel is used in the construction of chemical plant because of its strength and
resistance to corrosion.
29 The diagram shows an experiment to investigate how paint affects the rusting of iron.
P Q
iron painted iron
air
water
tube P tube Q
A falls rises
B no change rises
C rises falls
D rises no change
30 A new planet has been discovered and its atmosphere has been analysed.
atmosphere
planet
carbon dioxide 4
nitrogen 72
oxygen 24
Which gases are present in the atmosphere of the planet in a higher percentage than they are in
the Earth’s atmosphere?
31 Water was added to separate samples of anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride and anhydrous
copper(II) sulfate.
Which row describes the colour changes that take place in these reactions?
A carbon monoxide
B lead compounds
C oxides of nitrogen
D sulfur dioxide
33 A farmer’s soil is very low in both nitrogen (N) and phosphorus (P).
Which fertiliser would improve the quality of this soil most effectively?
percentage
nitrogen (N) phosphorus (P) potassium (K)
A 11 11 27
B 12 37 10
C 28 10 10
D 31 29 9
34 When limestone is heated it forms lime (calcium oxide) and carbon dioxide.
gasoline
petroleum Z
bitumen
X Y Z
1 CH3OH
2 CH3CH2OH
3 CH3COOH
4 CH3CH2CH2OH
H H H H H H H H
H H H H H H H H
H O
H C C
H OH
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2016
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/11/M/J/16
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.)
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2016 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 D 21 A
2 C 22 C
3 C 23 C
4 B 24 C
5 C 25 C
6 B 26 D
7 A 27 C
8 C 28 D
9 B 29 D
10 C 30 A
11 A 31 B
12 D 32 B
13 D 33 D
14 C 34 C
15 A 35 D
16 D 36 B
17 D 37 D
18 C 38 C
19 B 39 B
20 D 40 A
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2016
45 Minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*6622954837*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 20.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 06_0620_21/4RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
1 The rate of diffusion of two gases, methane, CH4, and ethene, C2H4, is measured using the
apparatus shown.
constant
pressure
applied metal foil – gas
gas syringe gas escapes through
small hole in the foil
gas that
reason
diffuses faster
A ethene Ethene molecules are heavier and so move faster.
D methane Methane molecules are smaller so they can get out of the
small hole more easily.
A line is drawn across a piece of chromatography paper and a spot of the dye is placed on it.
chromatography
paper
what is used to
position of spot
draw the line
3 The paper chromatogram below was obtained from four different dyes.
solvent front
baseline
A B C D
1 They are atoms which have the same chemical properties because they have the
same number of electrons in their outer shell.
2 They are atoms which have the same number of electrons and neutrons but
different numbers of protons.
3 They are atoms which have the same number of electrons and protons but different
numbers of neutrons.
W 2,8,1
X 2,8,4
Y 2,8,7
Z 2,8,8
6 Which statement describes the attractive forces between molecules (intermolecular forces)?
+ –
+ –
+ –
– –
+ + –
+
– – –
+ + +
What is Z?
A aluminium
B iodine
C silicon dioxide
D sulfur
8 A compound, X, contains 40.0% carbon, 6.7% hydrogen and 53.3% oxygen by mass.
9 25 cm3 of 0.1 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid exactly neutralise 20 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
used as
compound A an energy
source
C
B D
radioactive
voltmeter
electrolyte
Which statement about the process occurring when the cell is in operation is correct?
2H2 + O2 → 2H2O
H–H 436
O=O 498
O–H 464
A –3226 kJ / mol
B –884 kJ / mol
C –486 kJ / mol
D –442 kJ / mol
Which two diagrams show suitable methods for investigating the rate (speed) of the reaction?
1 2
cotton wool cotton wool
X X
Y Y
balance
3 4
stopper stopper
X X
Y Y
balance
15 Which statements explain why increasing temperature increases the rate of a chemical reaction?
1 Heat makes the molecules move faster and collide more often.
2 Heat makes the molecules collide with more energy so they are more likely to react.
3 Increasing temperature lowers the activation energy for the reaction.
Which conditions of temperature and pressure would give the largest yield of hydrogen?
temperature pressure
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
A Fe2+ + e– → Fe3+
B Fe2+ → Fe3+ + e–
C Fe3+ + e– → Fe2+
D Fe3+ → Fe2+ + e–
1 2
A
B
C
D
19 Which row describes whether an amphoteric oxide reacts with acids and bases?
A no no
B no yes
C yes no
D yes yes
20 Which substance reacts with dilute sulfuric acid to form a salt that can be removed from the
resulting mixture by filtration?
D copper(II) carbonate
21 Where in the Periodic Table is the metallic character of the elements greatest?
A left bottom
B left top
C right bottom
D right top
Two of these elements are in Group I of the Periodic Table and two are in Group VII.
physical state at
element reaction with water
room temperature
A P is below R in Group I.
B Q is above R in Group I.
C Q is below S in Group VII.
D R is below S in Group VII.
Which is correct?
25 A student investigated the reactions of four metals, R, S, T and U, with solutions of their salts.
R S nitrate reacts
R T nitrate reacts
S U nitrate no reaction
T U nitrate reacts
U R nitrate no reaction
A R→S→U→T
B R→T→U→S
C S → U → T→ R
D U→R→T→S
26 Three students, X, Y and Z, were told that solid P reacts with dilute acids and also conducts
electricity.
X Y Z
A Aluminium is used in the manufacture of aircraft because of its strength and high density.
B Copper is used in electrical wiring because of its strength and high density.
C Mild steel is used in the manufacture of car bodies because of its strength and resistance to
corrosion.
D Stainless steel is used in the construction of chemical plant because of its strength and
resistance to corrosion.
anode
cathode
+ +
aluminium oxide
in molten cryolite
molten aluminium
A Aluminium ions gain electrons during the electrolysis and are reduced.
B Cryolite is added to reduce the melting point of the aluminium oxide.
C The anode and cathode are made of graphite.
D The cathode has to be replaced regularly because it is burnt away.
29 The diagram shows an experiment to investigate how paint affects the rusting of iron.
P Q
iron painted iron
air
water
tube P tube Q
A falls rises
B no change rises
C rises falls
D rises no change
30 A new planet has been discovered and its atmosphere has been analysed.
atmosphere
planet
carbon dioxide 4
nitrogen 72
oxygen 24
Which gases are present in the atmosphere of the planet in a higher percentage than they are in
the Earth’s atmosphere?
increase in increase in
pressure temperature
A
B
C
D
Which effects do increasing the temperature and using a catalyst have on the rate of formation of
sulfur trioxide, SO3?
34 A farmer’s soil is very low in both nitrogen (N) and phosphorus (P).
Which fertiliser would improve the quality of this soil most effectively?
percentage
nitrogen (N) phosphorus (P) potassium (K)
A 11 11 27
B 12 37 10
C 28 10 10
D 31 29 9
gasoline
petroleum Z
bitumen
X Y Z
1 CH3OH
2 CH3CH2OH
3 CH3COOH
4 CH3CH2CH2OH
37 Which compounds contain the same number of carbon, hydrogen and oxygen atoms?
W X Y Z
Cl F
H C C H
A B
Cl Cl Cl Cl Cl F Cl F
C C C C C C C C
Cl Cl Cl Cl H H H H
C D
Cl F Cl F F F F F
C C C C C C C C
Cl F Cl F Cl Cl Cl Cl
A O O O O
H O H O
B N C N C N C
H O
O O O O
C C C O O C C O O
O O O O O
D C C N N C C N N C
H H H H
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2016
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
20
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/21/M/J/16
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.)
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2016 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 A
2 C 22 C
3 D 23 C
4 B 24 C
5 C 25 B
6 C 26 C
7 A 27 D
8 D 28 D
9 C 29 D
10 A 30 A
11 D 31 A
12 C 32 B
13 C 33 D
14 D 34 D
15 A 35 D
16 B 36 B
17 C 37 A
18 D 38 D
19 D 39 B
20 A 40 C
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
*3293960889*
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
06_0620_31_2016_1.11
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
A B C
Cl
Cl Cl Cl − K+ Cl − K+
C
Cl Cl K+ Cl − K+ Cl −
Cl
Cl − K+ Cl − K+
D E
Cl H F
Cl Cl Cl
Cl C C C F Al Al
H H F Cl Cl Cl
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................
................................................................................................................................ [2]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
Cl Cl
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Determine the number of neutrons present in one atom of the isotope Cl .
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Draw the electronic structure of a chlorine atom. Show all shells and all electrons.
[2]
[Total: 9]
(a) Which material is the most suitable for making the bicycle frame?
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... [3]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Suggest why aluminium is extracted by electrolysis and not by reduction with carbon.
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) The diagram shows the changes of state when zinc vapour is cooled slowly to room temperature.
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... [4]
[Total: 11]
sodium 98 883
caesium 29 669
(a) (i) Describe the trend in boiling points of the Group I metals.
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................
................................................................................................................................ [2]
(b) Complete the word equation for the reaction of rubidium with water.
H C O– Na+
C C C
C C C
H C N H
H H
Complete the table and calculate the relative molecular mass of compound F.
carbon 8 12 8 12 96
hydrogen
nitrogen 1 14 1 14 14
oxygen 1 16 1 16 16
sodium
(d) Three dye mixtures, J, K and L, were spotted onto a piece of chromatography paper. Three
pure dyes, X, Y and Z, were also spotted onto the same piece of paper.
J K L X Y Z
(i) Suggest why the base line was drawn in pencil and not in ink.
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Which dye mixture, J, K or L, contains a dye which did not move during this
chromatography?
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 12]
P Q R
H H
H H H H H H H
H C
C C H H C C C H H C C C
C C H H H H H H
H C
H
H H
S T U
H H H H H H H H H
H C C C O H H C C H H C C C C O H
H H H H H H H H H
................................................................................................................................
................................................................................................................................ [2]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) Methanol and ethanol are alcohols in the same homologous series.
Complete the following sentence about a homologous series using words from the list.
(i) Draw the structure of ethene showing all atoms and all bonds.
[1]
(ii) Describe how aqueous bromine is used to show that ethene is an unsaturated
compound.
................................................................................................................................
................................................................................................................................ [2]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iv) Complete the chemical equation for the cracking of hexadecane, C16H34 , to form propene
and one other hydrocarbon.
[Total: 11]
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... [5]
(i) Explain why this reaction could have an adverse effect on health if not carried out in a
fume cupboard.
................................................................................................................................
................................................................................................................................ [2]
A pH 1 B pH 7 C pH 9 D pH 13
[1]
[Total: 10]
6 Ammonia is manufactured by the reaction of nitrogen with hydrogen in the presence of a catalyst.
........................................................................................................................................... [1]
Complete the equation below by adding the sign for a reversible reaction.
N2 + 3H2 2NH3
[1]
N2 + 3H2
energy
2NH3
...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The graph shows how the percentage yield of ammonia changes with temperature when the
pressure is kept constant.
100
80
60
% yield
of ammonia
40
20
0
0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700
temperature / °C
(i) Describe how the percentage yield of ammonia changes with temperature.
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
test.....................................................................................................................................
result.................................................................................................................................. [2]
Describe how you would measure the pH of an aqueous solution of a weak base using Universal
Indicator.
...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) Complete the chemical equation for the reaction of ammonia with chlorine.
[Total: 11]
A student investigated this reaction by measuring the volume of carbon dioxide released every
minute at constant temperature.
(a) Draw a diagram of the apparatus that the student could use to investigate this reaction.
[2]
(b) The graph shows the results of this reaction using three samples of calcium carbonate of the
same mass: large pieces, medium-sized pieces and small pieces.
50
40
small
medium
30
volume of
carbon dioxide
/ cm3 large
20
10
0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350
time / s
(i) Which sample, large, medium or small pieces, gave the fastest initial rate of reaction?
................................................................................................................................
................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) The experiment was repeated using powdered calcium carbonate of the same mass.
Draw a line on the grid above to show how the volume of carbon dioxide changes with
time for this experiment. [2]
(iii) At what time was the reaction just complete when small pieces of calcium carbonate
were used?
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................ [1]
................................................................................................................................
................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 10]
...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... [2]
dry
hydrogen gas
copper(II) oxide
ice bath
water
The hydrogen was passed over the hot copper(II) oxide until the reaction was complete.
(i) As the experiment proceeds, suggest what happens to the mass of copper(II) oxide.
................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Suggest why electrical heating is used in this experiment and not a Bunsen burner.
................................................................................................................................ [1]
test..........................................................................................................................
result....................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
© UCLES 2016
Group
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
06_0620_31_2016_1.11
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.)
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2016 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) B / chlorine / Cl 2; 1
1(a)(ii) C / KCl / potassium chloride; 1
1(a)(iii) 2
B; 1
has only one type of atom; 1
1(a)(iv) C3H3F3Cl2 ; 1
1(b)(i) different number of neutrons / different mass numbers / different numbers of nucleons; 1
1(b)(ii) 18; 1
1(b)(iii) 2
7 electrons in the outer shell; 1
first shell has 2 electrons and second shell has 8 electrons; 1
2(a) 3
stainless steel;
any 2 from:
(very) strong;
(good) resistance to corrosion;
cheap;
OR
iron;
strong;
cheap;
OR
aluminium;
low density;
(good) resistance to corrosion;
OR
titanium;
any 2 from:
strong;
(good) resistance to corrosion;
low density;
OR
zinc;
(good) resistance to corrosion;
2(b)(i) bauxite; 1
2(b)(ii) aluminium is too reactive / aluminium is high in the electrochemical series / aluminium is very reactive; 1
2(b)(iii) 2
anode: oxygen / O2; 1
cathode: aluminium / Al; 1
2(c) any 4 from: 4
4(a)(i) 2
S and U; 1
both have OH (group); 1
4(a)(ii) Q and T; 1
4(b) 3
compounds; 1
chemical; 1
functional; 1
4(c)(i) 1
;
4(c)(ii) 2
aqueous bromine is added to (test tube of) ethene / aqueous bromine is orange; 1
aqueous bromine turns colourless / solution turns colourless; 1
4(c)(iii) high temperature / heat; 1
4(c)(iv) C13H28; 1
5(a) 5
any 3 physical properties: 3
• melting point increases down the Group;
• boiling point increases down the Group;
• density increases down the Group;
• colour gets darker down the Group / states goes from gas to liquid to solid down the Group;
reactivity: 2
• more reactive halogen displaces less reactive halogen (from halide);
• correct word equation, e.g. chlorine + potassium bromide → potassium chloride + bromine;
5(b)(i) 2
nitrogen dioxide (formed) / NO2 (formed) / nitrogen oxide (formed) / gas (formed); 1
damages lungs / irritates eyes / sore throat / skin burns / difficulty swallowing / persistent coughing / headache 1
/ vomiting;
5(b)(ii) pH 1; 1
5(b)(iii) 2
zinc nitrate; 1
water; 1
7(a) 2
(gas) syringe leading to flask / beaker / test tube OR flask and tube leading to upturned measuring cylinder over 1
trough of water;
closed apparatus with no air gaps; 1
7(b)(i) 2
small pieces; 1
line / curve / graph steepest; 1
7(b)(ii) 2
line to the left of the small pieces starting at (0, 0); 1
finishing at 45 cm3 and before the other lines; 1
7(b)(iii) any value between 205 s and 215 s (inclusive); 1
7(c)(i) neutralising (acidic) soils / neutralising (acidic) waste / steelmaking / self-heating cans / making concrete / 1
making glass / water treatment / making plaster / making paper / flue-gas desulfurisation / neutralising acids / making
limewater;
7(c)(ii) 2
basic oxide; 1
because it is a metal oxide / because it would react with acid / neutralizes acids / calcium is on the left of the Periodic 1
Table;
8(a) 2
copper(II) oxide; 1
loses oxygen; 1
8(b)(i) (mass of copper oxide in tube) decreases; 1
8(b)(ii) hydrogen is flammable / hydrogen is explosive; 1
8(b)(iii) 2
anhydrous copper(II) sulfate goes blue / white copper(II) sulfate goes blue 2
(1 mark for anhydrous copper (II) sulfate / white copper(II) sulfate)
OR
anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride goes pink / blue cobalt(II) chloride goes pink 2
(1 mark for anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride / blue cobalt(II) chloride)
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 06_0620_41/4RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
(a) Complete the table to show the relative mass and relative charge of a proton, a neutron and an
electron.
proton
neutron
1
electron
1840
[3]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Explain why the two isotopes of bromine have the same chemical properties.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) The table shows the number of protons, neutrons and electrons in some atoms and ions.
19 22 18
[5]
[Total: 12]
2 Period 3 contains the elements sodium to argon. This question asks about the chemistry of each of
the Period 3 elements or their compounds.
(a) Sodium nitrate is a white crystalline solid. When heated it melts and the following reaction
occurs.
Calculate the
.................................. mol
.................................. mol
.................................. dm3
[3]
(b) Magnesium reacts slowly with warm water to form a base, magnesium hydroxide.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Write a chemical equation for the reaction between magnesium and warm water.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Calcium phosphate is used in fertilisers. The bonding in calcium phosphate is ionic.
Calcium phosphate contains the phosphate ion, PO43–.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Sulfur tetrafluoride, SF4, can be made by combining gaseous sulfur with fluorine.
(i) Complete the energy level diagram for this reaction. Include an arrow which clearly shows
the energy change during the reaction.
S(g) + 2F2(g)
energy
[3]
(ii) During the reaction the amount of energy given out is 780 kJ / mol.
Use this information to determine the bond energy, in kJ / mol, of one S–F bond in SF4.
S + F F → F S F
F F
F
(g) Chlorine and compounds of chlorine are important in water treatment and in laboratory testing
for water.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) A compound of chlorine is used in the laboratory to test for the presence of water.
Name the compound of chlorine used in this test and describe the colour change seen in
a positive result of this test.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 27]
3 When aqueous sodium thiosulfate and dilute hydrochloric acid are mixed, a precipitate of insoluble
sulfur is produced. This makes the mixture difficult to see through.
The time taken for the cross to disappear from view is measured.
A student adds the following volumes of aqueous sodium thiosulfate, dilute hydrochloric acid and
distilled water to the conical flask.
The time taken for the formation of the precipitate of sulfur to make the cross disappear from view
is recorded.
1 10 10 40 56
2 20 10 30 28
(a) State the order in which the aqueous sodium thiosulfate, hydrochloric acid and distilled water
should be added to the flask.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) In experiment 3 the student wanted the sodium thiosulfate to be double the concentration used
in experiment 2.
(i) Complete the table to show the volumes which should be used and the expected time
taken for the cross to disappear from view in experiment 3. [2]
(ii) Use collision theory to explain why increasing the concentration of sodium thiosulfate
would change the rate of reaction.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
Use collision theory to explain why the rate of reaction would increase.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 8]
+ –
copper (anode)
(i) The chemical process taking place on the surface of the object is
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Explain why the concentration of copper ions in the electrolyte remains constant throughout
step 1.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) Give two changes which would be needed in order to coat nickel onto the object in step 2.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
Give three different properties of transition metals which are not typical of other metals.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 8]
5 Sulfuric acid is produced by the Contact process. The steps of the Contact process are shown.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) Describe step 2, giving reaction conditions and a chemical equation. Reference to reaction
rate and yield is not required.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
(c) Step 3 involves adding sulfur trioxide to concentrated sulfuric acid to form oleum.
A student adds excess dilute sulfuric acid to a sample of solid copper(II) carbonate in a
test-tube.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Concentrated sulfuric acid has different properties to dilute sulfuric acid.
When concentrated sulfuric acid is added to glucose, C6H12O6, steam is given off and a black
solid is formed.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 12]
(a) Name two industrial processes which must take place to produce alkenes from petroleum.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(b) Ethene, CH2=CH2, and propene, CH2=CHCH3, can both be converted into polymers.
(i) What type of polymerisation takes place when ethene forms a polymer?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) What is the empirical formula of the polymer formed from ethene?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[2]
Propene will react with steam to form two isomers, both of which are alcohols.
[2]
(d) Esters are organic chemicals noted for their characteristic smells. Ethanoic acid and methanol
will react to form an ester.
(i) Name the catalyst needed to form an ester from ethanoic acid and methanol.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Name the ester formed when ethanoic acid reacts with methanol.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Draw the structure of the ester formed when ethanoic acid reacts with methanol. Show all
bonds.
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 13]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2016
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/M/J/16
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.)
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2016 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level components.
1(a) 3
particle relative mass relative charge
proton 1 +1
neutron 1 nil
electron 1 / 1840 –1
1(b)(i) 2
M1 atom(s) of the same element; 1
M2 with different number of neutrons; 1
1(b)(ii) 2
M1 (both have) the same number of electrons; 1
M2 in the outer shell; 1
1(c) 5
number of number of number of
particle
protons neutrons electrons
7
3Li 3 4 3
34 2–
16S 16 18 18
41 +
19K 19 22 18
2(a) 3
number of moles of NaNO3 used: 3.40 / 85 = 0.04(00) (mol)
OR
4.(00) × 10–2 (mol);
2(f)(i) 3
1
M1 exothermic mark: horizontal product energy line at lower energy than that of reactant energy line; 1
M2 label of product mark: SF4; 1
M3 correct direction of vertical heat of reaction arrow: arrow must start level with reactant energy and finish level
with product energy and must have only one (correct) arrow-head;
2(f)(ii) 3
M1 bond energy of 2F2: 2 × F–F = 2 × 160 = 320 (kJ / mol); 1
M2 bond energy of all bonds in SF4: 780 + 320 = 1100 (kJ / mol); 1
M3 calculated bond energy of SF4 divided by 4: 1100 / 4 = 275 (kJ / mol); 1
2(g)(i) kills bacteria; 1
2(g)(ii) 3
name of compound: cobalt(II) chloride; 1
from: blue; 1
to: pink; 1
2(h)(i) it has a complete outer shell / a full outer shell / 8 electrons in the outer shell; 1
2(h)(ii) (in) lamps; 1
4(a)(i) reduction and (the Cu2+ ion / copper ions) is gaining electrons / is decreasing in oxidation number; 1
4(a)(ii) 2
formation of Cu2+ / copper ions at the anode happens at the same rate as; 1
removal of Cu2+ / copper ions at the cathode ora; 1
4(b) 2
replace (anode of) copper with nickel; 1
replace electrolyte with nickel(II) sulfate / NiSO4; 1
4(c) 3
(good) catalysts; 1
variable oxidation numbers; 1
form coloured compounds / coloured ions; 1
6(a) 2
fractional distillation; 1
cracking; 1
6(b)(i) addition; 1
6(b)(ii) CH2; 1
6(b)(iii) 2
; ;
M1 ester link;
M2 rest of molecule;
6(d)(iv) terylene; 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*9033818783*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the question paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The standard Report Form to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and
enclose it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of
the Supervisor’s Results and of the Report Form are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Safety glasses should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
F = flammable O = oxidising
If you have any queries regarding these Instructions, please contact CIE
by e-mail: [email protected],
by phone: +44 1223 553554,
by fax: +44 1223 553558,
stating the Centre number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 06_0620_51CI/3RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
For Question 1
For Question 2
[N][MH] (f) aqueous silver nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive halide test
(j) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record
the results on a spare copy of the question paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’.
Failure to enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably
penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported direct to
CIE on the normal Application for Special Consideration form.
SIGNED .......................................................
Supervisor
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
NAME .....................................................................................................................................................
(in block capitals)
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 06_0620_51/7RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between aqueous sodium carbonate and two different
solutions of dilute hydrochloric acid labelled A and B.
Instructions
You are going to carry out three experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
Use a measuring cylinder to pour 25 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate into a conical flask.
Add ten drops of thymolphthalein indicator to the conical flask.
Fill the burette provided up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with solution A of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Add solution A from the burette while swirling the flask, until the solution just changes colour.
Record the burette readings in the table below.
Experiment 2
Experiment 1 Experiment 2
final burette reading / cm3
initial burette reading / cm3
difference / cm3
[4]
(b) Experiment 3
Experiment 3
final burette reading / cm3
initial burette reading / cm3
difference / cm3
[2]
(d) State one observation, other than colour change, when hydrochloric acid was added to sodium
carbonate.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
Experiment ........... needed the largest volume of hydrochloric acid to change the colour of the
indicator. [1]
(f) What would be a more accurate method of measuring the volume of the aqueous
sodium carbonate?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(g) What would be the effect on the results, if any, if the solutions of sodium carbonate were
warmed before adding the hydrochloric acid? Give a reason for your answer.
reason ........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(h) (i) Determine the ratio of volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in Experiments 1 and 3.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Use your answer to (h)(i) to deduce how the concentration of solution A differs from that
of solution B.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Suggest a different method, using standard laboratory chemicals, to determine which of the
solutions of dilute hydrochloric acid, A or B, is more concentrated.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 18]
2 You are provided with two substances. Solid C is a salt and solution D is an aqueous solution of a
different salt.
Carry out the following tests on each substance, recording all of your observations at each stage.
tests on solid C
Add about half of solid C to about 10 cm3 of distilled water in a test-tube and shake to dissolve.
Divide the solution into two equal portions in two test-tubes, and carry out the following tests.
pH .................................................................................................................................. [1]
(ii) To the second portion of the solution, add about 1 cm3 of dilute nitric acid followed by
aqueous silver nitrate.
Record your observations.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
tests on solution D
Divide the solution D into three equal portions in three test-tubes and carry out the following tests.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) To the first portion of the solution, add drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide until a change
is seen.
Now add an excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the mixture.
Record your observations.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(iii) To the second portion of the solution, add drops of aqueous ammonia until a change is
seen.
Now add an excess of aqueous ammonia to the mixture.
Record your observations.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iv) To the third portion of the solution, add about 1 cm3 of dilute nitric acid followed by aqueous
silver nitrate.
Record your observations.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 16]
3 Calcium burns in air to form calcium oxide. The reaction is vigorous and some of the calcium oxide
can be lost as smoke.
Plan an investigation to determine the maximum mass of oxygen that combines to form calcium
oxide when 2 g of calcium granules are burnt in air.
You are provided with common laboratory apparatus and calcium granules.
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt. or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp, red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2016 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
• weigh calcium;
• heat / burn;
• with lid / cover;
• allow air to enter / lift lid;
• cool;
• reweigh calcium oxide;
• reheat to constant mass;
• calculate / find the difference;
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB16 06_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2016 [Turn over
2
1 The diagram shows the apparatus used to separate a mixture of water, boiling point 100 °C, and
ethanol, boiling point 78 °C.
condenser
water and
ethanol mixture
heat heat
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(e) Why would it be better to use an electrical heater instead of a Bunsen burner to heat the water
and ethanol mixture?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 7]
2 A student investigated the reaction between aqueous sodium carbonate and two different solutions
of dilute hydrochloric acid, A and B.
The reaction is:
(a) Experiment 1
Using a measuring cylinder, 25 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate were poured into a conical
flask.
Thymolphthalein indicator was added to the conical flask.
A burette was filled up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with solution A of dilute hydrochloric acid. A was
added to the flask, until the solution just changed colour.
Use the burette diagram to record the reading in the table.
12
13
14
final reading
Experiment 2
12 38
13 39
14 40
experiment 1 experiment 2
difference / cm3
[4]
(c) Experiment 3
Use the burette diagrams to record the readings in the table and complete the table.
8 15
9 16
10 17
experiment 3
difference / cm3
[2]
(d) Suggest one observation, other than colour change, that is made when hydrochloric acid is
added to sodium carbonate.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
Experiment .......... needed the largest volume of hydrochloric acid to change the colour of the
indicator. [1]
(f) What would be a more accurate method of measuring the volume of the aqueous
sodium carbonate?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(g) What would be the effect on the results, if any, if the solutions of sodium carbonate were
warmed before adding the hydrochloric acid? Give a reason for your answer.
reason ........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(h) (i) Determine the ratio of volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in experiments 1 and 3.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Use your answer to (h)(i) to deduce how the concentration of solution A differs from that
of solution B.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Suggest a different method, using standard laboratory chemicals, to determine which of the
solutions of dilute hydrochloric acid, A or B, is more concentrated.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 17]
3 Two substances, C and D, were analysed. Solid C was a salt and solution D was an aqueous
solution of chromium(III) chloride.
The tests on solid C, and some of the observations, are in the following table.
tests observations
tests on solid C
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) test 1
observations ........................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) test 2
(iii) test 3
Dilute nitric acid was added to solution D followed by aqueous silver nitrate.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 10]
4 Calcium burns in air to form calcium oxide. The reaction is vigorous and some of the calcium oxide
can be lost as smoke.
Plan an investigation to determine the maximum mass of oxygen that combines to form calcium
oxide when 2 g of calcium granules are burnt in air.
You are provided with common laboratory apparatus and calcium granules.
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2016
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2016 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a) 2
fractionating column; 1
tripod; 1
1(b) water labelled twice; 1
1(c) heat under (the collecting) beaker; 1
1(d) 2
M1 ethanol; 1
M2 lowest / lower boiling point; 1
1(e) ethanol is flammable; 1
2(a) 4
final readings completed correctly: 13.2, 39.2; 1
initial readings completed correctly: 0.0, 12.8; 1
differences completed correctly: 13.2, 26.4; 1
all readings and differences to 1 decimal place; 1
2(b) yellow to orange / red / pink; 1
2(c) 2
initial and final readings completed correctly: 9.9, 16.5; 1
difference completed correctly: 6.6; 1
2(d) bubbles / fizzing / effervescence; 1
2(e) Experiment 2; 1
2(f) use a pipette / burette; 1
2(g) 2
effect on results: none owtte; 1
reason: no change in concentration owtte; 1
2(h)(i) 2:1; 1
2(h)(ii) acid B is double the concentration of acid A ora / acid B is more concentrated ora; 1
2(i) any suitable correct and different method 3
M1 method; 1
M2 reagents; 1
M3 result; 1
3(a) 2
sodium; 1
bromide; 1
3(b) green; 1
3(c)(i) 3
green; 1
precipitate; 1
with excess, green solution / clear / dissolves; 1
3(c)(ii) 2
grey-green; 1
precipitate; 1
3(c)(iii) white precipitate; 1
3(d) fume cupboard / protective clothing, e.g. gloves or goggles; 1
4 any 6 from: 6
weigh calcium;
with lid / cover;
heat / burn;
allow air to enter / lift lid;
cool;
reweigh CaO;
reheat to constant mass;
calculate / find the difference;
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*2950887077*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 06_0620_11/FP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
P Q
R S
P Q R S
31
30
3 Pure water has a boiling point of 100 °C and a freezing point of 0 °C.
What is the boiling point and freezing point of a sample of aqueous sodium chloride?
A 98 –2
B 98 2
C 102 –2
D 102 2
4 Pure copper(II) sulfate crystals can be made by adding copper(II) oxide to hot dilute sulfuric acid.
The solution is ......2...... and then ......3...... to obtain the pure crystals.
1 2 3
A electron
B neutron
C nucleus
D proton
Which statements describe what happens to the sodium atoms in this reaction?
A chlorine
B hydrogen
C oxygen
D sodium
Which fuel is a gas at room temperature and makes two products when it burns in a plentiful
supply of air?
Further heating causes the sulfur to undergo a ......2...... change and form sulfur dioxide.
1 2
A chemical chemical
B chemical physical
C physical chemical
D physical physical
14 Which row correctly matches the experiment and observations to the identity of the underlined
substance?
15 A student was investigating the reaction between marble chips and dilute hydrochloric acid.
gas syringe
bung
marble
chips 25 cm3 of dilute
hydrochloric acid
N2 + O2 o 2NO
2NO + O2 o 2NO2
NO + O3 o NO2 + O2
Which row shows what happens to the reactant molecules in each of these reactions?
N2 NO O3
17 Hydrochloric acid is added to magnesium metal and to sodium carbonate in separate tests.
A effervescence effervescence
B effervescence no reaction
C no reaction effervescence
D no reaction no reaction
A carbon dioxide
B nitrogen dioxide
C sodium oxide
D sulfur dioxide
20 Substance X reacts with warm dilute hydrochloric acid to produce a gas which decolourises
acidified aqueous potassium manganate(VII).
What is X?
A potassium chloride
B potassium sulfite
C sodium chloride
D sodium sulfite
Which element is a soft solid that reacts violently with cold water?
A
B
C
D
22 Which element is less reactive than the other members of its group in the Periodic Table?
A astatine
B caesium
C fluorine
D rubidium
A Group I
B Group VII
C Group VIII
D transition elements
24 Why are weather balloons sometimes filled with helium rather than hydrogen?
25 Element E:
• forms an alloy
What is E?
A carbon
B copper
C sulfur
D zinc
S no yes
T yes no
U yes yes
least most
reactive reactive
A S T U
B S U T
C T S U
D U T S
27 Which statement about the extraction of iron in a blast furnace is not correct?
28 Stainless steel is an alloy of iron and other metals. It is strong and does not rust but it costs much
more than normal steel.
A cutlery
B pipes in a chemical factory
C railway lines
D saucepans
1 2 3
For which uses is it important for the water to have been treated?
A carbon monoxide
B chlorine
C hydrogen
D nitrogen
1 2
H H H H H H
H C O H H C C O H H C C C O H
H H H H H H
fraction use
The products of cracking include ......1...... and an ......2...... of ......3...... relative molecular mass
than the ......4...... that was cracked.
1 2 3 4
A ethane
B ethanoic acid
C ethanol
D ethene
H H H H H H H H H
C C C C C C C C C
H H H H H H H H H
Which diagram shows the monomer from which this polymer could be manufactured?
A B C D
H H H H H H H
H C H H C C H C C H C C O H
H H H H H H H
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/11/M/J/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2017 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 B 1
2 B 1
3 C 1
4 B 1
5 B 1
6 C 1
7 B 1
8 C 1
9 A 1
10 A 1
11 B 1
12 C 1
13 C 1
14 D 1
15 A 1
16 B 1
17 A 1
18 C 1
19 C 1
20 D 1
21 D 1
22 A 1
23 D 1
24 D 1
25 B 1
26 B 1
27 B 1
28 C 1
29 A 1
30 A 1
31 C 1
32 C 1
33 D 1
34 D 1
35 C 1
36 B 1
37 D 1
38 A 1
39 D 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*8889844006*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 O6_0620_21_VI_LIL/FP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 Small crystals of purple KMnO4 (Mr = 158) and orange K2Cr2O7 (Mr = 294) were placed at the
centres of separate petri dishes filled with agar jelly. They were left to stand under the same
physical conditions.
After some time, the colour of each substance had spread out as shown.
dish 1 dish 2
KMnO4 K2Cr2O7
The lengths of the arrows indicate the relative distances travelled by particles of each substance.
2 Pure water has a boiling point of 100 °C and a freezing point of 0 °C.
What is the boiling point and freezing point of a sample of aqueous sodium chloride?
A 98 –2
B 98 2
C 102 –2
D 102 2
solvent front
10.5 cm
5.8 cm 6.3 cm
5.5 cm 5.2 cm
baseline
A B C D
Which statements describe what happens to the sodium atoms in this reaction?
A Metals are malleable because the metal ions can slide over one another.
B Metals conduct electricity because electrons can move through the lattice.
C Metals consist of a giant lattice of metal ions in a ‘sea of electrons’.
D Metals have high melting points because of the strong attraction between the metal ions.
x y z
A 1 2 1
B 2 3 2
C 3 2 3
D 4 3 4
A 22 g B 28 g C 44 g D 88 g
A Electrons move through the electrolyte from the cathode to the anode.
B Electrons move towards the cathode in the external circuit.
C Negative ions move towards the anode in the external circuit.
D Positive ions move through the electrolyte towards the anode during electrolysis.
electrolyte
Which fuel is a gas at room temperature and makes two products when it burns in a plentiful
supply of air?
H H H H
H C C H + Cl Cl H C C Cl + H Cl
H H H H
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
C–Cl +340
C–C +350
C–H +410
Cl –Cl +240
H–Cl +430
A –1420 kJ / mol
B –120 kJ / mol
C +120 kJ / mol
D +1420 kJ / mol
Further heating causes the sulfur to undergo a ......2...... change and form sulfur dioxide.
1 2
A chemical chemical
B chemical physical
C physical chemical
D physical physical
15 A student was investigating the reaction between marble chips and dilute hydrochloric acid.
gas syringe
bung
marble
chips 25 cm3 of dilute
hydrochloric acid
16 Nitrogen, hydrogen and ammonia gases are placed inside a container. The container is then
sealed. After some time, an equilibrium forms.
A The amount of ammonia remains constant from the moment the container is sealed.
B The amounts of ammonia, nitrogen and hydrogen in the container are always equal.
C The rate of formation of ammonia is equal to the rate of decomposition of ammonia.
D The rate of formation of ammonia is faster than the rate of decomposition of ammonia.
Zn + Cu2+ → Zn2+ + Cu
reaction with
reaction with
aqueous
hydrochloric acid
sodium hydroxide
A key
B = reaction occurs
C = reaction does not occur
D
19 Which row shows how the hydrogen ion concentration and pH of ethanoic acid compare to those
of hydrochloric acid of the same concentration?
A higher higher
B higher lower
C lower higher
D lower lower
20 A pure sample of the insoluble salt barium carbonate can be made using the method given.
21 Substance X reacts with warm dilute hydrochloric acid to produce a gas which decolourises
acidified aqueous potassium manganate(VII).
What is X?
A potassium chloride
B potassium sulfite
C sodium chloride
D sodium sulfite
22 Which element is less reactive than the other members of its group in the Periodic Table?
A astatine
B caesium
C fluorine
D rubidium
carbon
silicon
germanium
tin
lead
flerovium
24 Why are weather balloons sometimes filled with helium rather than hydrogen?
A coloured solution is formed and metal Y is deposited at the bottom of the beaker.
26 Element E:
• forms an alloy
What is E?
A carbon
B copper
C sulfur
D zinc
27 Zinc metal is extracted from its ore zinc blende in a similar method to that used to extract iron
from hematite.
28 Stainless steel is an alloy of iron and other metals. It is strong and does not rust but it costs much
more than normal steel.
A cutlery
B pipes in a chemical factory
C railway lines
D saucepans
1 2 3
For which uses is it important for the water to have been treated?
A Oxides of nitrogen are formed by the reaction of nitrogen with oxygen during the fractional
distillation of liquid air.
B Oxides of nitrogen are formed in a car engine by the reaction of petrol with nitrogen from the
air.
C Oxides of nitrogen are removed from exhaust gases by reaction with carbon dioxide in a
catalytic converter.
D Oxides of nitrogen are removed from exhaust gases by reduction in a catalytic converter.
A Carbon dioxide is formed by the reaction of glucose with water during photosynthesis.
B Carbon dioxide is removed from the air by respiration.
C Glucose reacts with water to form oxygen during respiration.
D Photosynthesis produces glucose and oxygen.
pressure
temperature / °C catalyst
/ atm
A 200 2 V2O5
B 200 450 Fe
C 450 200 Fe
D 500 250 V2O5
fraction use
H H H H O H
H C C O H H C C C C H
H H H H H H
H H H H H H H H H
C C C C C C C C C
H H H H H H H H H
Which diagram shows the monomer from which this polymer could be manufactured?
A B C D
H H H H H H H
H C H H C C H C C H C C O H
H H H H H H H
A Fermentation uses a higher temperature than the catalytic addition of steam to ethene.
B Fermentation uses a non-renewable resource.
C The catalytic addition of steam to ethene produces purer ethanol than fermentation.
D The catalytic addition of steam to ethene uses a biological catalyst.
H H O
H C C C H
H H O C H
A catalysis
B hydration
C hydrolysis
D polymerisation
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/21/M/J/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2017 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 C 1
3 D 1
4 B 1
5 C 1
6 D 1
7 B 1
8 A 1
9 B 1
10 B 1
11 B 1
12 C 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 A 1
16 C 1
17 D 1
18 A 1
19 C 1
20 D 1
21 D 1
22 A 1
23 C 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 B 1
27 C 1
28 C 1
29 A 1
30 D 1
31 D 1
32 C 1
33 C 1
34 D 1
35 C 1
36 C 1
37 C 1
38 C 1
39 B 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2017
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 06_0620_31/FP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
A B C D E
Which atom, A, B, C, D or E,
(b) Complete the table to show the number of electrons, neutrons and protons in the chlorine atom
and bromide ion shown.
79
35Br
–
44
[3]
[Total: 8]
2 (a) The table shows the ions present in a 1000 cm3 sample of polluted river water.
mass present
ion present formula of ion
in mg / 1000 cm3
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Calculate the mass of silicate ions present in 250 cm3 of this sample.
(iv) Calculate the mass of solid formed when all the water is evaporated from the 1000 cm3
sample.
(v) Name the compound containing Ca2+ ions and HCO3– ions.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
test .............................................................................................................................................
result ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
aluminium chloride, Al Cl 3
calcium chloride, CaCl 2
sodium chloride, NaCl
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 10]
3 The diagram shows part of the structures of three substances, X, Y and Z, at room temperature and
pressure.
O
C
O O Na+ Cl – Na+ Cl –
C
O
O
Cl – Na+ Cl – Na+
O
C O
C
O
C
Na+ Cl – Na+ Cl –
O
X Y Z
● their bonding,
● the arrangement of their particles,
● the motion of their particles.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
end blocked
gas syringe
Describe what happens to the volume of substance X in the syringe when the pressure is
increased. The temperature remains constant. Explain your answer in terms of particles.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
Which two of the following are physical changes? Explain your answer.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 11]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) How does this equation show that chlorine is more reactive than bromine?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Aqueous potassium bromide and aqueous potassium chloride are both colourless.
Predict the colour change when aqueous chlorine reacts with aqueous potassium bromide.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Complete the chemical equation for the reaction of aqueous bromine with aqueous
potassium iodide.
test .............................................................................................................................................
result ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) The monomer used to make PVC is made by the thermal decomposition of dichloroethane.
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
1 ..........................................................................................................................................
2 ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 12]
CH3 CH3
C
C OH
CH2 H
CH2
CH2 CH2
C
CH3 H
(a) On the structure shown draw a circle around the alcohol functional group. [1]
(b) How many hydrogen atoms are there in one molecule of citronellol?
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) Describe how the density of the liquid alkanes varies with the number of carbon atoms in
one molecule.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Why would it be difficult to predict the melting point of butane from the information in the
table?
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [2]
(vi) Draw the structure of ethane. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
[Total: 13]
relative
density melting point relative
metal electrical cost
in g / cm3 in C strength
conductivity
(i) Which metal would be most useful for making overhead power cables?
Give two reasons for your answer.
metal ................................
reason 1 ..............................................................................................................................
reason 2 ..............................................................................................................................
[2]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) The front part of a space rocket is called a nose cone. The nose cone gets very hot as the
space rocket moves through the air.
Which metal is best to make a space rocket nose cone? Explain your answer.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
State two physical properties of transition elements which are not shown by Group I elements.
1 .................................................................................................................................................
2 .................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) When extremely hot tungsten reacts with oxygen, tungsten(VI) oxide is formed.
(d) Some information about the reaction of four metals with oxygen is given.
List these metals in order of their reactivity. Put the least reactive metal first.
[2]
(e) The table compares the time taken for reaction of an alloy with ethanoic acid, nitric acid and
phosphoric acid, each at three different concentrations. The time taken for the alloy to decrease
in mass by 1.0 g was measured. All other conditions were kept the same.
(i) How does the concentration of acid affect the rate of reaction?
.............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Predict how long it would take for the alloy to decrease in mass by 1.0 g using phosphoric
acid of concentration 0.03 mol / dm3.
(iv) Suggest which one of these pH values is the pH of concentrated aqueous ethanoic acid.
Draw a circle around the correct answer.
pH 4 pH 7 pH 10 pH 13
[1]
[Total: 14]
7 Carbon is an element in Group IV of the Periodic Table. It reacts with oxygen to form carbon dioxide.
C + O2
energy
CO2
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) Carbon monoxide, carbon dioxide and methane are all atmospheric pollutants.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
(c) Calcium carbonate decomposes to form calcium oxide (lime) and carbon dioxide.
....................................................................................................................................... [1]
Suggest how you could prepare a pure dry sample of carbon from a mixture of carbon powder
and magnesium powder.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 12]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/M/J/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2017 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) A 1
1(a)(ii) E 1
1(a)(iii) C 1
1(a)(iv) B 1
1(a)(v) C 1
number of neutrons in Cl = 18 1
2(a)(iii) 3 (mg) 1
yellow 1
2(c) MgCl2 1
4(b)(i) the chlorine has displaced / replaced the bromine (in KBr) 1
4(b)(iii) I2 1
KBr 1
yellow precipitate 1
4(d)(i) water purification / water treatment / killing bacteria / in (swimming) pools / disinfectant 1
(using) heat 1
5(b) 20 1
5(d)(ii) any value between –88 and 0 (°C) (exclusive of these values) 1
5(d)(iv) liquid 1
30 °C is between melting and boiling point / 30 °C is above the melting point and below the boiling point 1
5(d)(vi) H H 1
H C C H
H H
5(d)(vii) 3 (CO2) 1
5 (O2) 1
6(a)(i) aluminium
low density 1
6(c) 2 (W) 1
3 (O2) 1
6(e)(i) the more concentrated the acid, the greater the rate ORA 1
6(e)(iv) pH 4 1
7(a) the energy of the reactants is greater than the energy of the products / the product has less energy than the reactants / the 1
arrow is going down (from reactants to product)
any 3 effects:
• carbon dioxide: global warming / greenhouse effect / acidification of oceans
• methane: global warming / greenhouse effect
• carbon monoxide: poisonous / toxic
7(c)(i) making mortar / whitewash / neutralising (acidic) soils / neutralising acidic lakes / flue gas desulfurisation / steelmaking 1
/ glassmaking / making plaster
7(c)(ii) 100 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for (Ca =) 40, (C =) 12 and (O =) 16
wash carbon (with water or other solvent) AND dry in an oven / air dry / leave in air / leave to dry 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 06_0620_41/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
(b) Why is the 11H hydrogen atom the only atom to have an identical proton number and nucleon
number?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Complete the table to show the number of protons, neutrons and electrons in the atoms and
ions given.
26
Mg 12
31
P3–
87
Sr2+
[6]
(d) (i) Write the formula of the compound formed from fluorine and magnesium.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Write the formula of the compound formed from Sr2+ and P3–.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 12]
(a) Answer the following questions using only oxides from the list. Each oxide may be used once,
more than once or not at all.
(ii) which would give a solution of pH 14 when added to water, ................................................
(b) Amphoteric oxides and neutral oxides are different from each other.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 8]
(a) A student prepared magnesium sulfate crystals starting from magnesium carbonate. The
student carried out the experiment in four steps.
step 1
The student added excess magnesium carbonate to a small volume of
dilute sulfuric acid until no more magnesium carbonate would react.
step 3 The student heated the filtrate obtained from step 2 until it was saturated.
step 4 T
he student allowed the hot filtrate to cool to room temperature and then removed
the crystals which formed.
(i) How did the student know when the reaction had finished in step 1?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b)
Magnesium sulfate crystals are hydrated. Another student heated some hydrated
magnesium sulfate crystals in a crucible and obtained the following results.
(ii) Calculate the number of moles of anhydrous magnesium sulfate remaining in the crucible.
The Mr of anhydrous magnesium sulfate is 120.
(iii) Calculate the ratio of moles of anhydrous magnesium sulfate : moles of water. Give your
answer as whole numbers.
Describe how you would prepare a pure dry sample of lead(II) sulfate crystals starting from
solutions of lead(II) nitrate and sodium sulfate.
Include a series of key steps in your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [4]
(d) Write the ionic equation for the reaction which takes place between solutions of lead(II) nitrate
and sodium sulfate.
Include state symbols.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 16]
(a) Zinc is extracted from its ore, zinc blende. Zinc blende contains zinc sulfide, ZnS.
(i) Describe how zinc sulfide is converted to zinc oxide in this industrial process.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(i) Name the substance added to the furnace to reduce the zinc oxide.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe how the pure zinc is removed from the furnace and collected.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(c) When rods of zinc and copper are placed into dilute sulfuric acid as shown, electricity is
generated.
bulb
(i) Write the ionic half-equation for the reaction occurring at the zinc rod.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Write the ionic half-equation for the reaction occurring at the copper rod.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
Suggest the change, if any, in the intensity of the light emitted from the bulb and give a
reason for your answer.
change .................................................................................................................................
reason ..................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 12]
5 When barium carbonate is added to dilute hydrochloric acid, carbon dioxide gas is formed.
A student carried out an experiment to measure the volume of gas formed as a reaction proceeds.
The student added a small mass of powdered barium carbonate to an excess of 0.1 mol / dm3
hydrochloric acid. A graph of the results was drawn.
400
300
volume
of gas 200
/ cm3
100
0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240
time / s
(a) Name the two pieces of apparatus needed to take the measurements shown on the graph.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[1]
(b) On the axes below, sketch a graph to show how the rate of reaction changes as the reaction
proceeds.
rate of
reaction
0
0 30 60 90 120
time / s
[2]
(c) The total volume of gas collected was 180 cm3 at room temperature and pressure.
On the grid, draw the graph expected if the same mass of barium carbonate is added as large
lumps instead of as a powder. All other conditions are the same as in the original experiment.
400
300
volume
of gas 200
/ cm3
100
0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240
time / s
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
On the grid, draw the graph expected if the concentration of dilute hydrochloric acid is changed
from 0.1 mol / dm3 to 0.2 mol / dm3. All other conditions are the same as in the original experiment.
Explain, in terms of particles, why your graph is different from the original graph.
400
300
volume
of gas 200
/ cm3
100
0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240
time / s
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [4]
(f)
The experiment is changed and the mass of powdered barium carbonate is doubled. All other
conditions are the same as in the original experiment. The acid is still in excess.
Deduce the volume of gas formed at room temperature and pressure, in cm3, in this experiment.
[Total: 13]
6 The alkenes and alkanes are both examples of homologous series which are hydrocarbons.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[3]
(c) Name and draw the structure of the second member of the alkene homologous series.
Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
name ...........................................................................................................................................
structure
[2]
Name the reagent and conditions needed to convert an alkene into an alcohol.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) The alcohol butanol, CH3CH2CH2CH2OH, can be converted into a carboxylic acid with four
carbon atoms.
(i) Name the carboxylic acid formed from butanol and draw its structure. Show all of the
atoms and all of the bonds.
name ....................................................................................................................................
structure
[2]
(ii) Ethanoic acid can be formed from ethanol by fermentation. It can also be formed by the
addition of a suitable chemical reagent.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(iii)
State the type of chemical change which occurs when ethanol is converted into
ethanoic acid.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(f) Describe how a student could prepare the ester methyl ethanoate in a school laboratory.
In your description give
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
[Total: 19]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/M/J/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory Extended May/June 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2017 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(c)
number of number of number of
protons neutrons electrons
19
F 9 10 9
26
Mg 12 14 12
31 3–
P 15 16 18
87 2+
Sr 38 49 36
1(d)(i) MgF2 1
1(d)(ii) Sr3P2 1
2(a)(i) SO2 1
2(a)(ii) Na2O 1
2(a)(iii) Cr2O3 1
2(a)(iv) SiO2 1
2(a)(vi) CO 1
2(b)(i) an amphoteric oxide will react with acids AND with bases 1
2(b)(ii) a neutral oxide will not react with acids or with bases 1
at that temperature 1
3(b)(iv) MgSO4.7H2O 2
M1 MgSO4
M2 rest of the formula correct
M1 correct species
M2 correct state symbols
M1 correct species
M2 correct balancing
4(b)(i) coke 1
and is condensed 1
M1 correct species
M2 correct balancing
M1 correct species
M2 correct balancing
reason: the difference in reactivity between zinc and iron is less than the difference in reactivity between zinc and copper 1
5(d) curve starts from (0,0) and has a lower gradient than the original curve 1
5(e) curve starts from (0,0) and has a steeper gradient than the original curve 1
because there are more particles per unit volume / dm3 / cm3 1
because there are more collisions per second / unit time OR a greater collision rate 1
5(f) 360 (cm3) 1
6(c) propene 1
6(d) steam 1
catalyst 1
6(e)(ii) acidified 1
(potassium) manganate(VII) 1
6(e)(iii) oxidation 1
6(f) methanol 1
ethanoic acid 1
catalyst 1
heat 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*4461154142*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email [email protected]
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 06_0620_51CI/5RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
Question 1
Each candidate will require the following apparatus and chemicals. The labels of solution C and
solution D must not include concentrations.
(f) 50 cm3 of an aqueous solution of potassium iodate, KIO3, containing 6 g per dm3, labelled
solution C
(g) 50 cm3 of an aqueous solution of potassium iodate, KIO3, containing 3 g per dm3, labelled
solution D
[MH] (h) 50 cm3 of sulfuric acid of concentration 1 mol / dm3, labelled dilute sulfuric acid
(j) two samples in stoppered test-tubes of 1 g solid potassium iodide, each labelled 1 g of
potassium iodide
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following apparatus and chemicals. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[MH][N] (h) aqueous silver nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive halide test
(m) spatulas
(n) splints
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
2 The Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
Cambridge on the Special Consideration Form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 06_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between aqueous sodium thiosulfate and two different
aqueous solutions of potassium iodate labelled solution C and solution D.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
● ill the burette provided up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with the aqueous sodium thiosulfate.
F
● Use a measuring cylinder to pour 20 cm3 of solution C into a conical flask.
● Add 10 cm3 of dilute sulfuric acid into the flask and 1 g of potassium iodide. Swirl the flask
to mix the contents.
● Add the aqueous sodium thiosulfate slowly from the burette to the flask, and swirl to mix
thoroughly.
● When the contents of the flask are pale yellow, add 1 cm3 of starch solution to the flask.
● Continue to add aqueous sodium thiosulfate slowly to the flask until the solution just turns
colourless.
● Record the burette readings in the table.
(b) Experiment 2
Experiment 1 Experiment 2
difference / cm3
[4]
(c) D
escribe the appearance of the solution in the conical flask before adding the aqueous
sodium thiosulfate.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) B
efore the addition of the starch solution, describe the changes to the colour of the solution in
the conical flask as the aqueous sodium thiosulfate is added.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) What colour change is observed in the conical flask when the starch solution is added?
(f) (i) W
hich solution of potassium iodate, solution C or solution D, is the more concentrated?
Explain your answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) How many times more concentrated is this solution of potassium iodate?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(g) Predict the volume of aqueous sodium thiosulfate which would be needed to react completely
with 30 cm3 of solution D.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 16]
tests on solid E
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Place a small amount of solid E in a hard glass test-tube. Heat the solid gently then strongly.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) (i) Place a small amount of solid E in a test-tube and add about 2 cm3 of dilute sulfuric acid.
Test the gas given off.
Record your observations.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
(ii) Now gradually add an excess of aqueous ammonia to the mixture in the test-tube.
Record your observations.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
(d) C
arry out a flame test on solid E.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on solid F
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
dd about 4 cm3 of distilled water to about half of solid F in a test-tube and shake the test-tube to
A
dissolve solid F.
Divide the solution into two equal portions in two test-tubes and carry out the following tests.
(g) (i) T
o the first portion of the solution, add an excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) T
o the second portion of the solution, add about 1 cm3 of dilute nitric acid and aqueous
silver nitrate.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(h) C
arry out a flame test on solid F.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 18]
3 A sample of furniture cleaner contains aqueous sodium chloride, aqueous ammonia and sand.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
[Total: 6]
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp, red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2017 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
unit: cm3 1
2(a) green 1
2(c)(ii) blue 1
precipitate 1
2(d) blue-green 1
carbonate / CO32– 1
2(f) white 1
2(h) lilac 1
2(i) potassium / K+ 1
iodide / I– 1
dry 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 06_0620_61/FP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
.........................................
strontium
carbonate
added
strontium nitrate
solution
dilute acid
unreacted
solid
stage 1 stage 2 stage 3
(ii) What is used to add the strontium carbonate to the acid in stage 1?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) Describe how crystals of strontium nitrate could be obtained from the mixture in stage 3.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 10]
2 A student investigated the reaction between aqueous sodium thiosulfate and two different aqueous
solutions of potassium iodate labelled solution C and solution D.
Experiment 1
● burette was filled with aqueous sodium thiosulfate. The initial burette reading was recorded.
A
● Using a measuring cylinder, 20 cm3 of solution C were poured into a conical flask. 10 cm3 of
dilute sulfuric acid and 1 g of potassium iodide were added to the flask to form a solution of
iodine. The flask was swirled to mix the contents.
● Aqueous sodium thiosulfate was slowly added from the burette to the flask and swirled to mix
thoroughly.
● When the contents of the flask turned pale yellow, starch solution was added and the solution
turned blue-black.
● More aqueous sodium thiosulfate was then added slowly to the flask until the solution just
turned colourless. The final burette reading was recorded.
(a) Use the burette diagrams to record the readings in the table and complete the table.
4 37
5 38
6 39
difference / cm3
[2]
Experiment 2
(b) Use the burette diagrams to record the readings in the table and complete the table.
3 20
4 21
5 22
difference / cm3
[2]
(c) (i) W
hich solution of potassium iodate, solution C or solution D, is the more concentrated?
Explain your answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) How many times more concentrated is this solution of potassium iodate?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) Predict the volume of aqueous sodium thiosulfate which would be needed to react completely
with 30 cm3 of solution D.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
1. ..........................................................................................................................................
2. ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
1. ..........................................................................................................................................
2. ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 13]
3 Two solids, E and F, were analysed. Solid F was potassium iodide. Tests were carried out on each
solid. Some of the observations on solid E are shown.
test 1
Solid E was heated gently then strongly. the solid turned black
test 2
Excess aqueous ammonia was then added to a pale blue precipitate formed, which then
the mixture in the test-tube. dissolved to form a dark blue solution
test 3
(a)
Test 1 states that the solid should be heated gently then strongly.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on solid F
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Distilled water was added to solid F in a test-tube and shaken to dissolve solid F.
(e) (i) To the first portion of the solution, an excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was added.
(ii) T
o the second portion of the solution, dilute nitric acid and aqueous silver nitrate were
added.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 11]
4 A sample of furniture cleaner contains aqueous sodium chloride, aqueous ammonia and sand.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
[Total: 6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2017 series for most Cambridge IGCSE®,
Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(ii) Spatula 1
1(d) filter 1
heat / evaporate 1
2(c)(ii) 2 × as concentrated 1
unit: cm3 1
3(a) solid spits out of the tube / the tube might crack 1
carbonate / CO32– 1
3(d) white 1
3(e)(ii) yellow 1
precipitate 1
3(f) lilac 1
dry 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*1330880521*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_11/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 The diagram shows how the arrangement of particles changes when a substance changes state.
A boiling
B condensation
C evaporation
D sublimation
2 Which method can be used to separate a mixture of salt and water to obtain both parts of the
mixture?
A crystallisation
B distillation
C evaporation
D filtration
3 A student put 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid into a conical flask.
The student added 2.5 g of solid sodium carbonate and measured the change in temperature of
the mixture.
Which apparatus does the student need to use to obtain the most accurate results?
A –61 °C to –51 °C
B –56 °C
C 51 °C to 61 °C
D 56 °C
P Q R
W 6 6 6
X 6 6 7
Y 7 7 7
Z 7 7 8
substance 1 substance 2
8 Substances with giant covalent structures can be used as lubricants and as cutting tools for hard
materials.
The diagram shows how the atoms are arranged in two giant covalent substances, X and Y.
X Y
key
strong
covalent
bond
weak
attraction
9 The equation shows the thermal decomposition of magnesium carbonate (Mr = 84).
Which mass of magnesium oxide is formed when 21.0 g of magnesium carbonate are completely
decomposed?
10 Electricity is passed through concentrated aqueous sodium chloride. Inert electrodes are used.
+ –
concentrated
aqueous sodium
chloride
A chlorine
B hydrogen
C oxygen
D sodium
1 2
12 When dilute sulfuric acid reacts with aqueous sodium hydroxide, the temperature of the solution
increases.
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
14 When blue copper(II) sulfate is heated, a white solid and water are formed.
The white solid turns blue and gives out heat when water is added to it.
Which terms describe the blue copper(II) sulfate and the reactions?
the blue
reactions
copper(II) sulfate is
15 Which changes increase the rate of reaction between calcium carbonate and dilute
hydrochloric acid?
P 2NaNO2 + O2 → 2NaNO3
Q 2HgO → 2Hg + O2
P Q
A
B
C
D
18 Magnesium, phosphorus and chlorine are elements in the same period of the Periodic Table.
Which row describes the type of oxide formed by each of these elements?
19 Zinc sulfate is made by reacting an excess of zinc oxide with dilute sulfuric acid.
Which process is used to obtain solid zinc sulfate from the solution?
A crystallisation
B dissolving
C filtration
D fractional distillation
A a glowing splint
B damp litmus paper
C limewater
21 Which statements about the trends across a period of the Periodic Table are correct?
The melting point of astatine is ......2...... than the melting point of iodine.
1 2 3
A high no no
B high yes yes
C low no yes
D low yes no
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
26 Which material is not involved in the large-scale extraction of iron from iron ore?
A bauxite
B calcium carbonate (limestone)
C carbon (coke)
D hematite
P yes no
Q no yes
R yes yes
most least
reactive reactive
A P R Q
B Q P R
C R P Q
D R Q P
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
A argon
B carbon dioxide
C nitrogen
D oxygen
Mild steel is used for ......1...... and is prevented from rusting by ......2...... .
Stainless steel does not rust. It is produced by ......3...... iron with another metal.
1 2 3
32 A mixture produces a gas both when it reacts with an acid and when it reacts with an alkali.
33 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
1 2 3 4
C C H C C H H C C H H C C CH3
H3 C CH3 H CH3 H H H H
35 Some of the fractions obtained from the fractional distillation of petroleum are used as fuels for
vehicles.
A coal
B hydrogen
C natural gas
D petroleum
38 The table shows bonds that are present and bonds that are not present in compound X.
bond
C–C
C=C
C–H
C–O
C=O
O–H
A a carboxylic acid
B an alcohol
C an alkane
D an alkene
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
H H H H H H H H H H H H
C C + C C + C C C C C C C C
H H H H H H H H H H H H
A cracking
B oxidation
C polymerisation
D reduction
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/11/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 B 1
3 C 1
4 D 1
5 C 1
6 A 1
7 C 1
8 B 1
9 C 1
10 B 1
11 B 1
12 C 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 B 1
16 B 1
17 B 1
18 C 1
19 A 1
20 B 1
21 C 1
22 A 1
23 B 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 A 1
27 A 1
28 A 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 B 1
32 A 1
33 C 1
34 C 1
35 C 1
36 B 1
37 B 1
38 A 1
39 B 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*1790619835*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 Which process causes the greatest increase in the distance between particles?
A condensation
B freezing
C melting
D sublimation
2 A student put 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid into a conical flask.
The student added 2.5 g of solid sodium carbonate and measured the change in temperature of
the mixture.
Which apparatus does the student need to use to obtain the most accurate results?
distance travelled / cm
solvent 5.0
substance X 3.0
substance Y 2.5
Rf (X) Rf (Y)
A 0.5 0.6
B 0.6 0.5
C 1.6 2.0
D 2.0 1.6
1 It is a hard substance.
2 It has a macromolecular structure with strong covalent bonds.
Which is correct?
5 Which statement explains why isotopes of the same element have the same chemical properties?
6 Which dot-and-cross diagram shows the outer shell electron arrangement in a molecule of
nitrogen?
A B C D
N N N N N N N N
7 The equation for the reaction between barium chloride solution and dilute sulfuric acid is shown.
8 A compound is analysed and found to contain 85.7% carbon and 14.3% hydrogen.
9 Which statements about the electrolysis of concentrated copper(II) chloride are correct?
2 Electrons move round the external circuit from the cathode to the anode.
3 Chloride ions are attracted to the anode.
4 Hydroxide ions transfer electrons to the cathode.
10 Which metal combination produces the highest voltage reading in the cells shown?
A B
V V
Fe Cu Zn Cu
C D
V V
Cu Cu Mg Cu
11 The compound hydrazine is used as a rocket fuel. It has the structural formula shown.
H H
N N
H H
N2H4 → N2 + 2H2
bond energy
in kJ / mol
H–H +436
N–H +390
N–N +160
N≡N +945
A The energy absorbed for bond breaking is greater than the energy released by bond
formation.
B The energy absorbed for bond breaking is less than the energy released by bond formation.
C The energy released by bond breaking is greater than the energy absorbed for bond
formation.
D The energy released by bond breaking is less than the energy absorbed for bond formation.
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
CuO + H2 → Cu + H2O
A H2 CuO
B CuO H2
C H2O Cu
D Cu H2O
Which statements explain why an increase in temperature increases the rate of the reaction?
Which changes in temperature and pressure increase the equilibrium yield of carbon monoxide?
temperature pressure
A decrease decrease
B decrease increase
C increase decrease
D increase increase
Oxide 2 reacts with acids to form salts but does not react with alkalis.
Oxide 3 reacts with alkalis to form salts but does not react with acids.
19 Zinc sulfate is made by reacting an excess of zinc oxide with dilute sulfuric acid.
Which process is used to obtain solid zinc sulfate from the solution?
A crystallisation
B dissolving
C filtration
D fractional distillation
A a glowing splint
B damp litmus paper
C limewater
21 Which statements about the trends across a period of the Periodic Table are correct?
The melting point of astatine is ......2...... than the melting point of iodine.
1 2 3
A high no no
B high yes yes
C low no yes
D low yes no
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
A aluminium tin
B aluminium zinc
C copper tin
D copper zinc
28 Information about the nitrates and carbonates of two metals, Q and R, is shown.
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
The nails were placed in an open dish filled with water and left for a week.
A B
wrapped wrapped
in aluminium in copper
D C
wrapped wrapped
in zinc in magnesium
N2 + 3H2 2NH3
What are the sources of the nitrogen and hydrogen used in the Haber process?
nitrogen hydrogen
A combustion of alkanes
B photosynthesis
C respiration
D thermal decomposition of limestone
33 Which row shows the conditions used in the manufacture of sulfuric acid by the Contact process?
temperature pressure
catalyst
/ °C / atm
A 40 200 Fe
B 40 200 V2O5
C 400 2 Fe
D 400 2 V2O5
34 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
1 2 3 4
C C H C C H H C C H H C C CH3
H3 C CH3 H CH3 H H H H
36 Some of the fractions obtained from the fractional distillation of petroleum are used as fuels for
vehicles.
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
O O O O O
C C N N C C N N C
H H H H
1 2
A polyamide addition
B polyamide condensation
C polyester addition
D polyester condensation
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/21/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 C 1
3 B 1
4 A 1
5 C 1
6 B 1
7 A 1
8 B 1
9 A 1
10 D 1
11 B 1
12 B 1
13 B 1
14 B 1
15 C 1
16 C 1
17 B 1
18 B 1
19 A 1
20 B 1
21 C 1
22 A 1
23 B 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 A 1
27 D 1
28 D 1
29 C 1
30 B 1
31 C 1
32 B 1
33 D 1
34 C 1
35 C 1
36 C 1
37 B 1
38 B 1
39 C 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_31/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
A B C
Na+ Br – Na+ Br – F
Br Br
Br – Na+ Br – Na+ F Br F
Na+ Br – Na+ Br –
D E
H H H H
C C Br C C Br
H H H H
nswer the following questions using only the structures in the diagram.
A
Each structure may be used once, more than once or not at all.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
2 The table shows the composition of the atmosphere of the planet Neptune.
percentage of gas in
gas present
Neptune’s atmosphere
helium 19.5
hydrogen 78.8
methane
(a) Complete the table to calculate the percentage of methane in Neptune’s atmosphere. [1]
(b) D
escribe how Neptune’s atmosphere differs from the Earth’s atmosphere.
Give three differences.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
[2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
educe the number of protons and neutrons present in one atom of this isotope of
D
hydrogen.
Use your Periodic Table to help you.
(e) Other gases present in Neptune’s atmosphere include ethane and water vapour.
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 13]
coloured dyes
ethanol
preservatives
sodium carbonate
(a) (i) Balance the chemical equation for the complete combustion of ethanol.
(ii) Draw the structure of an ethanol molecule showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[2]
(iii) T
he chemical equation for the reaction between sodium carbonate and dilute sulfuric acid
is shown.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The coloured dyes in the liquid floor cleaner can be separated using the apparatus shown.
P ..................................................................
Q ..................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) O
n the diagram, put an X to show where the mixture of coloured dyes is placed at the start
of the experiment. [1]
[Total: 14]
electrical electrical
density
substance boiling point conductivity conductivity
in g / cm3
of solid when molten
graphite 2.25
(a) Complete the table to show the electrical conductivity of solid graphite and solid potassium.
[2]
(b) Give one piece of evidence from the table that shows that iodine is a simple covalent substance.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) What information in the table shows that zinc chloride is an ionic compound?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Aqueous iodine is formed when aqueous chlorine is added to aqueous potassium iodide.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
(a) (i) Balance the chemical equation for the first step in this extraction.
(ii) Explain why the conversion of carbon to carbon monoxide is an oxidation reaction.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) T
itanium is a transition element.
Sodium is a Group I element.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) T
he properties and relative reactivity with water of some Group I elements are shown in the
table.
(ii) Describe the general trend in the density of the Group I elements.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
6 The diagram shows a fractionating column used for the fractional distillation of petroleum.
refinery gas
gasoline fraction
naphtha fraction
kerosene fraction
lubricating fraction
and bitumen
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [4]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
C4H10 2C2H4 + X
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
All the bonds in butane are single ................................ chemical bonds. [1]
[Total: 9]
(a) A few drops of liquid bromine were placed at the bottom of a beaker containing cyclohexane.
After 3 days, a red-brown colour had spread throughout the beaker.
cyclohexane
bromine
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
Br H H O
H C C C C
H Br H O H
(i) D
educe the molecular formula of this compound showing the number of carbon, hydrogen,
oxygen and bromine atoms.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
Complete the definition of relative atomic mass using terms from the list.
6
12
an atom
an element
a molecule
average
carbon
hydrogen
total
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
3 ...........................................................................................................................................
[3]
(ii) Hydrobromic acid reacts with oxygen. The products are water and bromine.
[Total: 13]
8 Ammonia is manufactured by combining nitrogen and hydrogen at high temperature and pressure.
catalyst
nitrogen + hydrogen ammonia
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) The graph shows the percentage yield of ammonia at different temperatures.
100
80
60
percentage
yield of
ammonia
40
20
0
0 100 200 300 400 500 600
temperature / °C
(i) Describe how the percentage yield of ammonia changes with temperature.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
When 20 g of copper(II) oxide react with an excess of ammonia, 16 g of copper are formed.
alculate the mass of copper formed when 140 g of copper(II) oxide react with an excess of
C
ammonia.
.............................. g [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Core Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) A 1
1(a)(ii) B 1
1(a)(iii) D 1
1(a)(iv) B 1
1(a)(v) C 1
1(b) substance containing only one type of atom / substance containing atoms (each) with the same number of protons 1
/ substance which cannot be broken down further by chemical means
1(c) solid 1
2(c) labels ‘C’ and ‘H’ in the correct circles and no non-bonding electrons or extra bonding electrons 1
2(d)(i) atoms of the same element with the same number of protons but a different number of neutrons 1
number of neutrons: 2 1
2(e)(i) 30 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for (C =) 12 and (H =) 1
3(a)(i) 2 (CO2) 1
3 (H2O) 1
3(a)(ii) correct structure showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds including O–H 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for structure with OH
3(b)(i) pH 10 1
3(b)(ii) red / pink 1
to yellow 1
3(b)(iii) sodium carbonate + sulfuric acid → sodium sulfate + carbon dioxide + water 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for either sodium sulfate OR carbon dioxide + water
Q: solvent 1
3(d)(ii) chromatography 1
potassium: conducts 1
4(c) does not conduct when solid but conducts when molten 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for conducts when molten
5(a)(i) 2 (C) 1
2 (Cl2) 1
5(c)(i) relative reactivity with water: forms bubbles slowly / slower than sodium 1
6(b)(ii) hydrogen 1
6(c) covalent 1
6(d) polymer 1
7(b)(i) C4H6O2Br2 1
7(c) average 1
an element 1
an atom 1
12 1
7(d)(ii) 4 (HBr) 1
8(b)(ii) 28% 1
8(c) 112 (g) 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_41/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 The table gives information about five particles. The particles are all atoms or ions.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b)
D is an ion of an element.
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 6]
2 The graph shows how the temperature of a substance changes as it is cooled over a period of
30 minutes. The substance is a gas at the start.
300 S
250 T
V W
200
X
temperature Y
150
/ °C
Z
100
50
0
0 10 20 30
time / minutes
Each letter on the graph may be used once, more than once or not at all.
(i) the particles in the substance have the most kinetic energy,
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Use the graph to estimate the freezing point of the substance.
.............................. °C [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) W
hen smoke is viewed through a microscope, the smoke particles in the air appear to jump
around.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
Mg + Cu2+ Mg2+ + Cu
(i) Give one change you would observe during this reaction.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Identify the oxidising agent in this reaction. Give a reason for your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
Write a chemical equation for the reaction between magnesium and iron(III) oxide.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) T
he metal iron and the alloy steel are commonly used materials. A problem with them is that
they rust.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
xplain how the magnesium blocks prevent the whole of the bottom of the boat from
E
rusting.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) Replacing the magnesium blocks with copper blocks does not prevent rusting.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 10]
(i) Complete the chemical equation for the formation of ethanol by fermentation.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(b) E
thanol can also be made by the catalytic hydration of ethene. The equation for the reaction is
shown.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Calculate the maximum mass of ethanol that can be made from 56 g of ethene.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
H O
H C C
H O H
H O
H C C
H O H
[3]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Describe how you could show that ethanoic acid is a weaker acid than hydrochloric acid.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
H H O
H C C C H H H H
H H O C C C C H
H H H H
raw the structures of the carboxylic acid and alcohol from which this ester can be made.
D
Give the names of the carboxylic acid and alcohol.
[Total: 19]
olid copper(II) carbonate undergoes thermal decomposition. One of the products of the
5 (a) S
thermal decomposition is copper(II) oxide.
(i) State the colour change of the solid seen during the reaction.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
opper(II) carbonate reacts with dilute nitric acid. One of the products of the reaction is a
(b) C
solution of copper(II) nitrate.
(i) Describe tests for copper(II) ions and nitrate ions. Include the results of the tests.
copper(II) ions .....................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
nitrate ions............................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
[4]
Balance the chemical equation for the thermal decomposition of copper(II) nitrate.
(c) N itrogen dioxide, NO2, exists in equilibrium with dinitrogen tetroxide, N2O4.
Nitrogen dioxide is brown and dinitrogen tetroxide is colourless.
2NO2(g) N2O4(g)
brown colourless
end blocked
gas syringe
State how the colour of the gas in the syringe changed. Explain your answer in terms of
the position of the equilibrium.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) A
sealed tube containing nitrogen dioxide and dinitrogen tetroxide at equilibrium was
cooled in an ice bath at constant pressure. The contents of the tube became paler.
Suggest an explanation for this observation in terms of the position of the equilibrium.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 12]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) C
omplete the dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in one of the
oxide ions present in aluminium oxide. Include the charge on the oxide ion.
One of the aluminium ions is shown.
3+ ........
Al O
[2]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
+ power –
supply
anodes wires
cathode
+ +
aluminium oxide
and cryolite
molten aluminium
(i) Name the type of particle responsible for the transfer of charge in
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) Write the ionic half-equation for the formation of aluminium during the electrolysis.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) W
hen a piece of aluminium is placed in dilute hydrochloric acid, there is no immediate visible
reaction.
If the aluminium is left in the dilute hydrochloric acid for several hours, bubbles start to form.
Explain why aluminium does not react immediately with dilute hydrochloric acid.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 14]
(a) T
he rate of the reaction can be increased by increasing the concentration of the hydrochloric acid
or by heating it.
(i) In terms of collisions, explain why increasing the concentration of the hydrochloric acid
increases the rate of the reaction.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) In terms of collisions, explain why heating the hydrochloric acid increases the rate of the
reaction.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) (i) Calculate the number of moles of copper(II) oxide added to the hydrochloric acid.
rystals of hydrated copper(II) chloride were obtained from the solution at the end of the
(c) C
reaction.
The crystals had the following composition by mass: Cl, 41.52%; Cu, 37.43%; H, 2.34%;
O, 18.71%.
[Total: 11]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Extended Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) B 1
1(a)(ii) A 1
1(a)(iii) C 1
1(a)(iv) E 1
1(b) O2– 2
M1 O
M2 2–
2(a)(i) S 1
2(a)(ii) S 1
2(a)(iii) V 1
2(c) sublimation 1
gains electrons 1
4(b)(ii) 92 2
If full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for Mr of ethene = 28
4(c)(ii) 3
propanoic acid 1
structure of butan-1-ol 1
butan-1-ol 1
(nitrate ions) add aluminium AND aqueous sodium hydroxide AND warm 1
5(b)(ii) 2 / 2 / 4 / 1 1
6(b)(i) oxide ion has an outer shell with six dots and two crosses 1
7(a)(ii) particles have more energy / particles move faster / more collisions per second / more collisions per unit time / greater 1
collision rate
more (of the) particles / collisions have energy greater than the activation energy / more particles have sufficient energy to 1
react / more collisions have sufficient energy to react / a greater percentage of collisions are successful
7(b)(i) 0.075 2
If full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for Mr of CuO = 80
7(b)(ii) 0.05 1
7(b)(iii) 4 (g) 2
M1 moles copper(II) oxide that reacted = (0.05 / 2) = 0.025 mol
M2 mass copper(II) oxide = ((0.075 – 0.025) × 80) = 4 g
7(c) Cl2CuH4O2 2
M1 41.52 / 35.5; 37.43 / 64; 2.34 / 1; 18.71 / 16 OR 1.17 : 0.58 : 2.34 : 1.17
M2 appropriate scaling to give whole number ratios
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*3496257854*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email [email protected]
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_51CI/FP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
Question 1
[MH] (f) 3 g of anhydrous calcium chloride in a stoppered test-tube, labelled solid X
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following apparatus and chemicals. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[MH][N] (b) 10 cm3 of aqueous ammonia of concentration 1 mol / dm3, in a stoppered test-tube,
labelled solution Z
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 A student reacted dilute hydrochloric acid with zinc oxide to prepare zinc chloride solution.
The diagram shows part of the procedure.
zinc chloride
solution
unreacted
zinc oxide
funnel
.........................................
(b)
Which of the reactants was in excess?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) (i)
Name the separation process this apparatus is used for.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) Describe how crystals of zinc chloride could be obtained from the zinc chloride solution.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 7]
2
A student investigated the rate of reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and aqueous
sodium thiosulfate. When these chemicals react they form a precipitate which makes the solution
go cloudy. The formation of this precipitate can be used to show how fast the reaction proceeds.
eye
Experiment 1
● sing a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were poured into a conical
U
flask. The initial temperature of the solution was measured. The conical flask was placed on a
sheet of paper with words printed on it.
● Using a measuring cylinder, 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid were added to the solution in the
conical flask and a stopclock was started.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
● The final temperature of the mixture was measured.
Experiment 2
● sing a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were poured into a conical
U
flask. The solution was heated to about 30 °C and the temperature was measured. The conical
flask was placed on a sheet of paper with words printed on it.
● Using a measuring cylinder, 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid were added to the solution in the
conical flask and a stopclock was started.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
● The final temperature of the mixture was measured.
Experiment 3
● xperiment 2 was repeated but the 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were heated to about
E
40 °C before adding the dilute hydrochloric acid.
Experiment 4
● xperiment 2 was repeated but the 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were heated to about
E
50 °C before adding the dilute hydrochloric acid.
Experiment 5
● xperiment 2 was repeated but the 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were heated to about
E
60 °C before adding the dilute hydrochloric acid.
(a) Calculate the average temperatures and record them in the table.
Use the stopclock diagrams to record the times in the table.
1 19 17 45 15 5 15
10
minutes
30
0
0
2 32 30 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
3 42 40 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
4 54 52 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
5 65 61 45 15 5 15
10
30
[3]
(b) Plot the results of Experiments 1–5 on the grid. Draw a smooth line graph.
240
210
180
150
time taken
for the
printed
words to 120
disappear
from view / s
90
60
30
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
average temperature / °C
[4]
(c) From your graph, deduce the time taken for the printed words to disappear from view when
Experiment 2 was repeated at an initial temperature of 73 °C. The final temperature of the
mixture was 71 °C.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) Sketch on the grid the graph you would expect if all of the experiments were repeated using
a more dilute solution of aqueous sodium thiosulfate. [1]
(e) (i) In which experiment, 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, was the rate of reaction greatest?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Explain, in terms of particles, why the rate of reaction was greatest in this experiment.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 18]
3 Two solid salts, F and G, were analysed. Solid F was iron(III) nitrate.
Tests were carried out on each solid.
tests on solid F
Solid F was dissolved in distilled water to produce solution F. Solution F was divided into three
equal portions in three test-tubes.
(a) (i) A
few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the first portion of solution F until
a change was seen.
(ii) An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was then added to the mixture from (a)(i).
observations................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) An excess of aqueous ammonia was added to the second portion of solution F until a change
was seen.
observations.......................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Aluminium foil and aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the third portion of solution F.
The mixture was heated and the gas which was produced was tested.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
tests on solid G
test 1
test 2
The gas produced was passed through limewater. limewater turned milky
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 9]
4 Iron, tin and zinc all react with dilute hydrochloric acid to produce hydrogen.
Plan an experiment to determine the order of reactivity of iron, tin and zinc.
You are provided with powdered samples of the metals and common laboratory apparatus.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(c)(i) filtration 1
1(d) heat / boil / evaporate 1
to crystallising point 1
cool / leave to stand 1
2(a) average temperatures completed for all five experiments: 18, 31, 41, 53, 63 1
times completed for all five experiments: 210, 111, 84, 66, 54 1
unit (s) 1
shown clearly 1
2(e)(i) Experiment 5 1
depth greater 1
3(a)(i) red-brown 1
precipitate 1
turns blue 1
3(d) ammonia 1
3(e) lithium 1
carbonate 1
max [6]:
M1 fixed volume of acid
M2 to fixed mass of metal
M3 measure volume of gas / temperature change
M4 named apparatus for the measurement
M5 after time
M6 repeat with other metals
M7 compare / conclude
displacement method
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*9563332168*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_11/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 2 3
A B C D
3 The melting points and boiling points of pure substances W, X and Y are shown.
W X Y
W X Y
What is Q?
A ammonia, NH3
B chlorine, Cl 2
C methane, CH4
D water, H2O
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
8 The equation for the reaction between magnesium and dilute sulfuric acid is shown.
Mg + H2SO4 → MgSO4 + H2
Which mass of magnesium sulfate is formed when 12 g of magnesium completely reacts with
dilute sulfuric acid?
A 5g B 10 g C 60 g D 120 g
9 What is observed at each electrode when molten lead(II) bromide is electrolysed using platinum
electrodes?
A argon
B hydrogen
C nitrogen
D oxygen
A A gas is produced.
B Energy is released.
C Heat is absorbed.
D The mass of the fuel decreases.
hydrogen
excess dilute
magnesium hydrochloric acid at 25 °C
Increasing the concentration of the acid and increasing the temperature both affect the rate of
reaction.
A The copper(II) sulfate turns blue and the solution formed gets colder.
B The copper(II) sulfate turns blue and the solution formed gets hotter.
C The copper(II) sulfate turns white and the solution formed gets colder.
D The copper(II) sulfate turns white and the solution formed gets hotter.
A C + O2 → CO2
D N2O4 → 2NO2
A gas, G, is produced which is denser than air and extinguishes a burning splint.
solid F gas G
A calcium hydrogen
B calcium carbonate carbon dioxide
C calcium hydroxide hydrogen
D calcium oxide carbon dioxide
17 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
test X Y
a few drops of aqueous green precipitate red-brown
sodium hydroxide are added formed precipitate formed
a few drops of dilute nitric acid and no change seen white precipitate
a few drops of barium nitrate are added formed
a few drops of dilute nitric acid and white precipitate no change seen
a few drops of silver nitrate are added formed
X Y
A germanium
B scandium
C sodium
D strontium
21 Which row shows the catalytic activity of transition elements and their compounds?
A good good
B good poor
C poor good
D poor poor
23 The following statements are made about the metals copper, iron, magnesium and zinc.
The oxides of the same three metals were also heated strongly with carbon.
25 In a blast furnace, iron ore is mixed with coke and limestone, and heated in hot air.
A C + O2 → CO2
B CO2 + C → 2CO
27 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
28 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
30 Farmers use fertilisers to replace minerals in the soil that have been removed by the crops they
grow.
A Ca, P, O B K, O, S C N, K, P D N, O, S
B Sulfur dioxide turns acidified aqueous potassium manganate(VII) from purple to colourless.
A electrolysis
B fractional distillation
C incomplete combustion
D thermal decomposition
untreated treated
waste waste
lime
A acidic → neutral
B alkaline → acidic
C alkaline → neutral
D neutral → acidic
ethane
ethanoic acid
ethanol
ethene
F F F F F F
F C F F C C F F C C C F
F F F F F F
40 Polymers are long-chain molecules made from small molecules linked together.
1 carbohydrates
2 nylon
3 proteins
4 Terylene
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/11/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 B 1
2 A 1
3 B 1
4 D 1
5 B 1
6 A 1
7 C 1
8 C 1
9 C 1
10 B 1
11 B 1
12 D 1
13 B 1
14 A 1
15 B 1
16 C 1
17 C 1
18 A 1
19 C 1
20 B 1
21 A 1
22 A 1
23 C 1
24 D 1
25 B 1
26 B 1
27 B 1
28 C 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 D 1
32 C 1
33 D 1
34 A 1
35 A 1
36 B 1
37 C 1
38 C 1
39 A 1
40 D 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*1264661612*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 A student investigated the diffusion of ammonia gas, NH3, and hydrogen chloride gas, HCl.
Two sets of apparatus were set up as shown at room temperature and pressure.
apparatus 1 apparatus 2
The damp red litmus paper in apparatus 1 changed colour after 30 seconds.
How long does it take for the damp blue litmus paper to change colour in apparatus 2?
A 64 seconds
B 30 seconds
C 21 seconds
D The blue litmus paper would not change colour.
solvent front
baseline
A B C D
dyes
A B C D
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
Which statement explains why the two isotopes are of the same element?
A diamond
B graphite
C silicon(IV) oxide
D sulfur
1 Copper is malleable because layers of ions are in fixed positions and cannot move.
2 The structure of copper consists of negative ions in a lattice.
3 Copper conducts electricity because electrons can move through the metal.
4 Electrons hold copper ions together in a lattice by electrostatic attraction.
Which volume of carbon dioxide, at room temperature and pressure, is formed when 0.5 moles of
ethane burn?
What are the ionic half-equations for the reactions that take place at each electrode?
Which row describes and explains the energy change that occurs?
type of
explanation
energy change
A endothermic less energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
B endothermic more energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
C exothermic less energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
D exothermic more energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
13 Hydrogen bromide decomposes to form hydrogen and bromine. The equation is shown.
The bond energies are shown in the table. The reaction is endothermic.
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
Br–Br +193
H–Br +366
H–H +436
14 Which row describes the effects of increasing both concentration and temperature on the
collisions between reacting particles?
C more collisions per second only more collisions per second and more
collisions with sufficient energy to react
D more collisions per second and more more collisions per second and more
collisions with sufficient energy to react collisions with sufficient energy to react
pressure temperature
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
Cl 2 + 2I– → I2 + 2Cl –
A chloride ions
B chlorine
C iodide ions
D iodine
19 A student mixes silver nitrate and barium chloride to form a white precipitate of silver chloride.
soluble insoluble
A silver nitrate barium chloride, barium nitrate
and silver chloride
B silver nitrate and barium chloride barium nitrate and silver chloride
C silver nitrate, barium chloride silver chloride
and barium nitrate
D silver nitrate, barium chloride barium nitrate
and silver chloride
20 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
A germanium
B scandium
C sodium
D strontium
23 Which row shows the catalytic activity of transition elements and their compounds?
A good good
B good poor
C poor good
D poor poor
24 The following statements are made about the metals copper, iron, magnesium and zinc.
28 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
29 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
Which row describes the sources of hydrogen and nitrogen and the conditions used in the
manufacture of ammonia in the Haber process?
B Sulfur dioxide turns acidified aqueous potassium manganate(VII) from purple to colourless.
A electrolysis
B fractional distillation
C incomplete combustion
D thermal decomposition
A bromination
B hydration
C hydrogenation
D hydrolysis
A CH3CH2COOCH3
B CH3COOCH2CH2CH3
C CH3CH2CH2COOCH3
D HCOOCH2CH2CH3
B monomers have a C=C double bond the monomers react to form the
and the polymer is the only product polymer and a small molecule
C the monomers react to form the monomers have a C=C double bond
polymer and a small molecule and the polymer is the only product
D the monomers react to form the the monomers react to form the
polymer and a small molecule polymer and a small molecule
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/21/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 A 1
2 D 1
3 A 1
4 C 1
5 B 1
6 D 1
7 D 1
8 B 1
9 B 1
10 D 1
11 C 1
12 A 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 B 1
16 B 1
17 C 1
18 D 1
19 C 1
20 C 1
21 C 1
22 B 1
23 A 1
24 C 1
25 C 1
26 D 1
27 B 1
28 B 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 D 1
32 A 1
33 C 1
34 D 1
35 A 1
36 D 1
37 C 1
38 A 1
39 A 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_31/2RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
ammonia
argon
carbon dioxide
helium
hydrogen
methane
neon
sulfur dioxide
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iv) is a product of the reaction of copper(II) carbonate with hydrochloric acid
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) is a monatomic gas which has atoms with the electronic structure 2,8,8.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) (i) Explain why helium and not hydrogen is used to fill party balloons.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Complete the dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of
ammonia. Show outer shell electrons only.
H N H
[2]
[Total: 10]
2 The table shows the percentage by volume of each of the gases present in the exhaust gases from
a petrol engine.
(a) (i) Calculate the percentage by volume of carbon dioxide in the exhaust gases.
..............................% [1]
(ii) Which gas shown in the table is present in the lowest percentage by volume?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Which two elements in the table combine to form nitrogen dioxide?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) Where does the nitrogen in the exhaust gases come from?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b)
The carbon monoxide in the exhaust gases comes from the incomplete combustion of
hydrocarbons.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Balance the chemical equation for the complete combustion of pentane.
[Total: 10]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(b) An enzyme present in peppermint plants is a catalyst for the oxidation of limonene.
(i) catalyst
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) oxidation
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
H
H
H CH3
C C
H 3C C C C OH
C C H CH3
H H
H H
(i) What feature of the structure of the α-terpineol molecule shows that it is an unsaturated
compound?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe how the colour of aqueous bromine changes when an excess of α-terpineol is
added to it.
[Total: 10]
(a) The table shows how easy it is to reduce four metal oxides by heating with carbon.
Use this information to put the metals in order of their reactivity. Put the least reactive metal
first.
[2]
(b) Iron is a transition element. Potassium is an element in Group I of the Periodic Table.
Describe three ways in which the properties of iron differ from those of potassium.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[3]
(d) Pure iron can be made by reducing iron(III) oxide, Fe2O3, with hydrogen.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) When iron reacts with dilute hydrochloric acid, iron(II) chloride is formed.
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
Cl Cl Cl
Fe Fe
Cl Cl Cl
Deduce the molecular formula of this compound showing the number of iron and chlorine
atoms.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(f) Some iron nails were placed in bottles under different conditions.
A B C D
moist boiled
air water
water
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
5 (a) Complete the sentence about electrolysis using words from the list.
(b) Molten zinc iodide can be electrolysed using the apparatus shown.
+ –
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) When chlorine is bubbled through a colourless aqueous solution of zinc iodide, the solution
turns brown.
Name the brown substance. Suggest, using ideas about reactivity of the halogens, why this
reaction occurs.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 11]
9F
19
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
(b) Complete the sentence about isotopes using words from the list.
Isotopes are atoms of the same .............................. which have the same
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[1]
[Total: 10]
(a) The properties of some Group I elements are shown in the table.
(ii) Describe the trend in the boiling points of the Group I elements.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Use the information in the table to predict what you would observe when rubidium reacts
with cold water.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) Which one of the statements about the formation of a sodium ion from a sodium atom is
correct?
Tick one box.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Complete the word equation for the reaction of sodium hydroxide with sulfuric acid.
[2]
[Total: 10]
80
60
volume of
hydrogen 40
gas / cm3
20
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
time / min
(a) Explain why the volume of hydrogen gas remains constant after six minutes.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) What volume of hydrogen gas was released in the first two minutes of the reaction?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) The experiment is repeated using the same volume of 0.1 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid.
All other conditions are kept the same.
On the grid, draw the graph for the experiment using 0.1 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid.
[2]
(d) Give the name of the salt formed when zinc reacts with hydrochloric acid.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Which one of the following pH values could be the pH of dilute hydrochloric acid?
Draw a circle around the correct answer.
pH 1 pH 7 pH 9 pH 13 [1]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) ammonia / NH3 1
1(a)(iii) methane / CH4 1
1(a)(v) argon / Ar 1
1(c) (substance containing) two (or more) types of atom bonded / two (or more) types of atom joined / two (or more) types of 1
atoms chemically combined
2(a)(i) 15.5(%) 1
2(a)(ii) hydrogen / H2 1
2(a)(iv) NO2 1
2(b)(i) compound of carbon and hydrogen only / compound of hydrogen and carbon with no other elements 2
2(b)(ii) poisonous / toxic 1
2(b)(iii) 5 (CO2) 1
6 (H2O) 1
• diffusion
• (bulk) movement of particles from higher to lower concentration / movement of particles down concentration gradient
3(a)(ii) solid 1
– 80 ºC is below the melting point / it is below the melting point / it has not yet reached its melting point / melts above – 80 ºC 1
3(b)(i) (substance which) speeds up a reaction / substance which increases the rate of reaction 1
3(c)(ii) orange / red-brown / brown 1
to colourless 1
4(a) nickel<iron<chromium<magnesium 2
• iron compounds have variable oxidation states / form ions with different charges / ORA for K
• one suitable difference in chemical properties e.g. iron is less reactive than potassium ORA / potassium reacts with
cold water / iron does not react with cold water / iron rusts / potassium does not rust
4(c) 3 (Fe) 1
2 (O2) 1
4(d) it loses oxygen / oxygen is removed from the iron oxide / hydrogen gains the oxygen from the iron oxide 1
4(e)(ii) Fe2Cl 6 1
5(a) breakdown 1
compound 1
molten 1
electricity 1
5(e) iodine 1
• electrons outside the nucleus / electrons surrounding the nucleus / electrons orbiting the nucleus
• 9 protons
• 9 electrons
• 10 neutrons
6(b) element 1
atomic 1
nucleons 1
6(c) any suitable e.g. treating cancer / checking thyroid function / tracer (in the body) 1
6(d) 235 1
U
92
7(a)(i) atomic radius of Rb: any value between 228 and 264 (inclusive of these values) 1
relative thermal conductivity of K: any value between 3.8 and 1.7 (inclusive of these values) 1
7(a)(ii) decreases down (the Group) / increases up (the Group) / decreases from sodium to caesium ORA 1
7(d) 76 2
water 1
8(c) line starts from 0 cm3 AND initial gradient less steep 1
8(e) pH 1 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_41/5RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
Give the order and the correct scientific term for the physical processes used to separate the
common salt from the mixture.
1 .................................................................................................................................................
2 .................................................................................................................................................
3 .................................................................................................................................................
[4]
alcohol A B C D
boiling point / °C 56 78 122 160
(c) A
student suggested that the apparatus shown could be used to separate the mixture of
alcohols.
fractionating column X
mixture of
hot water alcohols
A, B, C and D
electric heater
● Draw an arrow on the diagram to show where the cold water enters apparatus X.
● Name apparatus X.
. ............................................................................................................................................
[2]
(ii) Part of the fractionating column is missing. This means that the experiment will not work.
● Draw on the diagram the part of the fractionating column which is missing.
● xplain why the experiment will not work with this part of the fractionating column
E
missing.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) Suggest why a Bunsen burner is not used to heat the flask.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Explain why.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
2 Flerovium, Fl, atomic number 114, was first made in research laboratories in 1998.
(a) F
lerovium was made by bombarding atoms of plutonium, Pu, atomic number 94, with atoms of
element Z.
●● The nucleus of one atom of plutonium combined with the nucleus of one atom of element Z.
●● his formed the nucleus of one atom of flerovium.
T
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) T
wo isotopes of flerovium are 286Fl and 289Fl. The nuclei of both of these isotopes are unstable
and emit energy when they split up.
(i) State the term used to describe isotopes with unstable nuclei.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) C
omplete the table to show the number of protons, neutrons and electrons in the atoms of
the isotopes shown.
289
Fl
[2]
(e) O
nly a relatively small number of atoms of flerovium have been made in the laboratory and the
properties of flerovium have not yet been investigated.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
(a) T
hree of the raw materials added to a blast furnace used to extract iron from hematite are
coke, hematite and limestone.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) A series of reactions occurs in a blast furnace during the extraction of iron from hematite.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
(c) The iron extracted from hematite using a blast furnace is impure.
Identify the main impurity in this iron and explain how it is removed in the steel‑making process.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 9]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
xplain why the term relative molecular mass can be used for butane but cannot be used for
E
potassium fluoride.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) A 0.095 g sample of gaseous element Y occupies 60.0 cm3 at room temperature and pressure.
●● Calculate the relative molecular mass of element Y and hence suggest the identity of
element Y.
(d) A 1.68 g sample of phosphorus was burned and formed 3.87 g of an oxide of phosphorus.
[Total: 12]
5 (a) T
he table gives some chemical properties of transition elements and their compounds, and of
Group I elements and their compounds.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Give one other chemical property shown by transition elements which is not shown by
Group I elements.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Give two physical properties shown by transition elements which are not shown by Group I
elements.
1 .................................................................................................................................................
2 .................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) T
he energy level diagram shows the energy profile for the reaction between zinc and dilute
sulfuric acid.
progress of reaction
(i) Complete the diagram by adding the formulae of the products. Include state symbols. [3]
(ii) Draw an arrow on the diagram to represent the activation energy. [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) T
he reaction between zinc and dilute sulfuric acid can be catalysed by the addition of aqueous
copper(II) sulfate.
On the diagram, add the energy profile for the catalysed reaction.
progress of reaction
[1]
power supply
+ –
carbon electrodes
aqueous
copper(II) sulfate
(i) W
rite an ionic half‑equation for the reaction at the negative electrode (cathode). Include
state symbols.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Give two other observations which the student makes during the electrolysis.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iv) W
hat difference would the student observe at the positive electrode if the aqueous
copper(II) sulfate were replaced by concentrated aqueous copper(II) chloride?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 18]
P Q R S
CH3–CH3 CH2=CH2 CH2=CH–CH3 CH2=CH–CH2–CH3
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Draw the structure of this compound. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
(e) D
raw the structure of an unbranched isomer of compound S. Show all of the atoms and all of
the bonds. Name this unbranched isomer of compound S.
structure
name ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
n CH2=CH2
[2]
(g) A
mino acids undergo polymerisation to form proteins. Part of a protein molecule with the
linkages missing is shown.
Draw the linkages on the diagram. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
H O
N C
[2]
O CH2 CH3
Write the word equation for a reaction which could be used to make this ester.
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 19]
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
12
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
chemically combined 1
1(b) dissolving 1
filtration 1
evaporation / crystallisation 1
1(c)(i) condenser 1
2(a) calcium / Ca 1
2(b) 7 1
2(c) 4 1
2(d)(i) radioisotopes 1
286
2(d)(ii) Fl 114p 172n 114e 1
289
Fl 114p 175n 114e 1
KF is ionic 1
fluorine 1
ratio of P to O 1
P = 0.054 / 0.054 O = 0.13 / 0.054
=1 = 2.5
mass = 220 (g) 1
without being used up (at the end) / remains unchanged or unaffected or without changing mass 1
5(c)(i) ZnSO4 1
5(c)(ii) (labelled) arrow pointing upwards starting level with reactants and finishing level with top of the hump. 1
1 mark for any equation which has Cu as the product or Cu2+ ions on left
1 mark for correct species
1 mark for correct state symbols
only 1
but-2-ene 1
6(f)(i) poly(ethene) 1
both amide links shown in the correct orientation for three amino acids 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
INSERT
1 hour 15 minutes
*8393780945-I*
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
IB18 06_0620_51/RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
BLANK PAGE
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
BLANK PAGE
1 You are going to investigate the rate of reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and aqueous
sodium thiosulfate. When these chemicals react they form a precipitate which makes the solution
go cloudy. The formation of this precipitate can be used to show how fast the reaction proceeds.
Instructions
You are going to do five experiments using the apparatus shown.
eye
printed insert
printed words
Experiment 1
● se the large measuring cylinder to pour 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into the conical
U
flask. Place the conical flask on the printed insert.
● Fill the small measuring cylinder with 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
● Add the dilute hydrochloric acid to the solution in the conical flask. Start the timer immediately
and swirl the mixture.
● View the conical flask from above and measure the time taken for the printed words to disappear
from view. Record the time taken in the table on page 4.
● Immediately pour the contents of the conical flask into the quenching bath and rinse the conical
flask with distilled water.
Experiment 2
● se the large measuring cylinder to pour 40 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into the conical
U
flask, followed by 10 cm3 of distilled water. Place the conical flask on the printed insert.
● Fill the small measuring cylinder with 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
● Add the dilute hydrochloric acid to the solution in the conical flask. Start the timer immediately
and swirl the mixture.
● View the conical flask from above and measure the time taken for the printed words to disappear
from view. Record the time taken in the table on page 4.
● Immediately pour the contents of the conical flask into the quenching bath and rinse the conical
flask with distilled water.
Experiment 3
● epeat Experiment 2 but use 35 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate, 15 cm3 of distilled water
R
and 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Experiment 4
Experiment 5
[3]
(b) Plot your results from Experiments 1–5 on the grid. Draw a smooth line graph.
350
300
250
200
time taken for the
printed words to
disappear from view / s
150
100
50
0
0 10 20 30 40 50
volume of aqueous sodium thiosulfate / cm 3
[3]
(c) Describe the appearance of the mixture in the conical flask at the end of each experiment.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) (i)
From your graph, deduce the time taken for the printed words to disappear from view
if Experiment 2 were repeated using 20 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 30 cm3 of
distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. s [2]
(ii) The rate of reaction can be calculated using the equation shown.
1
rate of reaction =
time taken
Calculate the rate of reaction using your answer from (d)(i).
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(e) (i) In which experiment, 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, was the rate of reaction greatest?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Explain, in terms of particles, why the rate of reaction was greatest in this experiment.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(f) Give the name of a more accurate piece of apparatus for measuring volumes than a measuring
cylinder.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) S
uggest the effect on the results of using a 100 cm3 conical flask instead of a 250 cm3
conical flask. Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(h) S
ketch on the grid the graph you would expect if all of the experiments were repeated at a
lower temperature. Clearly label your graph. [1]
[Total: 17]
tests on solution A
Divide solution A into four approximately equal portions in three test-tubes and one boiling tube.
pH = .............................. [1]
(b) A
dd a strip of magnesium ribbon to the second portion of solution A in a test‑tube. Shake the
mixture.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
tests on solid B
(d) U
se a spatula to place approximately half of solid B into a hard glass test-tube. Heat solid B
gently then strongly. Leave the hard glass test-tube to stand for approximately 1 minute.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Add the rest of solid B to the fourth portion of solution A in a test-tube. Test the gas produced.
Record your observations.
test ..............................................................................................................................................
result ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
Keep the solution from the test in (e) for the test in (f).
dd an approximately equal volume of distilled water to the solution from the test in (e). Shake the
A
solution and divide it into three approximately equal portions in two test-tubes and one boiling tube.
(f) (i) A
dd a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the first portion of the solution in a
test‑tube.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(g) (i) Add a few drops of aqueous ammonia to the second portion of the solution in a test‑tube.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii)
Now add an excess of aqueous ammonia to the mixture.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(h) A
dd a small piece of aluminium foil and about 2 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the third
portion of the solution in a boiling tube. Gently warm the mixture. Test the gas produced with
indicator paper.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 17]
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced
gently and test for the presence of will turn acidified aqueous
sulfur dioxide potassium manganate(VII) from
purple to colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
comparable to supervisor’s 1
indication 1
1(e)(i) experiment 1 1
1(f) pipette / burette 1
2(a) pH 1–3 1
white on standing 1
2(e) limewater 1
milky / cloudy / white ppt. 1
2(f)(ii) clears / dissolves / colourless / soluble 1
2(g)(ii) clears / dissolves / colourless / soluble 1
2(h) bubbles / fizz / effervescence 1
2(i) nitric 1
acid 1
2(j) zinc 1
carbonate 1
evaporation
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C / heat to >40 °C
• add KCl until no more dissolves / add excess KCl
• stir
• filter mixture (if heated to >40 °C then need to cool and filter)
• evaporate filtrate to dryness
• weigh solid
mass undissolved
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C
• stir
• filter
• weigh residue (do not award if residue washed)
• add weighed (excess) KCl to water – only awarded if mass of residue measured
• mass KCl dissolved = initial mass – final mass
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2018
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 The volume of dilute nitric acid that reacts with 25.0 cm3 of aqueous potassium hydroxide can be
found by titration using the apparatus shown.
...........................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
A student did the titration four times and recorded the following results.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Use the other results to calculate the average volume of dilute nitric acid that reacted with
the aqueous potassium hydroxide.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(d) The equation for the reaction taking place in the titration is shown.
The student concluded that the aqueous potassium hydroxide was more concentrated than the
dilute nitric acid.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
2
A student investigated the rate of reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and aqueous
sodium thiosulfate. When these chemicals react they form a precipitate which makes the solution
go cloudy. The formation of this precipitate can be used to show how fast the reaction proceeds.
eye
Experiment 1
● large measuring cylinder was used to pour 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into a
A
250 cm3 conical flask. The conical flask was placed on a printed sheet of paper.
● 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid was added to the solution in the conical flask. A timer was
started immediately and the mixture was swirled.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
Experiment 2
● he large measuring cylinder was used to pour 40 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into a
T
conical flask, followed by 10 cm3 of distilled water. The conical flask was placed on the printed
sheet of paper.
● 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid was added to the solution in the conical flask. The timer was
started immediately and the mixture was swirled.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
Experiment 3
● xperiment 2 was repeated but using 35 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 15 cm3 of
E
distilled water.
Experiment 4
● xperiment 2 was repeated but using 30 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 20 cm3 of
E
distilled water.
Experiment 5
● xperiment 2 was repeated but using 10 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 40 cm3 of
E
distilled water.
(a) Record the volumes of distilled water used in the table. Use the stop-clock diagrams to record
the results in the table.
1 50 45 15 5 15
10
minutes
30
0
0
2 40 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
3 35 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
4 30 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
5 10 45 15 5 15
10
30
[3]
(b) Plot the results from Experiments 1–5 on the grid. Draw a smooth line graph.
240
210
180
150
time taken for
the printed words
to disappear
from view / s 120
90
60
30
0
0 10 20 30 40 50
volume of aqueous sodium thiosulfate / cm3
[3]
(c) (i)
From your graph, deduce the time taken for the printed words to disappear from view
if Experiment 2 were repeated using 20 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 30 cm3 of
distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. s [2]
(ii) The rate of reaction can be calculated using the equation shown.
1
rate of reaction =
time taken
Calculate the rate of reaction using your answer from (c)(i).
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) (i) In which experiment, 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, was the rate of reaction greatest?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Explain, in terms of particles, why the rate of reaction was greatest in this experiment.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(e) Give the name of a more accurate piece of apparatus for measuring volumes than a measuring
cylinder.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Suggest the effect on the results of using a 100 cm3 conical flask instead of a 250 cm3 conical
flask. Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) Sketch on the grid the graph you would expect if all of the experiments were repeated at a
lower temperature. Clearly label your graph. [1]
[Total: 16]
tests on solution A
test 1
test 2
The gas produced was tested. gas ‘popped’ with a lighted splint
test 3
Dilute nitric acid and aqueous barium nitrate white precipitate formed
were added to the third portion of solution A.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on solid B
(c) Dilute nitric acid was added to solid B. The gas produced was tested.
observations ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
The zinc nitrate solution formed in the test in (c) was divided into two portions in two test‑tubes.
(d) (i) D
rops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the first portion of the zinc nitrate
solution.
(ii)
An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was then added to the mixture.
(e) (i)
Drops of aqueous ammonia were added to the second portion of the zinc nitrate solution.
(ii) An excess of aqueous ammonia was then added to the mixture.
[Total: 10]
You are provided with potassium chloride and common laboratory apparatus.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a) burette 1
1(c)(iii) 18.2 1
cm3 1
2(d)(i) experiment 1 1
3(a) hydrogen / H2 1
3(b) sulfuric 1
acid 1
3(c) limewater 1
milky / cloudy / white ppt. 1
3(d)(i) white 1
precipitate 1
evaporation
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C / heat to >40 °C
• add KCl until no more dissolves / add excess KCl
• stir
• filter mixture (if heated to >40 °C then need to cool and filter)
• evaporate filtrate to dryness
• weigh solid
mass undissolved
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C
• stir
• filter
• weigh residue (do not award if residue washed)
• add weighed (excess) KCl to water – only awarded if mass of residue measured
• mass KCl dissolved = initial mass – final mass
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2019
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*7680430453*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 06_0620_11/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
How are the particles arranged and how do the particles move in sodium chloride at 900 °C?
Which apparatus is used to measure the calcium carbonate and the hydrochloric acid?
A balance burette
B balance thermometer
C pipette burette
D pipette thermometer
1 filter paper
2 fractionating column
3 hexane
4 water
A B C D
baseline
19
5 Which statement about an atom of fluorine, 9 F, is correct?
Which row shows the energy change and temperature change of the mixture during the
dissolving of ammonium chloride?
A burning wood
B cooking an egg
C melting an ice cube
D rusting iron
13 Hydrogen peroxide solution decomposes very slowly at room temperature to produce oxygen
gas. This gas forms a rising foam when liquid detergent is added.
Five test-tubes are half filled with hydrogen peroxide solution. A drop of liquid detergent is added
to each one.
Different metal oxides are added to four of the test-tubes and the height of the foam formed after
1 minute is measured. The results are shown.
height of
metal oxide
foam / cm
C Manganese(IV) oxide is the best catalyst of the four metal oxides tested.
D Only transition element oxides increase the rate of this reaction.
14 When blue-green crystals of nickel(II) sulfate are heated, water is produced and a yellow solid
remains. When water is added to the yellow solid, the blue-green colour returns.
A combustion
B corrosion
C neutralisation
D reversible reaction
15 In a blast furnace, iron is extracted when iron(III) oxide reacts with carbon monoxide.
oxidised reduced
A CO Fe2O3
B CO2 Fe
C Fe CO2
D Fe2O3 CO
16 Four different solutions are separately tested with blue litmus and with methyl orange. Each
solution is known to be either acidic or alkaline. The results are shown.
1 red red
2 red yellow
3 blue yellow
4 blue yellow
Y
X Z
18 How could crystals of a pure salt be prepared from dilute sulfuric acid?
A add an excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide, filter, evaporate the filtrate to crystallisation
point
C add an excess of copper metal, filter, evaporate the filtrate to crystallisation point
D add an excess of zinc oxide, filter, evaporate the filtrate to crystallisation point
test observation
add ammonia solution green precipitate formed
add dilute nitric acid followed white precipitate formed
by aqueous barium nitrate
What is Q?
A iron(II) chloride
B iron(II) sulfate
C iron(III) chloride
D iron(III) sulfate
A B
C
D
21 Which statement about elements in Group I and Group VII of the Periodic Table is correct?
A high low no
B high high yes
C low low no
D low low yes
23 Which statement about elements in Group VIII of the Periodic Table is correct?
24 The diagrams show the structure of two substances used to make electrical conductors.
X Y
P yes no
Q no no
R yes yes
most least
reactive reactive
A P Q R
B Q R P
C R Q P
D R P Q
Hematite, coke, limestone and hot air are added to the furnace.
A It conducts electricity.
B It has a high melting point.
C It is resistant to corrosion.
D It is strong.
30 The diagram shows an experiment to investigate how paint affects the rusting of iron.
P Q
iron painted iron
air
water
tube P tube Q
A falls rises
B no change rises
C rises falls
D rises no change
damp red
litmus paper
R and S
gentle heat
R S
33 The diagram represents a lime kiln used to heat limestone to a very high temperature.
waste gases
lime kiln
limestone
fuel in fuel in
air in air in
A calcium carbonate
B calcium hydroxide
C calcium oxide
D calcium sulfate
A B C D
H H H H H O H H
C C H C C H H C C H C C OH
H H H H H OH H H
Is it obtained
from petroleum?
yes no
Is it used as Is it used as
fuel for cars? fuel for cars?
yes no yes no
A B C D
name of W structure of W
H H
A ethane H C C H
H H
H H
B ethane C C
H H
H H
C ethene H C C H
H H
H H
D ethene C C
H H
37 Why is ethanol a member of the homologous series of alcohols but propane is not?
A Ethanol has two carbon atoms per molecule but propane has three.
B Ethanol can be made from ethene but propane is obtained from petroleum.
C Ethanol is a liquid but propane is a gas.
D Ethanol contains the same functional group as other alcohols but propane does not.
1 complex carbohydrates
2 nylon
3 salts
4 proteins
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/11/M/J/19
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 A 1
3 B 1
4 D 1
5 B 1
6 D 1
7 A 1
8 C 1
9 C 1
10 C 1
11 A 1
12 C 1
13 C 1
14 D 1
15 A 1
16 C 1
17 A 1
18 D 1
19 B 1
20 D 1
21 C 1
22 B 1
23 A 1
24 B 1
25 D 1
26 D 1
27 C 1
28 B 1
29 A 1
30 D 1
31 A 1
32 D 1
33 C 1
34 D 1
35 A 1
36 D 1
37 D 1
38 C 1
39 C 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2019
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*7311411163*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 06_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
1 Which statement explains why ammonia gas, NH3, diffuses at a faster rate than
hydrogen chloride gas, HCl ?
Which apparatus is used to measure the calcium carbonate and the hydrochloric acid?
A balance burette
B balance thermometer
C pipette burette
D pipette thermometer
3 The measurements from a chromatography experiment using substance F are shown. The
diagram is not drawn to scale.
solvent front
distance moved by F
100 mm
90 mm
55 mm
15 mm
baseline
19
4 Which statement about an atom of fluorine, 9 F, is correct?
x y
A 5 4
B 7 4
C 10 8
D 13 8
What is the concentration of ascorbic acid when one tablet is dissolved in 200 cm3 of water?
9 Which statement about the electrolysis of copper(II) sulfate solution using carbon electrodes is
correct?
Which ionic half-equation describes a reaction that occurs at the named electrode?
N2 + 3H2 → 2NH3
The reaction is exothermic. The bond energies are shown in the table.
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
N≡N 945
H–H 436
N–H 390
A –1473 kJ / mol
B –87 kJ / mol
C 87 kJ / mol
D 1473 kJ / mol
13 Which change in reaction conditions increases both the collision rate and the proportion of
molecules with sufficient energy to react?
A addition of a catalyst
B increasing the concentration of a reactant
C increasing the surface area of a reactant
D increasing the temperature of the reaction
14 When blue-green crystals of nickel(II) sulfate are heated, water is produced and a yellow solid
remains. When water is added to the yellow solid, the blue-green colour returns.
A combustion
B corrosion
C neutralisation
D reversible reaction
15 The graph shows how the yield of product in a reversible reaction changes as the temperature
and pressure are changed.
reactants products
yield of
product 300 °C
100 °C
pressure
A reactant exothermic
B reactant endothermic
C product endothermic
D product exothermic
1 2I– → I2 + 2e–
2 Cr(VI) → Cr(III)
3 Fe(II) → Fe(III)
17 Nitrogen(I) oxide, N2O, nitrogen(II) oxide, NO, and carbon monoxide, CO, are all non-metal
oxides.
Y
X Z
A B
C
D
21 Which statement about elements in Group I and Group VII of the Periodic Table is correct?
22 Which statement about elements in Group VIII of the Periodic Table is correct?
23 The diagrams show the structure of two substances used to make electrical conductors.
X Y
P Q R
25 Zinc is extracted from its ore, zinc blende, using two chemical reactions.
reaction 1 reaction 2
A O2 C
B O2 ZnO
C ZnS C
D ZnS ZnO
26 Four metals, zinc, M, copper and magnesium, are reacted with aqueous solutions of their
nitrates.
magnesium key
zinc = reacts
M = no reaction
copper
What is the order of reactivity of these four metals starting with the most reactive?
A It conducts electricity.
B It has a high melting point.
C It is resistant to corrosion.
D It is strong.
29 Oxides of nitrogen are formed in car engines and are a source of air pollution.
A combustion
B cracking
C oxidation
D reduction
30 The diagram shows an experiment to investigate how paint affects the rusting of iron.
P Q
iron painted iron
air
water
tube P tube Q
A falls rises
B no change rises
C rises falls
D rises no change
pressure temperature
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
atmospheric
carbon dioxide
X
respiration
decomposition Y
Z green plants
dead
organic matter
animals
X Y Z
temperature pressure
catalyst
/ °C / atm
A 25 2 iron
B 25 200 iron
C 450 2 vanadium(V) oxide
D 450 200 vanadium(V) oxide
34 The diagram represents a lime kiln used to heat limestone to a very high temperature.
waste gases
lime kiln
limestone
fuel in fuel in
air in air in
A calcium carbonate
B calcium hydroxide
C calcium oxide
D calcium sulfate
Is it obtained
from petroleum?
yes no
Is it used as Is it used as
fuel for cars? fuel for cars?
yes no yes no
A B C D
36 Why is ethanol a member of the homologous series of alcohols but propane is not?
A Ethanol has two carbon atoms per molecule but propane has three.
B Ethanol can be made from ethene but propane is obtained from petroleum.
C Ethanol is a liquid but propane is a gas.
D Ethanol contains the same functional group as other alcohols but propane does not.
CH3 C
OCH2CH2CH3
A ethyl propanoate
B methyl propanoate
C propyl ethanoate
D propyl methanoate
O O O O
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/21/M/J/19
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 B 1
2 A 1
3 B 1
4 B 1
5 A 1
6 A 1
7 A 1
8 D 1
9 A 1
10 D 1
11 C 1
12 B 1
13 D 1
14 D 1
15 B 1
16 B 1
17 D 1
18 A 1
19 A 1
20 D 1
21 C 1
22 A 1
23 B 1
24 C 1
25 B 1
26 D 1
27 C 1
28 B 1
29 D 1
30 D 1
31 B 1
32 C 1
33 C 1
34 C 1
35 A 1
36 D 1
37 C 1
38 C 1
39 C 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2019
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 06_0620_31/2RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
He Li+ Cl – Li+ Cl –
He
He Cl – Li+ Cl – Li+
He
He Li+ Cl – Li+ Cl –
He Cl – Li+ Cl – Li+
A B C
N
N
Cu Cu Cu Cu
N N
Cu Cu Cu Cu
N
Cu Cu Cu Cu
N
N N
N
N Cu Cu Cu Cu
D E
(a) A
nswer the following questions about these structures.
Each structure may be used once, more than once or not at all.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) In a blast furnace used for the extraction of iron, carbon reacts with oxygen from the air to form
carbon monoxide.
(c) In the hotter parts of the furnace, carbon reacts with the iron(III) oxide present in the iron ore.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) L
imestone is added to the blast furnace. The limestone is converted into calcium oxide and
carbon dioxide. The reaction is endothermic.
heat
CaCO3 CaO + CO2
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) W
hat type of oxide is calcium oxide?
Give a reason for your answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[3]
O
OC C CO
OC Fe Fe CO
C
OC O CO
C
O
educe the molecular formula of this compound to show the number of iron, carbon and
D
oxygen atoms.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 11]
3 (a) The table shows the percentage by mass of the elements on Earth and in the Universe.
.............................. % [1]
(ii) Which non-metallic element is present on Earth in the greatest percentage by mass?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) G
ive two major differences in the percentage by mass of the elements on Earth and in the
Universe.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[2]
(b) Complete the diagram to show the electron arrangement in an oxygen atom.
[1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 7]
(a) U
se the kinetic particle model to describe the separation between the molecules and the type
of motion of the molecules in:
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[4]
(b) T
he graph shows how the volume of iodine gas changes with pressure. The temperature is
kept constant.
volume of
iodine gas
0
0 pressure
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) (i) C
omplete the word equation to show the halogen and halide compound which react to
form the products iodine and potassium bromide.
(ii) E
xplain, in terms of the reactivity of the halogens, why aqueous iodine does not react with
aqueous potassium chloride.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
reactants
energy
products
progress of reaction
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
test ..............................................................................................................................................
observations ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 14]
carbon dioxide
carbon monoxide
ethene
hydrogen
methane
nitrogen
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Draw the structure of a molecule of ethene. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
(iii) D
escribe how aqueous bromine can be used to tell the difference between methane and
ethene.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Which one of the following words describes the ethene molecules in this reaction?
Draw a circle around the correct answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) Ethanol can be made from ethene and one other reactant.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 11]
escribe how you could prepare a pure sample of crystals of hydrated copper(II) sulfate using
(a) D
dilute sulfuric acid and an excess of copper(II) oxide.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) C omplete the table to calculate the relative formula mass of anhydrous copper(II) sulfate,
CuSO4.
Use your Periodic Table to help you.
number relative
type of atom
of atoms atomic mass
copper 1 64 1 × 64 = 64
sulfur
oxygen
(d) C
omplete the table to show the number of electrons, protons and neutrons in the sulfur atom
and copper ion shown.
16S
34
29Cu
63 2+
29
[4]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Suggest why an alloy of copper is used to make coins instead of using pure copper.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 13]
7 A student investigates the rate of reaction of small pieces of calcium carbonate with an excess of
hydrochloric acid of concentration 1 mol / dm3.
(a) Name the salt formed when calcium carbonate reacts with hydrochloric acid.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) The graph shows how the mass of the reaction mixture changes with time.
200.0
199.8
199.6
mass of
reaction
mixture
/g 199.4
199.2
199.0
198.8
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140
time / s
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Calculate the loss in mass during the first 40 seconds of the experiment.
.............................. g [1]
Draw a line on the grid for the experiment using hydrochloric acid of concentration
2 mol / dm3.[2]
(iv) In the experiment, when 2.00 g of calcium carbonate is used, the loss in mass of the
reaction mixture is 0.88 g.
All other conditions are kept the same.
(v) T he experiment is repeated using the same mass of different sized pieces of
calcium carbonate.
All other conditions are kept the same.
● powder
● small pieces
● large pieces.
Complete the table by writing the sizes of the pieces of calcium carbonate in the first
column.
0.005
0.030
0.100
[1]
[Total: 7]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) S
ulfur dioxide is oxidised to sulfur trioxide in the air.
Oxides of nitrogen act as catalysts for this reaction.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
pH 4 pH 7 pH 9 pH 13
[1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Excess sulfuric acid reacts with ammonia to make a salt which can be used as a fertiliser.
State the name of the salt formed when excess sulfuric acid reacts with ammonia.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The table shows some observations about the reactivity of four metals with dilute sulfuric acid.
se the information in the table to put the four metals in order of their reactivity.
U
Put the least reactive metal first.
[2]
[Total: 9]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
20
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/M/J/19
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
D / nitrogen / N2 (1)
1(a)(ii) D / nitrogen / N2 1
1(a)(v) B / diamond 1
1(a)(vi) E / copper / Cu 1
1(b) substance in which all the atoms have the same proton number / substance containing (only) one type of atom 1
2(a) hematite 1
O2 (1)
2(c) carbon gains oxygen (from Fe2O3) / oxygen (from Fe2O3) combines with carbon 1
2(f) Fe2C9O9 1
3(a)(i) 5.0% 1
3(a)(ii) oxygen 1
3(b) 2 electrons in inner shell AND 6 electrons in outer shell AND no additional shells of electrons 1
3(c)(i) has complete outer (electron) shell / has full outer (electron) shell / outer shell cannot gain or lose electron(s) 1
4(a) solid: 4
gas:
4(b) increasing the pressure decreases the volume / decreasing the pressure increases the volume / the higher the volume, the lower 1
the pressure
4(c)(ii) chlorine more reactive than iodine / iodine less reactive than chlorine 1
2 (NaI) (1)
4(d)(ii) the energy of the reactants is more than the energy of the products / the energy of the products is less than the energy of the 1
reactants / the reactants lose energy when they form products
4(f) iodine / I2 1
5(a)(i) methane 1
5(a)(ii) 1
5(b)(i) polymerisation / addition 1
5(b)(ii) monomers 1
5(b)(iii) cannot be decomposed by organisms / cannot be broken down by bacteria / cannot be broken down by fungi 1
catalyst (1)
6(b)(ii) heat / warm 1
protons in S = 16 (1)
6(e)(ii) (alloy) more resistant to wear / stronger / harder / more resistant to corrosion ORA for copper 1
7(b)(ii) 0.7 (g) 1
7(b)(iii) line steeper than original and starting from 0 and 200.0 g (1) 2
line ends up at same final mass AND levels off at or before 104 s (1)
7(b)(iv) 0.22 (g) 1
8(a)(ii) substance which speeds up a reaction / substance which increases the rate of reaction 1
8(a)(iii) pH4 1
8(a)(iv) erodes buildings (made of carbonate rocks) / wears away buildings (made of carbonate rocks) / reacts with mortar / corrodes iron 1
work / corrodes metal
–20 °C is between the melting and boiling point / –20 °C is above melting point but lower than boiling point (1)
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2019
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 06_0620_41/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
BLANK PAGE
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) (i) Complete the table to show the number of protons, neutrons and electrons present in
24
atoms of 12 Mg and 12
26
Mg.
12Mg
24
12Mg
26
[2]
24
(ii) What term is used to describe atoms of the same element, such as 12 Mg and 12
26
Mg?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
24
(iii) Explain why the chemical properties of 12 Mg and 12
26
Mg are the same.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(c) Complete the table to identify the atoms and ions which have the following numbers of protons,
neutrons and electrons.
11Na
23 +
11 12 10
4 5 4
17 20 18
[4]
(d) State the electronic structure of the following atom and ion.
Al ................................
S2– ...............................
[2]
[Total: 13]
2
Z is a covalent substance. In an experiment, a sample of pure solid Z was continually heated for
11 minutes.
The graph shows how the temperature of the sample of pure Z changed during the first 9 minutes.
240
220
200
180
160
140
temperature
/ °C 120
100
80
60
40
20
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
time / minutes
.............................. °C [1]
(b) The sample of pure Z began to boil at 9 minutes. It was boiled for 2 minutes.
Use this information to sketch on the grid how the temperature of the sample of pure Z changed
between 9 minutes and 11 minutes. [1]
(c) The sample of pure Z was continually heated between 2 minutes and 5 minutes.
Explain, in terms of attractive forces, why there was no increase in the temperature of the
sample of pure Z between 2 minutes and 5 minutes.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) Describe how the motion of particles of pure Z changed from 0 minutes to 2 minutes.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
Suggest the differences, if any, in the melting point and boiling point of the sample of impure Z
compared to the sample of pure Z.
(f) A sample of pure Z was allowed to cool from 120 °C to 20 °C. The total time taken was 8 minutes.
Starting from point ×, sketch on the grid how the temperature of the sample of pure Z changed
between 0 minutes and 8 minutes.
200
180
160
140
120
temperature
/ °C 100
80
60
40
20
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
time / minutes
[2]
[Total: 10]
3 Zinc and copper are elements next to each other in the Periodic Table.
step 1 .........................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
step 2 .........................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[5]
(b) Name the alloy formed when zinc is mixed with copper.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
State two other chemical properties of transition elements which make them different from
Group I elements.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) State the colour change that occurs when water is added to this compound of copper.
(e) Aqueous potassium iodide reacts with aqueous copper(II) sulfate to produce iodine.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) In terms of electron transfer, explain why copper is reduced in this reaction.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 16]
4
Ethanoic acid is a weak acid and hydrochloric acid is a strong acid.
Both ethanoic acid and hydrochloric acid dissociate in aqueous solution.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii)
The chemical equation shows the changes which occur when the strong acid,
hydrochloric acid, is added to water.
Complete the chemical equation to show the changes which occur when the weak acid,
ethanoic acid, is added to water.
(b) A student does experiments to show that hydrochloric acid is a strong acid and ethanoic acid is
a weak acid. The student adds an excess of hydrochloric acid and an excess of ethanoic acid
to separate samples of lumps of calcium carbonate.
Only the identity of the acid is changed between the experiments. All other conditions are kept
the same.
(i) State two observations which would show that hydrochloric acid is a stronger acid than
ethanoic acid.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(ii) The student uses the same size container and checks that the pressure is the same for
each experiment.
State three other conditions which must be kept the same to ensure fair testing.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
3 ...........................................................................................................................................
[3]
Calculate the mass, in g, of magnesium carbonate needed to react exactly with 50.00 cm3 of
2.00 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid using the following steps.
.............................. mol
●● etermine the number of moles of MgCO3 which would react with 50.00
D cm3 of
2.00 mol / dm HCl.
3
.............................. mol
Mr of MgCO3 = ..............................
●● Calculate the mass of MgCO3 needed to react exactly with 50.00 cm3 of 2.00 mol / dm3 HCl.
mass = .............................. g
[4]
(d)
A student prepares crystals of magnesium chloride by adding an excess of
magnesium carbonate to 50.00 cm3 of 2.00 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Describe how the student would obtain pure crystals of magnesium chloride from the
filtrate.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
(e) Silver chloride, AgCl, is insoluble. It can be made by a precipitation reaction between aqueous
barium chloride and a suitable aqueous silver salt.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 22]
A B C
H H H CH3 H CH2CH3
C C C C C C
H H H H H H
D E
H CH2CH2CH3 H CH2CH2CH2CH3
C C C C
H H H H
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
alkene .............................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
alkene .............................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
C
H CH2CH3
C C
H H
Describe the colour change seen and draw the structure of the product. Show all of the atoms
and all of the bonds.
structure
[2]
(f) Two different alcohols can be produced from alkene B by an addition reaction.
B
H CH3
C C
H H
(i) Draw the structures of the two alcohols. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[2]
(ii) State the reagent and conditions needed to produce an alcohol from alkene B.
reagent ................................................................................................................................
conditions ............................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[3]
C
H CH2CH3
C C
H H
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
H CH2CH3
n C C
H H
[3]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 19]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/M/J/19
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(b)(ii) isotope(s) 1
1(c) 9 Be
4 4
use of Cl (1)
1(d) 2 8 3 (1) 2
2 8 8 (1)
increase (1)
2(f) decrease from 120 °C to 80 °C and horizontal line at 80 °C (1) 2
3(b) brass 1
blue (1)
3(e)(ii) 1+ 1
4(c) 50.0 4
M1 mol of HCl = 2.00 × = 0.1(00) mol (1)
1000
M1
M2 mol of MgCO3 = = 0.1(00) / 2 = 0.05(00) (1)
2
M3 Mr of MgCO3 = 84 (1)
4(d)(i) to remove the acid / make sure all the acid is used up / no acid is left over 1
4(d)(ii) to make sure all the filtrate / MgCl2 / salt goes through / no MgCl2 left behind 1
formulae (1)
balance(1)
5(c) E (1) 2
5(d) A (1) 2
catalyst (1)
5(g)(i) addition 1
5(g)(ii) poly(but-1-ene) 1
5(g)(iii) M1 2 C atoms (only) with a single bond between them linked to the continuation bonds shown 3
M2 correct repeat unit showing one C2H5 / CH2CH3 side chain attached to one of the C atoms in M1
5(g)(iv) CH2 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2019
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
*7806266751*
This document gives details of how to prepare for and administer the practical exam.
The information in this document and the identity of any materials supplied by Cambridge International
are confidential and must NOT reach candidates either directly or indirectly.
The supervisor must complete the report at the end of this document and return it with the scripts.
If you have any queries regarding these confidential instructions, contact Cambridge International stating the
centre number, the syllabus and component number and the nature of the query.
email [email protected]
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 06_0620_51/CI/2RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
Safety
Supervisors must follow national and local regulations relating to safety and first aid.
Supervisors must inform candidates that materials and apparatus used in the exam should be treated
with caution. Suitable eye protection should be used where necessary.
The following hazard codes are used in these confidential instructions, where relevant:
Hazard data sheets relating to substances used in this exam should be available from your chemical
supplier.
● The packets containing the question papers must not be opened before the exam.
● It is assumed that standard school laboratory facilities, as indicated in the Guide to Planning
Practical Science, will be available.
● Spare materials and apparatus for the tasks set must be available for candidates, if required.
● It must be made clear to candidates at the start of the exam that they may request spare materials
and apparatus for the tasks set.
● Where specified, the supervisor must perform the experiments and record the results as instructed.
This must be done out of sight of the candidates, using the same materials and apparatus as the
candidates.
● Any assistance provided to candidates must be recorded in the supervisor’s report.
● If any materials or apparatus need to be replaced, for example, in the event of breakage or loss,
this must be recorded in the supervisor’s report.
● The supervisor must complete a report for each practical session held and each laboratory used.
● Each packet of scripts returned to Cambridge International must contain the following items:
● the scripts of the candidates specified on the bar code label provided
● the supervisor’s results relevant to these candidates
● the supervisor’s reports relevant to these candidates
● seating plans for each practical session, referring to each candidate by candidate number
● the attendance register.
During the exam, the supervisor (NOT the invigilator) must do the experiments in Questions
1 and 2 and record the results on a spare copy of the question paper, clearly labelled
‘supervisor’s results’.
Each candidate will require the following materials and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
● 50 cm3 of aqueous barium nitrate, Ba(NO3)2, of concentration 0.33 mol / dm3 labelled aqueous
barium nitrate
● 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate, Na2CO3, of concentration 0.33 mol / dm3 labelled aqueous
sodium carbonate
● test-tube rack
● teat pipette
During the exam, the supervisor (NOT the invigilator) must do the experiments in Questions
1 and 2 and record the results on a spare copy of the question paper, clearly labelled
‘supervisor’s results’.
Each candidate will require the following materials and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
● 0.1 g of powdered calcium carbonate, CaCO3, in a stoppered boiling tube labelled
solid G
● aqueous barium nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive sulfate test
[MH][N] ● aqueous silver nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive halide test
● distilled water
● pH indicator paper and chart
● red and blue litmus paper
● 10 cm3 measuring cylinder
● splints
● Bunsen burner and means to light it
● rack of test-tubes
● teat pipettes
● spatula
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
Supervisor’s report
Centre number
Give details of any difficulties experienced by the centre or by candidates (include the relevant
candidate names and candidate numbers).
Declaration
1 Each packet that I am returning to Cambridge International contains the following items:
the scripts of the candidates specified on the bar code label provided
the supervisor’s results relevant to these candidates
the supervisor’s reports relevant to these candidates
seating plans for each practical session, referring to each candidate by candidate number
the attendance register
2 here the practical exam has taken place in more than one practical session, I have clearly labelled
W
the supervisor’s results, supervisor’s reports and seating plans with the time and laboratory name/
number for each practical session.
3 I have included details of difficulties relating to each practical session experienced by the centre or
by candidates.
4 I have reported any other adverse circumstances affecting candidates, e.g. illness, bereavement or
temporary injury, directly to Cambridge International on a special consideration form.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2019
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 06_0620_51/2RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
1
You are going to investigate the reaction between aqueous sodium carbonate and aqueous
barium nitrate.
Instructions
You are going to do one experiment.
●● ill the burette up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with the aqueous sodium carbonate.
F
●● Label the test-tubes 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6 and place them in order in the test-tube rack.
●● Use the measuring cylinder to pour 6 cm3 of the aqueous barium nitrate into each of the six
test-tubes.
●● Add 1.0 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate from the burette to test-tube 1.
●● Add 2.0 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate from the burette to test-tube 2.
●● Add 4.0 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate from the burette to test-tube 3.
●● Add 5.0 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate from the burette to test-tube 4.
●● Add 6.0 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate from the burette to test-tube 5.
●● Add 7.0 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate from the burette to test-tube 6.
Using the glass rod, carefully stir the contents of each of the test-tubes. Leave the contents of the
test-tubes to stand for at least 10 minutes.
You should start Question 2 while you are waiting for the solid formed in the test‑tubes to
settle.
(a) After 10 minutes, use a ruler to measure the height of the solid formed in each test-tube.
Record your results in the table.
6
[4]
(b) Plot your results on the grid. Draw a line of best fit.
height of
solid / mm
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
volume of aqueous sodium carbonate / cm3
[3]
(c)
From your graph, deduce the height of the solid formed when 3.0
cm3 of aqueous
sodium carbonate is added to 6 cm of aqueous barium nitrate.
3
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) Describe the trend in the heights of the solids formed in test-tubes 1–6.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Explain one improvement you could make to the experiment to obtain more accurate results
for the heights of the solid formed.
improvement ...............................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(f) Suggest a different method to measure the amount of solid formed during the experiment.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) What type of chemical reaction occurs when aqueous sodium carbonate reacts with aqueous
barium nitrate?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 18]
tests on solution F
pH = .............................. [1]
(b) Add a strip of magnesium ribbon to the second portion of solution F. Shake the mixture. Test
the gas produced.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of aqueous silver nitrate to the third portion
of solution F.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of aqueous barium nitrate to the fourth
portion of solution F.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Keep the fifth portion of the solution F for the test in (f).
tests on solid G
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Add the fifth portion of solution F to solid G. Test the gas produced.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
Add about 2 cm3 of distilled water to the solution formed in the test in (f) and shake the mixture.
Divide the solution formed into two approximately equal portions in two test-tubes for the tests in
(g) and (h).
(g) Add aqueous sodium hydroxide to the first portion of the solution until no further change occurs.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(h) Add an excess of aqueous ammonia to the second portion of the solution.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 16]
3 Steel nails rust in the presence of air and water. Plan an investigation to:
●● s how that coating steel nails with paint helps to protect the nails from rusting
●● show that coating steel nails with zinc helps to protect the nails from rusting
●● determine which coating is more effective at protecting steel nails from rusting.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced
gently and test for the presence of will turn acidified aqueous
sulfur dioxide potassium manganate(VII) from
purple to colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical test May/June 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
in mm 1
shown clearly 1
unit = mm 1
1(e) improvement:
use burette or pipette to measure the barium nitrate / leave to settle longer / use measuring cylinders instead of test- 1
tubes
explanation:
1(f) M1 filter 1
M2 dry 1
M3 weigh solid 1
1(h) precipitation 1
tests on solution F
2(a) 0-3 1
2(b) bubbles / fizz / effervescence 1
2(d) No reaction/change 1
tests on solid G
2(f) bubbles / fizz / effervescence 1
limewater 1
turns milky 1
remains / insoluble 1
2(i) hydrochloric 1
acid 1
2(j) calcium 1
carbonate 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2019
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 06_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
BLANK PAGE
1 The diagram shows the apparatus a student used to prepare a dry sample of chlorine gas. Chlorine
is more dense than air.
concentrated ..........................................
hydrochloric
acid
..........................................
manganese(IV) oxide
flask 1 concentrated
sulfuric acid
(b) Use the diagram to identify two mistakes the student made.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) Suggest one reason why the gas produced in flask 1 is passed through concentrated
sulfuric acid.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
test ..............................................................................................................................................
observations ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
2 A student investigated the reaction between aqueous sodium carbonate and aqueous barium nitrate.
A glass rod was used to stir the contents of each of the test‑tubes. The contents of the test‑tubes
were left to stand until the solid formed had settled. A ruler was used to measure the height of the
solid formed in each test‑tube.
(a) Use a ruler to measure the heights of the solid formed in each test‑tube shown in the diagram.
Record the heights of the solid formed in the table and complete the table.
test-tube number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
volume of aqueous
sodium carbonate / cm3
solid
height of solid / mm
[3]
(b) Plot the results on the grid. Draw two intersecting lines of best fit. Label the x-axis.
100
80
60
height of
solid / mm
40
20
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
[4]
(c)
From your graph, deduce the height of the solid formed when 3.0
cm3 of aqueous
sodium carbonate is added to 6 cm of aqueous barium nitrate.
3
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. mm [2]
(d) Describe the trend in the heights of the solids formed in test‑tubes 1–7.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Predict what would happen if the experiment were continued using three further test‑tubes
each containing 6 cm3 of aqueous barium nitrate and separately adding 9.0 cm3, 10.0 cm3 and
11.0 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate to each one.
Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(f)
Suggest one change to the apparatus used which could be made to obtain more accurate
results.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) Suggest a different method to measure the amount of solid formed during the experiment.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 18]
3 Two substances, solution F and solid G, were analysed. Solution F was dilute hydrochloric acid.
Tests were done on solution F and solid G.
tests on solution F
pH = .............................. [1]
(b) Magnesium ribbon was added to the second portion of solution F. The gas produced was
tested.
observations ...............................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(c) Dilute nitric acid and aqueous silver nitrate were added to the third portion of solution F.
(d) Dilute nitric acid and aqueous barium nitrate were added to the fourth portion of solution F.
tests on solid G
test 1
test 2
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
4 Steel nails rust in the presence of air and water. Plan an investigation to:
●● s how that coating steel nails with paint helps to protect the nails from rusting
●● show that coating steel nails with zinc helps to protect the nails from rusting
●● determine which coating is more effective at protecting steel nails from rusting.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
heights of solid boxes completed 12, 24, 48, 60, 73, 73, 73 (1)
in mm (1)
2(f) use burette / pipette to measure out aqueous barium nitrate / instead of measuring cylinder 1
dry (1)
Tests on solution F
3(a) 0–3 1
pops (1)
3(d) no reaction/change 1
Tests on solid G
carbonate (1)
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2019
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*5634656915*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 11_0620_11/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
Which row describes the water particles in the air above the cup compared with the water
particles in the cup?
A
B
C
D
2 A student is asked to measure the time taken for 0.4 g of magnesium carbonate to react
completely with 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Which row describes the properties of the fractions that condense at the top of the fractionating
column?
A large high
B large low
C small high
D small low
4 Some information about solid silver chloride and solid sodium chloride is shown.
● The boiling point of silver chloride is 1547 °C and the boiling point of sodium chloride
is 1413 °C.
Which processes are used to separate a mixture of solid silver chloride and solid sodium
chloride?
What is M?
A ammonia, NH3
B hydrogen chloride, HCl
C methane, CH4
D water, H2O
52
6 An isotope of chromium is represented by 24 Cr .
A It contains 24 electrons.
B It contains 24 neutrons.
C It contains 28 protons.
D It contains 52 neutrons.
P Q
A alloy element
B alloy compound
C compound alloy
D compound element
H H H H
H C C O C C H
H H H H
10 During the electrolysis of concentrated hydrochloric acid, gases are produced at both electrodes.
Which statement describes the test result for the gas collected at the negative electrode?
1 The energy of the products is greater than the energy of the reactants.
2 The energy of the reactants is greater than the energy of the products.
3 The temperature of the surroundings increases during the reaction.
4 The temperature of the surroundings decreases during the reaction.
12 Equations for the formation of anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride and anhydrous copper(II) sulfate are
shown.
13 A method used to investigate the rate of reaction of calcium carbonate with dilute hydrochloric
acid under different conditions is shown.
Which volume of water and which temperature gives the shortest time taken for the reaction to
finish?
A 10 30
B 10 50
C 40 30
D 40 50
A boiling water
B cooking an egg
C dissolving sugar
D melting ice cubes
2HgO → 2Hg + O2
16 Carbonic acid is a weak acid formed when carbon dioxide dissolves in water.
A 1 B 5 C 7 D 9
What is X?
A copper(II) carbonate
B lithium carbonate
C potassium carbonate
D sodium sulfate
A carbon dioxide
B sodium oxide
C sulfur dioxide
D water
step 3 step 4
A to ensure all of the acid has reacted to obtain solid copper(II) sulfate
B to ensure all of the acid has reacted to remove the excess of copper(II) oxide
C to speed up the reaction to obtain solid copper(II) sulfate
D to speed up the reaction to remove the excess of copper(II) oxide
20 Which set of elements shows the change from metallic to non-metallic character across a period
of the Periodic Table?
A acts as a catalyst
B forms coloured compounds
C has a high melting point
D has a low density
A
B
C
D
What is X?
A a covalent compound
B a macromolecule
C a metal
D an ionic compound
25 Four different metals are reacted with an equal volume of dilute hydrochloric acid. The results of
the reactions are shown.
rate of
metal
effervescence
calcium very high
copper none
iron low
magnesium high
What is the order of reactivity of the four metals starting with the most reactive?
2 CO2 → C + O2
3 CO2 + C → 2CO
A Filtration removes bacteria and insoluble impurities, and chlorination removes soluble
impurities.
B Filtration removes insoluble impurities, and chlorination kills the bacteria.
C Filtration removes soluble and insoluble impurities, and chlorination kills the bacteria.
D Filtration removes soluble impurities and bacteria, and chlorination removes insoluble
impurities.
29 Clean, dry air contains nitrogen, oxygen and small amounts of other gases. The noble gases
have been left out of the table.
air
water
Which diagram shows the level of the water at the end of the week?
A B C D
31 Farmers add calcium oxide (lime) and ammonium salts to their fields.
The compounds are not added at the same time because they react with each other.
A ammonia
B carbon dioxide
C hydrogen
D nitrogen
A as a bleach
B as a food preservative
C in the manufacture of wood pulp for paper
D treating acidic soils
A cracking
B fractional distillation
C neutralisation
D thermal decomposition
A Bottled gas for heating and cooking is obtained from the naphtha fraction.
B Diesel oil is used as a fuel for jet aircraft.
C Substances used to make polishes are obtained from the lubricating fraction.
D The kerosene fraction contains many useful waxes.
A
B
C
D
40 The diagram shows the structure of a monomer and of the polymer made from it.
H H H H
n C C C C
H H H H
n
monomer polymer
A ethane poly(ethane)
B ethane poly(ethene)
C ethene poly(ethane)
D ethene poly(ethene)
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/11/O/N/19
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 A 1
2 A 1
3 D 1
4 B 1
5 C 1
6 A 1
7 A 1
8 D 1
9 D 1
10 B 1
11 B 1
12 A 1
13 B 1
14 B 1
15 D 1
16 B 1
17 B 1
18 B 1
19 B 1
20 D 1
21 B 1
22 D 1
23 C 1
24 C 1
25 D 1
26 D 1
27 B 1
28 B 1
29 C 1
30 B 1
31 A 1
32 B 1
33 D 1
34 D 1
35 C 1
36 C 1
37 C 1
38 B 1
39 D 1
40 D 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2019
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*8533346900*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 11_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
The gases are carbon dioxide, CO2, hydrogen chloride, HCl, hydrogen sulfide, H2S, and nitrogen
dioxide, NO2.
A carbon dioxide
B hydrogen chloride
C hydrogen sulfide
D nitrogen dioxide
2 A student is asked to measure the time taken for 0.4 g of magnesium carbonate to react
completely with 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
The results are shown on the chromatogram. The diagram is not drawn to scale.
solvent front
10 cm
8 cm
6 cm
4 cm
2 cm
baseline
A B C D
52
5 An isotope of chromium is represented by 24 Cr .
A It contains 24 electrons.
B It contains 24 neutrons.
C It contains 28 protons.
D It contains 52 neutrons.
12 14
6 Element X has two isotopes, 6X and 6X.
A They have different chemical properties because they have different numbers of neutrons.
B They have the same chemical properties because they have the same number of outer shell
electrons.
C They have the same nucleon number because the sum of the number of protons and
electrons is the same.
D They have different positions in the Periodic Table because they have different numbers of
neutrons.
A Molecules of both diamond and silicon(IV) oxide are held together by weak attractive forces.
B They both contain atoms arranged in planes held together by weak bonds.
C They both contain ions that are free to move.
D The carbon in diamond and the silicon in silicon(IV) oxide each have four covalent bonds.
Which fertiliser supplies the greatest mass of nitrogen per 100 kg bag?
1.00 g of calcium carbonate is added to 50.0 cm3 of 0.0500 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid.
11 Which rows correctly show cathode and anode products from the electrolysis of the named
electrolyte?
12 What are the ionic half-equations for the electrode reactions during the electrolysis of
concentrated aqueous sodium chloride?
anode cathode
1 The energy of the products is greater than the energy of the reactants.
2 The energy of the reactants is greater than the energy of the products.
3 The temperature of the surroundings increases during the reaction.
4 The temperature of the surroundings decreases during the reaction.
A boiling water
B cooking an egg
C dissolving sugar
D melting ice cubes
16 The rate of reaction between magnesium and dilute hydrochloric acid is increased by increasing
the concentration of the acid.
A increases increases
B increases stays the same
C stays the same increases
D stays the same stays the same
17 Dinitrogen tetroxide, N2O4, is converted into nitrogen dioxide, NO2, in a reversible reaction.
N2O4(g) 2NO2(g)
pressure
temperature
/ atmospheres
A 2 high
B 2 low
C 50 high
D 50 low
18 The equation for the reaction between iron(II) sulfate and bromine is shown.
Which row identifies the oxidising agent and the reducing agent?
A Br2 FeSO4
B FeSO4 Br2
C FeBr3 Fe2(SO4)3
D Fe2(SO4)3 FeBr3
20 Carbonic acid is a weak acid formed when carbon dioxide dissolves in water.
A 1 B 5 C 7 D 9
step 3 step 4
A to ensure all of the acid has reacted to obtain solid copper(II) sulfate
B to ensure all of the acid has reacted to remove the excess of copper(II) oxide
C to speed up the reaction to obtain solid copper(II) sulfate
D to speed up the reaction to remove the excess of copper(II) oxide
A crystallisation
B drying
C filtration
D precipitation
A
B
C
D
25 Which pair of compounds shows that transition elements have variable oxidation states?
What is X?
A a covalent compound
B a macromolecule
C a metal
D an ionic compound
A It is an alloy.
B It is below iron in the reactivity series.
C It is not a transition element.
D Its surface is protected by an oxide layer.
A Filtration removes bacteria and insoluble impurities, and chlorination removes soluble
impurities.
B Filtration removes insoluble impurities, and chlorination kills the bacteria.
C Filtration removes soluble and insoluble impurities, and chlorination kills the bacteria.
D Filtration removes soluble impurities and bacteria, and chlorination removes insoluble
impurities.
31 Which physical property is used to separate the nitrogen and oxygen from air?
A boiling point
B density
C electrical conductivity
D molecular mass
air
water
Which diagram shows the level of the water at the end of the week?
A B C D
A Carbon is absorbed from the atmosphere by combustion and released into it by respiration.
B Carbon is absorbed from the atmosphere by photosynthesis and released into it by
combustion.
C Carbon is absorbed from the atmosphere by both respiration and combustion.
D Carbon is released into the atmosphere by both photosynthesis and respiration.
The ......1...... is made by the ......2...... process in which ......3...... is used as a catalyst.
1 2 3
A cracking
B fractional distillation
C neutralisation
D thermal decomposition
A Bottled gas for heating and cooking is obtained from the naphtha fraction.
B Diesel oil is used as a fuel for jet aircraft.
C Substances used to make polishes are obtained from the lubricating fraction.
D The kerosene fraction contains many useful waxes.
A
B
C
D
39 The diagram shows the structure of a monomer and of the polymer made from it.
H H H H
n C C C C
H H H H
n
monomer polymer
A ethane poly(ethane)
B ethane poly(ethene)
C ethene poly(ethane)
D ethene poly(ethene)
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/21/O/N/19
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 C 1
2 A 1
3 C 1
4 C 1
5 A 1
6 B 1
7 D 1
8 C 1
9 D 1
10 A 1
11 C 1
12 B 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 B 1
16 B 1
17 A 1
18 A 1
19 C 1
20 B 1
21 B 1
22 A 1
23 C 1
24 B 1
25 C 1
26 C 1
27 B 1
28 D 1
29 A 1
30 B 1
31 A 1
32 B 1
33 B 1
34 C 1
35 D 1
36 C 1
37 B 1
38 D 1
39 D 1
40 A 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) October/November 2019
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 11_0620_31/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
(a) The list gives the names of nine substances which are solids at room temperature.
a ceramic
aluminium
anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride
anhydrous copper(II) sulfate
calcium oxide
graphite
iodine
iron
sodium
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
A evaporation
solid liquid sodium
sodium sodium gas
freezing B
A ..........................................................................................................................................
B ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(ii) Use the kinetic particle model to describe the arrangement and separation of the particles
in:
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[4]
[Total: 11]
(a) The table shows the percentage composition of the gases present in a sample of biogas.
percentage
substance present
present in biogas
carbon dioxide 28.5
hydrogen 1.0
methane 62.0
nitrogen
water vapour 2.4
other substances 0.1
total 100.0
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) (i) Balance the chemical equation for the complete combustion of methane.
(ii) Which one of these compounds belongs to the same homologous series as methane?
(iii) M
ethane is present in the refinery gas fraction produced by the fractional distillation of
petroleum.
Match the fractions on the left with their uses on the right.
The first one has been done for you.
fraction use
[2]
(c) (i) Draw a dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of hydrogen.
[1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
H
H O
N C C
H O H
H C H
S
H
(i) On the structure shown, draw a circle around the carboxylic acid functional group. [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [4]
[Total: 14]
3 A student investigated the reaction between zinc carbonate and an excess of dilute hydrochloric acid.
The rate of reaction can be found by measuring the decrease in the mass of the reaction mixture
over time.
(a) Describe one other practical method for measuring the rate of this reaction.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(c) What effect do the following have on the rate of this reaction?
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 8]
11Na
23
(a) (i) Deduce the number of protons, electrons and neutrons in this isotope of sodium.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[2]
(ii) State the name of the particle which is lost when a sodium atom forms a sodium ion.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
●● n alkaline solution
a
●● a gas which ‘pops’ with a lighted splint.
(i) Complete the word equation for the reaction of sodium with water.
.............................. ..............................
sodium + water +
..............................
[2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) The table shows some observations for the reaction of four metals with cold water and with hot
water.
Use this information to put the four metals in order of their reactivity.
Put the least reactive metal first.
[2]
[Total: 13]
(ii) Describe the trend in the atomic radius of the halogens down the group.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(b) Bromine reacts with an aqueous potassium salt to form iodine and a different potassium salt.
.............................. ..............................
bromine + iodine +
.............................. ..............................
[2]
(i) Explain, using ideas about the reactivity of the halogens, why chlorine does not react with
aqueous sodium fluoride.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Balance the chemical equation for the reaction of fluorine with ammonia.
number relative
type of atom
of atoms atomic mass
xenon
oxygen 3 16 3 × 16 = 48
fluorine
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 13]
(a) When ammonia gas reacts with hydrogen chloride gas, white fumes of ammonium chloride are
formed.
(ii) Watch-glasses of aqueous ammonia and concentrated hydrochloric acid were placed near
each other on a table.
At first no white fumes were seen.
After a short time, white fumes were seen between the watch-glasses.
dense
white fumes
watch-glass watch-glass of
of ammonia hydrochloric acid
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
Name the three elements present in most fertilisers which improve plant growth.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[3]
(c) Aqueous ammonia can be used to test for aluminium ions and zinc ions.
aluminium (Al 3+)
zinc (Zn2+)
[3]
[Total: 10]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Predict the products of the electrolysis of molten magnesium chloride at:
(b)
The following statements are about the procedure for making crystals of hydrated
magnesium chloride from magnesium and dilute hydrochloric acid.
[2]
Describe two other properties of copper which are different from those of magnesium.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(d) Chromatography can be used to separate a mixture of ions from different transition element
compounds.
Four samples, R, S, T and U, each containing transition element ions, were placed on a piece
of chromatography paper.
Two solutions, Y and Z, each containing only one type of transition element ion were also
placed on the same piece of chromatography paper.
R S T U Y Z
(i) Which sample, R, S, T or U, contains the same ions as both solution Y and solution Z?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Which sample, R, S, T or U, does not contain the same ions as either solution Y or
solution Z?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) In which sample, R, S, T or U, has the greatest number of transition element ions been
separated?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 11]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/O/N/19
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) October/November 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(ii) graphite 1
1(a)(iv) aluminium 1
1(a)(v) ceramic 1
B: condensing / condensation (1)
1(b)(ii) solid: 4
particles arranged regularly / particles ordered (1)
liquid:
particles arranged irregularly / particles randomly arranged (1)
2(a) 6.0 / 6 (%) 1
2(b)(i) 2 (O2) (1) 2
2 (H2O) (1)
2(b)(ii) propane 1
2(c)(i) two (hydrogen) atoms with pair of electrons between and no other electrons 1
2(c)(ii) fuel 1
2(d)(ii) 5 1
yeast (1)
AND
use of gas measuring apparatus e.g. syringe / inverted measuring cylinder full of water (1)
3(b) 31.25 (g) 1
respiration (1)
electrons: 11 (1)
neutrons: 12 (1)
electrons in first shell AND eight electrons in the second shell (1)
4(b)(ii) electron 1
hydrogen (1)
AND
sodium is a metal (1)
5(a)(i) density of chlorine: any value between 1 g / cm3 and 3 g / cm3 inclusive (1) 2
boiling point of iodine: any value between 115 °C and 320 °C inclusive (1)
50 °C is between the melting point and boiling point / 50 °C is higher than the melting point but lower than the boiling point
(1)
3 (F2) (1)
6(a)(i) neutralisation 1
phosphorus (1)
potassium (1)
7(d)(i) R 1
7(d)(ii) T 1
7(d)(iii) R 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) October/November 2019
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 11_0620_41/3RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
(a) Choose from the following list of ions to answer the questions.
Br
–
Ca2+ Cl – Cr3+ Cu2+
Each ion may be used once, more than once or not at all.
(iii) forms a white precipitate with aqueous sodium hydroxide ............................................ [1]
(iv) forms a cream precipitate with acidified aqueous silver nitrate ..................................... [1]
(v) forms a white precipitate with acidified aqueous barium nitrate. ................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Magnesium phosphate contains magnesium ions, Mg2+, and phosphate ions, PO43–.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
34
16 S2–
(i) How many neutrons are contained in this sulfide ion?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Which element forms an ion with a 2+ charge that has the same number of electrons as
a S2– ion?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) The manufacture of sulfuric acid by the Contact process occurs in four stages.
(i) Complete the chemical equation for stage 1 by adding the appropriate state symbols.
(ii) Name the catalyst used in stage 2 and state the temperature used.
catalyst .............................................
temperature ...................................... °C
[2]
(iii) Write chemical equations for the reactions in stage 3 and stage 4.
stage 3 ................................................................................................................................
stage 4 ................................................................................................................................
[2]
(i) State one environmental reason why sulfur dioxide should not be released into the
atmosphere.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
test .......................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
observations ........................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[2]
(e) S
ulfur dioxide reacts with aqueous sodium sulfite to produce a compound with the following
composition by mass: 29.1% Na, 40.5% S and 30.4% O.
[Total: 16]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Name the two substances, other than iron, that must be present for iron to rust.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[1]
(i) What can be deduced about the reactivity of zinc from this reaction?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
Identify the oxidising agent in this reaction. Explain your answer in terms of electron
transfer.
explanation ..........................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[2]
reagent 1 ....................................................................................................................................
observation .................................................................................................................................
reagent 2 ....................................................................................................................................
observation .................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 8]
(a) Name:
(b) Write the chemical equation for the reaction in which silver carbonate is formed.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Write the ionic equation for the reaction in which lead(II) iodide is formed.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) Aqueous silver nitrate produces a yellow precipitate with both iodide ions and carbonate ions.
When testing an unknown solution for iodide ions, the aqueous silver nitrate is acidified.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 7]
C C C C C C
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Draw the structure of the monomer from which polymer A is made.
[2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Draw the structures of two structural isomers with the formula C4H10.
Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[2]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 10]
(a) A 25.0 cm3 portion of Na2CO3(aq) was placed in a conical flask with a few drops of a suitable
indicator. It was titrated against HCl (aq) of concentration 0.180 mol /dm3.
Calculate the concentration of the Na2CO3(aq), in mol / dm3, using the following steps.
.............................. mol
●● Calculate the number of moles of Na2CO3 contained in the 25.0 cm3 portion of Na2CO3(aq).
.............................. mol
.............................. mol / dm3
[3]
(b) In another experiment, the volume of carbon dioxide, CO2, produced was 48.0 cm3, measured
at room temperature and pressure.
(c)
A sample of concentrated hydrobromic acid, HBr(aq), was electrolysed using platinum
electrodes.
The concentration of the hydrobromic acid was 8.89 mol / dm3.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(iii) Magnesium is not a suitable material from which to make the electrodes.
Explain why.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iv) Predict the product formed at the anode when concentrated HBr(aq) is electrolysed.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) Write the ionic half-equation for the reaction occurring at the cathode.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 11]
(a) Ethanol that is suitable for use as a fuel can be manufactured from sugars such as glucose,
C6H12O6, by a two-step process.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
H H
H C C O H + 3 O O 2 O C O + 3 H O H
H H
Use the bond energies in the table to calculate the energy change, in kJ / mol, for the complete
combustion of ethanol.
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
C–C 347
C–H 413
C–O 358
C=O 805
O–H 464
O=O 498
.............................. kJ
.............................. kJ
(c) Ethanol can be oxidised by hydrogen peroxide to form ethanal, CH3CHO. A catalyst for this
reaction is Fe3+.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
H C C O
H H
H C C O
H H
[3]
(iii) The table gives the boiling points of ethanal and ethanol.
In terms of attractive forces between particles, suggest why ethanal has a lower boiling
point than ethanol.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
The reaction can reach a position of equilibrium. The forward reaction is exothermic.
(i) State and explain the effect of increasing the pressure on the position of equilibrium.
All other conditions are unchanged.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
State and explain the effect of increasing the pressure on the rate of the reaction.
All other conditions are unchanged.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(iii) State and explain the effect of increasing the temperature on the position of equilibrium.
All other conditions are unchanged.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 20]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2019
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/O/N/19
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) October/November 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the specific
content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these marking
principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the question
as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may be
limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or grade
descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) K+ 1
1(a)(ii) Cr3+ 1
1(a)(iii) Ca2+ 1
1(a)(iv) Br- 1
1(a)(v) SO42- 1
1(c) Mg3(PO4)2 1
2(a) atoms with same number of protons or atoms of the same element or atoms with same atomic number (1) 2
atoms with different number of neutrons or atoms with different mass number or atoms with different nucleon number (1)
2(b)(i) 18 1
2(b)(iii) Ca / calcium 1
5(a)(i) addition 1
5(a)(ii) CH2 1
5(a)(iii) 2
5(b)(ii) 2
(1)
(1)
6(b) 0.002(00) 1
6(c)(i) 720(.09) 1
6(b)(iv) bromine / Br2 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2019
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
*2835959356*
This document gives details of how to prepare for and administer the practical exam.
The information in this document and the identity of any materials supplied by Cambridge International
are confidential and must NOT reach candidates either directly or indirectly.
The supervisor must complete the report at the end of this document and return it with the scripts.
If you have any queries regarding these confidential instructions, contact Cambridge International stating the
centre number, the syllabus and component number and the nature of the query.
email [email protected]
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 11_0620_51/CI/FP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
Safety
Supervisors must follow national and local regulations relating to safety and first aid.
Supervisors must inform candidates that materials and apparatus used in the exam should be treated
with caution. Suitable eye protection should be used where necessary.
The following hazard codes are used in these confidential instructions, where relevant:
Hazard data sheets relating to substances used in this exam should be available from your chemical
supplier.
● The packets containing the question papers must not be opened before the exam.
● It is assumed that standard school laboratory facilities, as indicated in the Guide to Planning
Practical Science, will be available.
● Spare materials and apparatus for the tasks set must be available for candidates, if required.
● It must be made clear to candidates at the start of the exam that they may request spare materials
and apparatus for the tasks set.
● Where specified, the supervisor must perform the experiments and record the results as instructed.
This must be done out of sight of the candidates, using the same materials and apparatus as the
candidates.
● Any assistance provided to candidates must be recorded in the supervisor’s report.
● If any materials or apparatus need to be replaced, for example, in the event of breakage or loss,
this must be recorded in the supervisor’s report.
● The supervisor must complete a report for each practical session held and each laboratory used.
● Each packet of scripts returned to Cambridge International must contain the following items:
During the exam, the supervisor (NOT the invigilator) must do the experiments in Questions
1 and 2 and record the results on a spare copy of the question paper, clearly labelled
‘supervisor’s results’.
Each candidate will require the following materials and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
● white tile
● teat pipette
During the exam, the supervisor (NOT the invigilator) must do the experiments in Questions
1 and 2 and record the results on a spare copy of the question paper, clearly labelled
‘supervisor’s results’.
Each candidate will require the following materials and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
● distilled water
● splints
● rack of test-tubes
● boiling tube
● watch-glass
● teat pipettes
● spatula
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
Supervisor’s report
Centre number
Give details of any difficulties experienced by the centre or by candidates (include the relevant
candidate names and candidate numbers).
Declaration
1 Each packet that I am returning to Cambridge International contains the following items:
2 Where the practical exam has taken place in more than one practical session, I have clearly
labelled the supervisor’s results, supervisor’s reports and seating plans with the time and laboratory
name/number for each practical session.
3 I have included details of difficulties relating to each practical session experienced by the centre or
by candidates.
4 I have reported any other adverse circumstances affecting candidates, e.g. illness, bereavement or
temporary injury, directly to Cambridge International on a special consideration form.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2019
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 11_0620_51/FP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and three different
concentrations of aqueous sodium hydroxide, labelled R, S and T.
Instructions
You are going to do three experiments.
Experiment 1
Experiment 2
Experiment 3
volume used
[4]
(b)
What colour change is observed in the conical flask at the end-point?
(c) Suggest why Universal Indicator is not a suitable indicator to use in these experiments.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Experiment ........ needed the smallest volume of dilute hydrochloric acid to change the
colour of the methyl orange indicator.
Experiment ........ needed the largest volume of dilute hydrochloric acid to change the
colour of the methyl orange indicator.
[1]
(ii) Determine the simplest whole number ratio of volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in
Experiments 1 and 2.
(iii)
Deduce the order of concentrations of the solutions of aqueous sodium hydroxide,
R, S and T.
.................................
(e) What would be the effect on the results, if any, if the solutions of aqueous sodium hydroxide
were warmed before adding the dilute hydrochloric acid? Give a reason for your answer.
reason .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) Suggest a different method, not involving an indicator, of finding the order of concentrations of
the solutions of aqueous sodium hydroxide, R, S and T.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 17]
tests on solid U
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Add the rest of solid U to about 10 cm3 of distilled water in a boiling tube. Stopper the boiling tube
and shake the mixture to dissolve solid U and form solution U.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) (i) Add a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the first portion of solution U.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) (i) Add a few drops of aqueous ammonia to the second portion of solution U.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(e) Add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of aqueous barium nitrate to the third
portion of solution U. Leave to stand for 5 minutes.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
What conclusions can you draw about the ions present in solid U?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
tests on liquid V
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) Use a teat pipette to place a few drops of liquid V onto a watch‑glass. Put the stopper back into
the test‑tube of liquid V. Use a lighted splint to touch the surface of liquid V carefully.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Use a spatula to transfer a small crystal of iodine carefully into the rest of liquid V in the
stoppered test‑tube. Put the stopper back into the test‑tube and shake the test‑tube.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 17]
3 Potassium nitrate and ammonium chloride are two salts. The energy change when they each
dissolve in water is endothermic.
Plan an experiment to show which of these two salts produces the larger endothermic energy
change per gram.
You are provided with potassium nitrate and ammonium chloride, distilled water and common
laboratory apparatus.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced
gently and test for the presence of will turn acidified aqueous
sulfur dioxide potassium manganate(VII) from
purple to colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test October/November 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1 / Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
comparable to supervisors 1
1(b) yellow 1
orange / pink / red 1
1(d)(ii) 1:2 1
1(e) no effect / none 1
thermometric
• measure temperature (change)
• highest temperature (change) is most concentrated
• add (excess) hydrochloric acid
gas produced
• measure volume of gas made
• largest volume is most concentrated
• add an ammonium salt or aluminium
evaporation
• mass of solid
• most mass is most concentrated
• evaporate solution
pH meter
• measure pH
• highest pH is most concentrated
• pH meter
dissolving
• measure time taken for solid to dissolve
• shortest time is most concentrated
• aluminium / aluminium oxide / zinc / zinc oxide
tests on solid U
2(a) lilac 1
2(b) blue / purple / violet 1
2(d)(i) grey-green 1
precipitate 1
2(e) white 1
precipitate 1
2(f) potassium 1
chromium 1
sulfate 1
tests on liquid V
2(g) colourless 1
2(i) pink / purple 1
2(j) fuel / organic 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2019
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
This syllabus is regulated for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB19 11_0620_61/2RP
© UCLES 2019 [Turn over
2
1 The apparatus shown was used to investigate the products formed when ethanol, C2H5OH, burns
in air.
to suction
pump
limewater
ethanol
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
test ..............................................................................................................................................
observations ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Predict the change seen in the test-tube containing the limewater. Explain your prediction.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
2
A student investigated the rate of reaction between dilute nitric acid and an excess of
solid magnesium carbonate at room temperature.
solid
magnesium
carbonate
water
dilute
nitric acid
50 cm3 of dilute nitric acid was added to the conical flask. The contents of the test‑tube were
released, allowing the solid magnesium carbonate to mix with the dilute nitric acid. A stop‑clock was
started and the volume of gas collected in the inverted measuring cylinder was measured every
10 seconds for 80 seconds.
(a) Use the inverted measuring cylinder diagrams to record the volume of gas collected in the
table.
inverted
total volume of
time / s measuring cylinder
gas collected / cm3
diagram
0
0
5
10
20
10
25
30
40
20
45
50
55
30
60
65
60
40
65
70
70
50
75
80
70
60
75
80
70
70
75
80
70
80
75
80
[2]
(b) Plot the results on the grid. Draw a smooth line graph.
80
70
60
50
total
volume
of gas 40
collected
/ cm3
30
20
10
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
time / s
[3]
(ii)
From your graph, deduce the time taken to collect 40 cm3 of gas.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. s [2]
(d) State one possible source of error in this experiment. Suggest one improvement to reduce this
source of error.
improvement ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
(e) The average rate of the reaction can be calculated using the equation shown.
(i) Calculate the volume of gas collected between 10 seconds and 30 seconds.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii)
Calculate the average rate of reaction between 10 seconds and 30 seconds. Include the
unit in your answer.
unit = ..............................
[2]
(f) The student calculated that the total volume of gas collected in this reaction would be 85 cm3.
Suggest and explain why the actual volume of gas collected was different from 85 cm3.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) S
ketch on the grid the graph you would expect if the experiment were repeated at a lower
temperature. Label this graph as L.[2]
[Total: 17]
3 Two substances, solid A and solid B, were analysed. Solid A was zinc nitrate.
Tests were done on the substances.
tests on solid A
Solid A was added to distilled water and the mixture shaken to dissolve solid A and produce
solution A. Solution A was divided into three equal portions in three test‑tubes.
(a) (i) A few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the first portion of solution A.
observations................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was then added to this mixture.
(b) (i) A few drops of aqueous ammonia were added to the second portion of solution A.
(ii) An excess of aqueous ammonia was then added to this mixture.
(c) Aluminium foil and aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the third portion of solution A.
The mixture was heated and the gas produced was tested with litmus paper.
observations ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on solid B
test 2
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 9]
Plan an experiment to find out in which solvent iodine is the most soluble at room temperature.
You are provided with iodine, the two solvents and common laboratory apparatus.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
Assessment International Education Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download
at www.cambridgeinternational.org after the live examination series.
Cambridge Assessment International Education is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of the University of
Cambridge Local Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which itself is a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2019
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2019 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond
the scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range
may be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a) beaker 1
condenses / cools 1
turns blue / pink 1
shown clearly 1
2(e)(i) 35 cm3 1
2(e)(ii) 35 / 20 = 1.75 1
cm3 / s 1
3(a)(i) white 1
precipitate 1
3(c) bubbles / effervescence 1
3(d) lithium 1
iodide 1